service: Add shepherd discover action.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
88
89 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
90 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
91 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
92 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
93 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
94 Documentation License''.
95 @end copying
96
97 @dircategory System administration
98 @direntry
99 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
100 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
101 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
102 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
103 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
104 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
105 @end direntry
106
107 @dircategory Software development
108 @direntry
109 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
110 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
111 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
112 @end direntry
113
114 @titlepage
115 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
116 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
117 @author The GNU Guix Developers
118
119 @page
120 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
121 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
122 @value{UPDATED} @*
123
124 @insertcopying
125 @end titlepage
126
127 @contents
128
129 @c *********************************************************************
130 @node Top
131 @top GNU Guix
132
133 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
134 package management tool written for the GNU system.
135
136 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
137 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
138 @c translation.
139 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
140 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
141 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
142 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
143 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
144 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
145 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
146 Project}.
147
148 @menu
149 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
150 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
151 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
152 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
153 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
154 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
155 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
156 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
157 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
158 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
159 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
160 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
161 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
162 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
163 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
164 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
165
166 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
167 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
168 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
169 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
170
171 @detailmenu
172 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
173
174 Introduction
175
176 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
177 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
178
179 Installation
180
181 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
182 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
183 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
184 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
185 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
186 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
187 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
188
189 Setting Up the Daemon
190
191 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
192 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
193 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
194
195 System Installation
196
197 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
198 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
199 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
200 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
201 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
202 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
203 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
204 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
205 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
206
207 Manual Installation
208
209 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
210 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
211
212 Package Management
213
214 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
215 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
216 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
217 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
218 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
219 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
220 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
221 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
222 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
223 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
224
225 Substitutes
226
227 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
228 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
229 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
230 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
231 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
232 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
233 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
234
235 Channels
236
237 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
238 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
239 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
240 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
241 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
242 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
243 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
244 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
245 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
246 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
247
248 Development
249
250 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
251 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
252 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
253 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
254
255 Programming Interface
256
257 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
258 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
259 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
260 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
261 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
262 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
263 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
264 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
265 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
266 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
267 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
268
269 Defining Packages
270
271 * package Reference:: The package data type.
272 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
273
274 Utilities
275
276 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
277 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
278 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
279 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
280 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
281 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
282 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
283 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
284 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
285 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
286 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
287 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
288 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
289 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
290 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
291
292 Invoking @command{guix build}
293
294 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
295 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
296 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
297 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
298
299 System Configuration
300
301 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
302 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
303 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
304 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
305 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
306 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
307 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
308 * Services:: Specifying system services.
309 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
310 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
311 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
312 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
313 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
314 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
315 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
316 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
317 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
318
319 Services
320
321 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
322 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
323 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
324 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
325 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
326 * X Window:: Graphical display.
327 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
328 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
329 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
330 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
331 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
332 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
333 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
334 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
335 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
336 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
337 * Web Services:: Web servers.
338 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
339 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
340 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
341 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
342 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
343 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
344 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
345 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
346 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
347 * Game Services:: Game servers.
348 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
349 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
350 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
351 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
352 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
353
354 Defining Services
355
356 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
357 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
358 * Service Reference:: API reference.
359 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
360
361 Installing Debugging Files
362
363 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
364 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
365
366 Bootstrapping
367
368 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
369 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
370
371 @end detailmenu
372 @end menu
373
374 @c *********************************************************************
375 @node Introduction
376 @chapter Introduction
377
378 @cindex purpose
379 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
380 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
381 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
382 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
383 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
384 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
385 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
386
387 @cindex Guix System
388 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
389 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
390 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
391 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
392 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
393 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
394 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
395 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
396 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
397 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
398
399 @menu
400 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
401 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
402 @end menu
403
404 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
405 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
406
407 @cindex user interfaces
408 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
409 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
410 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
411 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
412 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
413 @cindex build daemon
414 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
415 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
416 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
417
418 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
419 @cindex customization, of packages
420 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
421 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
422 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
423 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
424 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
425 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
426 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
427 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
428
429 @cindex functional package management
430 @cindex isolation
431 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
432 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
433 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
434 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
435 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
436 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
437 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
438 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
439 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
440 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
441 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
442 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
443 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
444 explicit inputs are visible.
445
446 @cindex store
447 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
448 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
449 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
450 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
451 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
452 input yields a different directory name.
453
454 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
455 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
456 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
457
458
459 @node GNU Distribution
460 @section GNU Distribution
461
462 @cindex Guix System
463 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
464 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
465 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
466 users of that software}.}. The
467 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
468 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
469 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
470 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
471 Guix@tie{}System.
472
473 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
474 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
475 list of available packages can be browsed
476 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
477 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
478
479 @example
480 guix package --list-available
481 @end example
482
483 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
484 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
485 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
486 tools that help users exert that freedom.
487
488 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
489
490 @table @code
491
492 @item x86_64-linux
493 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
494
495 @item i686-linux
496 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
497
498 @item armhf-linux
499 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
500 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
501 and Linux-Libre kernel.
502
503 @item aarch64-linux
504 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
505
506 @item i586-gnu
507 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
508 (IA32).
509
510 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
511 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
512 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
513 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
514 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
515
516 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
517 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
518 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
519 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
520 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
521 architecture then the code is still available.
522
523 @end table
524
525 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
526 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
527 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
528 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
529 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
530 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
531 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
532
533 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
534 @code{mips64el-linux}.
535
536 @noindent
537 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
538 @pxref{Porting}.
539
540 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
541 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
542
543
544 @c *********************************************************************
545 @node Installation
546 @chapter Installation
547
548 @cindex installing Guix
549
550 @quotation Note
551 We recommend the use of this
552 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
553 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
554 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
555 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
556 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
557 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
558 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
559 as the root user.
560 @end quotation
561
562 @cindex foreign distro
563 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
564 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
565 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
566 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
567 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
568
569 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
570 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
571
572 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
573 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
574 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
575 ready to use it.
576
577 @menu
578 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
579 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
580 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
581 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
582 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
583 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
584 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
585 @end menu
586
587 @node Binary Installation
588 @section Binary Installation
589
590 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
591 @cindex installer script
592 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
593 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
594 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
595 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
596 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
597
598 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
599 @quotation Note
600 We recommend the use of this
601 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
602 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
603 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
604 user. As root, you can thus run this:
605
606 @example
607 cd /tmp
608 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
609 chmod +x guix-install.sh
610 ./guix-install.sh
611 @end example
612
613 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
614 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
615 @end quotation
616
617 Installing goes along these lines:
618
619 @enumerate
620 @item
621 @cindex downloading Guix binary
622 Download the binary tarball from
623 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
624 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
625 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
626 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
627
628 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
629 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
630 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
631
632 @example
633 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
634 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
635 @end example
636
637 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
638 then run this command to import it:
639
640 @example
641 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
642 -qO - | gpg --import -
643 @end example
644
645 @noindent
646 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
647
648 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
649 signature!'' is normal.
650
651 @c end authentication part
652
653 @item
654 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
655 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
656
657 @example
658 # cd /tmp
659 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
660 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
661 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
662 @end example
663
664 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
665 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
666 step).
667
668 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
669 would overwrite its own essential files.
670
671 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
672 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
673 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
674 versions are fine).
675 They stem from the fact that all the
676 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
677 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
678 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
679 reproducible.
680
681 @item
682 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
683 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
684
685 @example
686 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
687 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
688 ~root/.config/guix/current
689 @end example
690
691 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
692 environment variables:
693
694 @example
695 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
696 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
697 @end example
698
699 @item
700 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
701 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
702
703 @item
704 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
705
706 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
707 with these commands:
708
709 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
710 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
711 @c files into place.
712 @c
713 @c See this thread for more information:
714 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
715
716 @example
717 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
718 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
719 /etc/systemd/system/
720 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
721 @end example
722
723 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
724
725 @example
726 # initctl reload-configuration
727 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
728 /etc/init/
729 # start guix-daemon
730 @end example
731
732 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
733
734 @example
735 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
736 --build-users-group=guixbuild
737 @end example
738
739 @item
740 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
741 for instance with:
742
743 @example
744 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
745 # cd /usr/local/bin
746 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
747 @end example
748
749 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
750 there:
751
752 @example
753 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
754 # cd /usr/local/share/info
755 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
756 do ln -s $i ; done
757 @end example
758
759 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
760 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
761 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
762 Info search path).
763
764 @item
765 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
766 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
767 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
768
769 @example
770 # guix archive --authorize < \
771 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
772 @end example
773
774 @item
775 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
776 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
777 @end enumerate
778
779 Voilà, the installation is complete!
780
781 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
782 the root profile:
783
784 @example
785 # guix install hello
786 @end example
787
788 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
789 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
790
791 @example
792 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
793 @end example
794
795 @noindent
796 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
797
798 @example
799 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
800 --profile-name=current-guix guix
801 @end example
802
803 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
804
805 @node Requirements
806 @section Requirements
807
808 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
809 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
810 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
811 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
812
813 @cindex official website
814 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
815 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
816
817 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
818
819 @itemize
820 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
821 2.2.x;
822 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
823 0.1.0 or later;
824 @item
825 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
826 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
827 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
828 @item
829 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
830 or later;
831 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib};
832 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
833 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
834 @item
835 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
836 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.3.0
837 or later;
838 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
839 4.3.0 or later;
840 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
841 @end itemize
842
843 The following dependencies are optional:
844
845 @itemize
846 @item
847 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
848 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
849 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
850 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
851 version 0.13.0 or later.
852
853 @item
854 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
855 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
856
857 @item
858 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
859 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
860 @end itemize
861
862 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
863 following packages are also needed:
864
865 @itemize
866 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
867 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
868 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
869 C++11 standard.
870 @end itemize
871
872 @cindex state directory
873 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
874 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
875 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
876 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
877 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
878 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
879 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
880 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
881
882 @node Running the Test Suite
883 @section Running the Test Suite
884
885 @cindex test suite
886 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
887 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
888 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
889 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
890 suite, type:
891
892 @example
893 make check
894 @end example
895
896 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
897 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
898 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
899 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
900 cache.
901
902 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
903 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
904
905 @example
906 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
907 @end example
908
909 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
910 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
911 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
912
913 @example
914 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
915 @end example
916
917 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
918 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
919 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
920 your message.
921
922 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
923 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
924 Guix is already installed, using:
925
926 @example
927 make check-system
928 @end example
929
930 @noindent
931 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
932
933 @example
934 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
935 @end example
936
937 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
938 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
939 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
940 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
941 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
942 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
943
944 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
945 all the details.
946
947 @node Setting Up the Daemon
948 @section Setting Up the Daemon
949
950 @cindex daemon
951 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
952 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
953 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
954 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
955 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
956 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
957 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
958
959 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
960 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
961 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
962
963 @menu
964 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
965 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
966 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
967 @end menu
968
969 @node Build Environment Setup
970 @subsection Build Environment Setup
971
972 @cindex build environment
973 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
974 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
975 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
976 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
977 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
978 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
979 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
980
981 @cindex build users
982 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
983 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
984 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
985 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
986 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
987 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
988 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
989 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
990 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
991 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
992
993 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
994 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
995
996 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
997 @c for why `-G' is needed.
998 @example
999 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1000 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
1001 do
1002 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1003 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
1004 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1005 guixbuilder$i;
1006 done
1007 @end example
1008
1009 @noindent
1010 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1011 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1012 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1013 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1014 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1015 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1016 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1017
1018 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1019 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1020 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1021 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1022 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1023 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1024 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1025 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1026
1027 @example
1028 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1029 @end example
1030
1031 @cindex chroot
1032 @noindent
1033 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1034 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1035 environment contains nothing but:
1036
1037 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1038 @itemize
1039 @item
1040 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1041 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1042 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1043 can only be created if the host has them.};
1044
1045 @item
1046 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1047 since a separate PID name space is used;
1048
1049 @item
1050 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1051 user @file{nobody};
1052
1053 @item
1054 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1055
1056 @item
1057 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1058 @code{127.0.0.1};
1059
1060 @item
1061 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1065 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1066 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1067 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1068 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1069 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1070 capture the name of their build tree.
1071
1072 @vindex http_proxy
1073 @vindex https_proxy
1074 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1075 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1076 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1077 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1078
1079 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1080 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1081 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1082 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1083 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1084 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1085 @emph{pure} functions.
1086
1087
1088 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1089 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1090
1091 @cindex offloading
1092 @cindex build hook
1093 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1094 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1095 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1096 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1097 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1098 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1099 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1100 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1101 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1102 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1103 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1104 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1105 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1106 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1107 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1108 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1109 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1110 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1111
1112 @enumerate
1113 @item
1114 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1115 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1116 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1117
1118 @item
1119 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1120 @code{build-machine} object.
1121
1122 @item
1123 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1124 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1125 @code{build-machine} object.
1126
1127 @item
1128 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1129 @end enumerate
1130
1131 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1132
1133 @lisp
1134 (list (build-machine
1135 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1136 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1137 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1138 (user "bob")
1139 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1140
1141 (build-machine
1142 (name "armeight.example.org")
1143 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1144 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1145 (user "alice")
1146 (private-key
1147 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1148 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1149 @end lisp
1150
1151 @noindent
1152 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1153 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1154 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1155
1156 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1157 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1158 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1159 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1160 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1161 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1162 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1163 detailed below.
1164
1165 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1166 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1167 builds. The important fields are:
1168
1169 @table @code
1170
1171 @item name
1172 The host name of the remote machine.
1173
1174 @item systems
1175 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1176 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1177
1178 @item user
1179 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1180 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1181 allow non-interactive logins.
1182
1183 @item host-key
1184 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1185 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1186 long string that looks like this:
1187
1188 @example
1189 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1190 @end example
1191
1192 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1193 key can be found in a file such as
1194 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1195
1196 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1197 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1198 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1199 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1200
1201 @example
1202 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1203 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1204 @end example
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1209
1210 @table @asis
1211
1212 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1213 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1214
1215 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1216 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1217 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1218
1219 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1220 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1221
1222 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1223 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1224 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1225
1226 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1227 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1228
1229 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1230 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1231 to on that machine.
1232
1233 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1234 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1235 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1236 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1237 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1238 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1239
1240 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1241 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1242
1243 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1244 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1245 machines with a higher speed factor.
1246
1247 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1248 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1249 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1250 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1251 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1252
1253 @end table
1254 @end deftp
1255
1256 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1257 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1258
1259 @example
1260 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1261 @end example
1262
1263 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1264 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1265 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1266 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1267 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1268
1269 @example
1270 # guix archive --generate-key
1271 @end example
1272
1273 @noindent
1274 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1275 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1276
1277 @example
1278 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1279 @end example
1280
1281 @noindent
1282 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1283
1284 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1285 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1286 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1287 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1288 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1289
1290 @cindex offload test
1291 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1292 master node:
1293
1294 @example
1295 # guix offload test
1296 @end example
1297
1298 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1299 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1300 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1301 from it, and report any error in the process.
1302
1303 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1304 command line:
1305
1306 @example
1307 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1308 @end example
1309
1310 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1311 regular expression like this:
1312
1313 @example
1314 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1315 @end example
1316
1317 @cindex offload status
1318 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1319 main node:
1320
1321 @example
1322 # guix offload status
1323 @end example
1324
1325
1326 @node SELinux Support
1327 @subsection SELinux Support
1328
1329 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1330 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1331 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1332 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1333 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1334 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1335 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1336 be used on Guix System.
1337
1338 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1339 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1340 To install the policy run this command as root:
1341
1342 @example
1343 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1344 @end example
1345
1346 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1347 mechanism provided by your system.
1348
1349 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1350 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1351 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1352 command:
1353
1354 @example
1355 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1356 @end example
1357
1358 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1359 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1360 operations.
1361
1362 @subsubsection Limitations
1363 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1364
1365 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1366 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1367 the Guix daemon.
1368
1369 @enumerate
1370 @item
1371 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1372 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1373 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1374 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1375
1376 @item
1377 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1378 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1379 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1380 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1381 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1382 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1383 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1384 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1385 reading and following these links.
1386
1387 @item
1388 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1389 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1390 differently from files.
1391
1392 @item
1393 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1394 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1395 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1396 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1397 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1398 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1399 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1400 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1401 allowed for processes in that domain.
1402
1403 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1404 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1405 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1406 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1407
1408 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1409 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1410 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1411 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1412 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1413 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1414 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1415 @end enumerate
1416
1417 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1418 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1419
1420 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1421 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1422 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1423 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1424
1425 @example
1426 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1427 @end example
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1431
1432 @cindex chroot
1433 @cindex container, build environment
1434 @cindex build environment
1435 @cindex reproducible builds
1436 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1437 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1438 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1439 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1440 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1441 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1442 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1443 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1444 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1445 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1446 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1447
1448 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1449 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1450 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1451 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1452 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1453
1454 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1455 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1456 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1457
1458 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1459 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1460 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1461 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1462 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1463
1464 The following command-line options are supported:
1465
1466 @table @code
1467 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1468 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1469 the Daemon, build users}).
1470
1471 @item --no-substitutes
1472 @cindex substitutes
1473 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1474 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1475 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1476
1477 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1478 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1479 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1480
1481 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1482 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1483 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1484 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1485 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1486
1487 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1488 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1489
1490 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1491 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1492
1493 @cindex offloading
1494 @item --no-offload
1495 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1496 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1497 builds to remote machines.
1498
1499 @item --cache-failures
1500 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1501
1502 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1503 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1504 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1505 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1506
1507 @item --cores=@var{n}
1508 @itemx -c @var{n}
1509 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1510 as available.
1511
1512 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1513 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1514 guix build}).
1515
1516 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1517 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1518 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1519
1520 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1521 @itemx -M @var{n}
1522 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1523 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1524 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1525 Setup}), or simply fail.
1526
1527 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1528 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1529 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1530
1531 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1532
1533 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1534 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1535
1536 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1537 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1538 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1539
1540 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1541
1542 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1543 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1544
1545 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1546 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1547 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1548 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1549 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1550
1551 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1552 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1553 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1554
1555 @item --debug
1556 Produce debugging output.
1557
1558 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1559 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1560 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1561
1562 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1563 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1564
1565 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1566 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1567 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1568 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1569 needs.
1570
1571 @item --disable-chroot
1572 Disable chroot builds.
1573
1574 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1575 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1576 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1577 account.
1578
1579 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1580 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1581 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1582
1583 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1584 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1585 them with Bzip2 by default.
1586
1587 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1588 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1589 and DNS-SD.
1590
1591 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1592 considerations.
1593
1594 @enumerate
1595 @item
1596 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1597 @item
1598 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1599 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1600 @item
1601 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1602 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1603 installing;
1604 @item
1605 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1606 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1607 @end enumerate
1608
1609 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1610 run-time by running:
1611
1612 @example
1613 herd discover guix-daemon on
1614 herd discover guix-daemon off
1615 @end example
1616
1617 @item --disable-deduplication
1618 @cindex deduplication
1619 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1620
1621 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1622 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1623 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1624 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1625 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1626 this optimization.
1627
1628 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1629 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1630 derivations.
1631
1632 @cindex GC roots
1633 @cindex garbage collector roots
1634 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1635 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1636 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1637 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1638 roots.
1639
1640 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1641 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1642 corresponding to live outputs.
1643
1644 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1645 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1646 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1647 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1648 space.
1649
1650 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1651 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1652 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1653 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1654 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1655 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1656 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1657 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1658
1659 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1660 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1661 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1662
1663 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1664 on the kernel version number.
1665
1666 @item --lose-logs
1667 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1668 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1669
1670 @item --system=@var{system}
1671 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1672 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1673 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1674
1675 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1676 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1677 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1678 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1679 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1680
1681 @table @code
1682 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1683 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1684 creating it if needed.
1685
1686 @item --listen=localhost
1687 @cindex daemon, remote access
1688 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1689 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1690 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1691 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1692 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1693
1694 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1695 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1696 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1697 @end table
1698
1699 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1700 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1701 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1702 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1703 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1704
1705 @quotation Note
1706 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1707 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1708 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1709 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1710 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1711 @end quotation
1712
1713 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1714 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1715 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1716 @end table
1717
1718
1719 @node Application Setup
1720 @section Application Setup
1721
1722 @cindex foreign distro
1723 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1724 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1725 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1726
1727 @subsection Locales
1728
1729 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1730 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1731 @vindex LOCPATH
1732 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1733 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1734 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1735 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1736 variable:
1737
1738 @example
1739 $ guix install glibc-locales
1740 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1741 @end example
1742
1743 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1744 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1745 917@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1746 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1747
1748 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1749 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1750 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1751
1752 @enumerate
1753 @item
1754 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1755 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1756 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1757 incompatible locale data.
1758
1759 @item
1760 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1761 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1762 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1763 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1764 data in the right format.
1765 @end enumerate
1766
1767 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1768 versions may be incompatible.
1769
1770 @subsection Name Service Switch
1771
1772 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1773 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1774 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1775 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1776 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1777 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1778 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1779 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1780 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1781 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1782
1783 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1784 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1785 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1786 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1787 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1788
1789 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1790 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1791 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1792 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1793 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1794 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1795 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1796 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1797 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1798 Reference Manual}).
1799
1800 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1801 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1802 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1803 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1804 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1805 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1806 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1807 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1808 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1809
1810 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1811 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1812 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1813 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1814
1815 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1816 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1817 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1818 themselves.
1819
1820 @subsection X11 Fonts
1821
1822 @cindex fonts
1823 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1824 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1825 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1826 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1827 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1828 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1829 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1830
1831 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1832 @cindex font cache
1833 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1834 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1835 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1836
1837 @example
1838 guix install fontconfig
1839 fc-cache -rv
1840 @end example
1841
1842 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1843 graphical applications, consider installing
1844 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1845 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1846 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1847 for Chinese languages:
1848
1849 @example
1850 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1851 @end example
1852
1853 @cindex @code{xterm}
1854 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1855 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1856 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1857
1858 @example
1859 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1860 @end example
1861
1862 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1863 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1864
1865 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1866 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1867 @example
1868 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1869 @end example
1870
1871 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1872 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1873 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1874
1875
1876 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1877
1878 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1879 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1880 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1881
1882 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1883 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1884 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1885 information.
1886
1887 @subsection Emacs Packages
1888
1889 @cindex @code{emacs}
1890 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1891 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1892 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1893 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1894 set when installing Emacs itself.
1895
1896 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1897 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1898 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1899 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1900 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1901 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1902
1903
1904 @node Upgrading Guix
1905 @section Upgrading Guix
1906
1907 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1908
1909 To upgrade Guix, run:
1910
1911 @example
1912 guix pull
1913 @end example
1914
1915 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1916
1917 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1918 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1919 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1920
1921 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1922
1923 @example
1924 sudo -i guix pull
1925 @end example
1926
1927 @noindent
1928 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1929 tool):
1930
1931 @example
1932 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1933 @end example
1934
1935 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1936 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1937
1938 @c TODO What else?
1939
1940 @c *********************************************************************
1941 @node System Installation
1942 @chapter System Installation
1943
1944 @cindex installing Guix System
1945 @cindex Guix System, installation
1946 This section explains how to install Guix System
1947 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1948 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1949 @pxref{Installation}.
1950
1951 @ifinfo
1952 @quotation Note
1953 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1954 @c installation image.
1955 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1956 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1957 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1958 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1959
1960 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1961 available.
1962 @end quotation
1963 @end ifinfo
1964
1965 @menu
1966 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1967 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1968 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1969 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1970 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1971 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1972 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1973 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1974 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1975 @end menu
1976
1977 @node Limitations
1978 @section Limitations
1979
1980 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1981 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1982 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1983
1984 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1985 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1986
1987 @itemize
1988 @item
1989 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1990 may be missing.
1991
1992 @item
1993 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1994 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1995 missing.
1996 @end itemize
1997
1998 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1999 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2000 info.
2001
2002
2003 @node Hardware Considerations
2004 @section Hardware Considerations
2005
2006 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2007 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2008 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2009 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2010 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2011 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2012 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2013 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2014 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2015
2016 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2017 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2018 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2019 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2020 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2021 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2022 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2023 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2024 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2025
2026 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2027 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2028 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2029 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2030 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2031 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2032
2033 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2034 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2035 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2036
2037
2038 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2039 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2040
2041 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2042 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2043 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
2044 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2045
2046 @table @code
2047 @item x86_64-linux
2048 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2049
2050 @item i686-linux
2051 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2052 @end table
2053
2054 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2055 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2056 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2057
2058 @example
2059 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2060 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2061 @end example
2062
2063 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2064 then run this command to import it:
2065
2066 @example
2067 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2068 -qO - | gpg --import -
2069 @end example
2070
2071 @noindent
2072 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2073
2074 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2075 signature!'' is normal.
2076
2077 @c end duplication
2078
2079 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2080 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2081
2082 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2083
2084 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
2085
2086 @enumerate
2087 @item
2088 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2089
2090 @example
2091 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2092 @end example
2093
2094 @item
2095 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2096 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2097 copy the image with:
2098
2099 @example
2100 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2101 sync
2102 @end example
2103
2104 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2105 @end enumerate
2106
2107 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2108
2109 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
2110
2111 @enumerate
2112 @item
2113 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2114
2115 @example
2116 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2117 @end example
2118
2119 @item
2120 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2121 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2122 copy the image with:
2123
2124 @example
2125 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2126 @end example
2127
2128 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2129 @end enumerate
2130
2131 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2132
2133 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2134 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2135 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2136 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2137 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2138
2139 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2140 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2141
2142
2143 @node Preparing for Installation
2144 @section Preparing for Installation
2145
2146 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2147 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2148 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2149 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2150 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2151
2152 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2153 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2154 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2155 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2156 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2157 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2158 with the middle button.
2159
2160 @quotation Note
2161 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2162 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2163 ``Networking'' section below.
2164 @end quotation
2165
2166 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2167 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2168
2169 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2170 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2171
2172 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2173 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2174 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2175 the networking dialog.
2176
2177 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2178
2179 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2180 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2181 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2182 things.
2183
2184 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2185
2186 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2187 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2188
2189 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2190
2191 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2192 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2193 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2194 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2195
2196
2197 @node Manual Installation
2198 @section Manual Installation
2199
2200 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2201 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2202 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2203 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2204 Installation}).
2205
2206 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2207 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2208 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2209 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2210 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2211
2212 @menu
2213 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2214 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2215 @end menu
2216
2217 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2218 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2219
2220 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2221 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2222 guide you through this.
2223
2224 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2225
2226 @cindex keyboard layout
2227 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2228 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2229 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2230
2231 @example
2232 loadkeys dvorak
2233 @end example
2234
2235 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2236 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2237 more information.
2238
2239 @subsubsection Networking
2240
2241 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2242
2243 @example
2244 ifconfig -a
2245 @end example
2246
2247 @noindent
2248 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2249
2250 @example
2251 ip address
2252 @end example
2253
2254 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2255 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2256 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2257 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2258 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2259
2260 @table @asis
2261 @item Wired connection
2262 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2263 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2264
2265 @example
2266 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2267 @end example
2268
2269 @noindent
2270 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2271
2272 @example
2273 ip link set @var{interface} up
2274 @end example
2275
2276 @item Wireless connection
2277 @cindex wireless
2278 @cindex WiFi
2279 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2280 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2281 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2282 @command{nano}:
2283
2284 @example
2285 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2286 @end example
2287
2288 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2289 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2290 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2291
2292 @example
2293 network=@{
2294 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2295 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2296 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2297 @}
2298 @end example
2299
2300 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2301 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2302 network interface you want to use):
2303
2304 @example
2305 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2306 @end example
2307
2308 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2309 @end table
2310
2311 @cindex DHCP
2312 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2313 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2314
2315 @example
2316 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2317 @end example
2318
2319 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2320
2321 @example
2322 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2323 @end example
2324
2325 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2326 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2327
2328 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2329 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2330 following command:
2331
2332 @example
2333 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2334 @end example
2335
2336 @noindent
2337 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2338 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2339
2340 @cindex installing over SSH
2341 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2342 an SSH server:
2343
2344 @example
2345 herd start ssh-daemon
2346 @end example
2347
2348 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2349 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2350
2351 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2352
2353 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2354 then format the target partition(s).
2355
2356 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2357 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2358 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2359 the partition layout you want:
2360
2361 @example
2362 cfdisk
2363 @end example
2364
2365 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2366 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2367 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2368 manual}).
2369
2370 @cindex EFI, installation
2371 @cindex UEFI, installation
2372 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2373 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2374 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2375 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2376
2377 @example
2378 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2379 @end example
2380
2381 @quotation Note
2382 @vindex grub-bootloader
2383 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2384 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2385 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2386 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2387 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2388 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2389 bootloaders.
2390 @end quotation
2391
2392 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2393 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2394 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2395 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2396 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2397 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2398
2399 @example
2400 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2401 @end example
2402
2403 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2404 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2405 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2406 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2407 deduplication}).
2408
2409 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2410 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2411 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2412 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2413 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2414 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2415
2416 @example
2417 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2418 @end example
2419
2420 @cindex encrypted disk
2421 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2422 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2423 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2424 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2425 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2426 be along these lines:
2427
2428 @example
2429 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2430 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2431 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2432 @end example
2433
2434 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2435 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2436 root file system):
2437
2438 @example
2439 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2440 @end example
2441
2442 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2443 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2444 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2445 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2446
2447 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2448 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2449 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2450 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2451
2452 @example
2453 mkswap /dev/sda3
2454 swapon /dev/sda3
2455 @end example
2456
2457 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2458 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2459 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2460 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2461 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2462 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2463
2464 @example
2465 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2466 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2467 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2468 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2469 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2470 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2471 @end example
2472
2473 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2474 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2475 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2476
2477 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2478 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2479
2480 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2481 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2482
2483 @example
2484 herd start cow-store /mnt
2485 @end example
2486
2487 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2488 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2489 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2490 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2491 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2492
2493 Next, you have to edit a file and
2494 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2495 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2496 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2497 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2498 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2499 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2500 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2501 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2502 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2503
2504 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2505 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2506 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2507 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2508 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2509 something along these lines:
2510
2511 @example
2512 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2513 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2514 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2515 @end example
2516
2517 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2518 in particular:
2519
2520 @itemize
2521 @item
2522 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2523 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2524 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2525 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2526 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2527 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2528 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2529 configuration.
2530
2531 @item
2532 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2533 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2534 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2535 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2536
2537 @item
2538 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2539 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2540 @end itemize
2541
2542 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2543 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2544 under @file{/mnt}):
2545
2546 @example
2547 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2548 @end example
2549
2550 @noindent
2551 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2552 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2553 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2554 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2555
2556 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2557 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2558 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2559 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2560 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2561 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2562 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2563
2564
2565 @node After System Installation
2566 @section After System Installation
2567
2568 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2569 system whenever you want by running, say:
2570
2571 @example
2572 guix pull
2573 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2574 @end example
2575
2576 @noindent
2577 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2578 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2579 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2580
2581 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2582 @quotation Note
2583 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2584 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2585 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2586 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2587
2588 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2589 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is ran
2590 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2591 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2592 @end quotation
2593
2594 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2595 join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2596 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2597
2598
2599 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2600 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2601
2602 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2603 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2604 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2605 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2606 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2607 section is for you.
2608
2609 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2610 disk image, follow these steps:
2611
2612 @enumerate
2613 @item
2614 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2615 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2616
2617 @item
2618 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2619 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2620
2621 @example
2622 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2623 @end example
2624
2625 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2626 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2627
2628 @item
2629 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2630
2631 @example
2632 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2633 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2634 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2635 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2636 @end example
2637
2638 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2639 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2640
2641 @item
2642 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2643 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2644 @end enumerate
2645
2646 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2647 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2648 that.
2649
2650 @node Building the Installation Image
2651 @section Building the Installation Image
2652
2653 @cindex installation image
2654 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2655 system} command, specifically:
2656
2657 @example
2658 guix system disk-image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2659 @end example
2660
2661 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2662 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2663 about the installation image.
2664
2665 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2666
2667 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2668 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2669
2670 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2671 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2672 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2673
2674 @example
2675 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2676 @end example
2677
2678 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2679 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2680
2681 @c *********************************************************************
2682 @node Getting Started
2683 @chapter Getting Started
2684
2685 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2686 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2687 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2688 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2689 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2690
2691 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2692 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2693 for a text editor, you can run:
2694
2695 @example
2696 guix search text editor
2697 @end example
2698
2699 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2700 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2701 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2702 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2703 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2704
2705 @example
2706 guix install emacs
2707 @end example
2708
2709 You've installed your first package, congrats! In the process, you've
2710 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2711 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2712 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2713
2714 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2715 have printed this hint:
2716
2717 @example
2718 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2719
2720 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2721 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2722
2723 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2724 @end example
2725
2726 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2727 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2728 above will do just that: it will add
2729 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2730 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2731 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2732 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2733 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2734 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2735 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2736 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2737 will be defined.
2738
2739 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2740 packages, run:
2741
2742 @example
2743 guix package --list-installed
2744 @end example
2745
2746 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2747 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2748 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2749
2750 @example
2751 guix package --roll-back
2752 @end example
2753
2754 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2755 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2756 between them can be displayed by running:
2757
2758 @example
2759 guix package --list-generations
2760 @end example
2761
2762 Now you know the basics of package management!
2763
2764 @quotation Going further
2765 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2766 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2767 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2768 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2769 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2770 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2771 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2772 @end quotation
2773
2774 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2775 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2776 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2777
2778 @example
2779 guix pull
2780 @end example
2781
2782 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2783 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2784 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2785 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2786 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2787
2788 @example
2789 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current/etc/profile"
2790 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2791 @end example
2792
2793 @noindent
2794 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2795
2796 @example
2797 hash guix
2798 @end example
2799
2800 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2801 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2802
2803 @example
2804 guix upgrade
2805 @end example
2806
2807 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2808 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2809 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2810 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2811
2812 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2813 running:
2814
2815 @example
2816 guix describe
2817 @end example
2818
2819 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2820 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2821 machine.
2822
2823 @quotation Going further
2824 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2825 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2826 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2827 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2828 @end quotation
2829
2830 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2831 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2832 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2833
2834 @example
2835 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2836 @end example
2837
2838 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2839 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2840 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2841 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2842 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2843 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2844 @emph{of the whole system}:
2845
2846 @example
2847 sudo guix system roll-back
2848 @end example
2849
2850 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2851 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2852 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2853 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2854 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2855
2856 Now you know enough to get started!
2857
2858 @quotation Resources
2859 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2860 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2861
2862 @itemize
2863 @item
2864 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2865 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2866
2867 @item
2868 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2869 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2870 need.
2871
2872 @item
2873 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2874 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2875 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2876
2877 @item
2878 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2879 computer.
2880 @end itemize
2881
2882 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2883 @end quotation
2884
2885 @c *********************************************************************
2886 @node Package Management
2887 @chapter Package Management
2888
2889 @cindex packages
2890 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2891 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2892 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2893 features.
2894
2895 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2896 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2897 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2898 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2899 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2900 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2901 with it):
2902
2903 @example
2904 guix install emacs-guix
2905 @end example
2906
2907 @menu
2908 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2909 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2910 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2911 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2912 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2913 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2914 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2915 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2916 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2917 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2918 @end menu
2919
2920 @node Features
2921 @section Features
2922
2923 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2924 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2925 going on under the hood.
2926
2927 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2928 own directory---something that resembles
2929 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2930
2931 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2932 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2933 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2934 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2935
2936 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2937 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2938 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2939 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2940 simply continues to point to
2941 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2942 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2943
2944 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2945 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2946 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2947
2948 @cindex transactions
2949 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2950 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2951 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2952 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2953 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2954 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2955
2956 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2957 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2958 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2959 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2960 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2961 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2962 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2963
2964 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2965 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2966 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2967 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2968 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2969 collected.
2970
2971 @cindex reproducibility
2972 @cindex reproducible builds
2973 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2974 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2975 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2976 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2977 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2978 given package installation matches the current state of their
2979 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2980 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2981 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2982 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2983
2984 @cindex substitutes
2985 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2986 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2987 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2988 downloads it and unpacks it;
2989 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2990 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2991 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2992 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2993 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2994
2995 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2996 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2997 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2998 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2999 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3000
3001 @cindex replication, of software environments
3002 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3003 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3004 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3005 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3006 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3007 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3008 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3009
3010 @node Invoking guix package
3011 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3012
3013 @cindex installing packages
3014 @cindex removing packages
3015 @cindex package installation
3016 @cindex package removal
3017 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3018 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3019 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
3020 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3021 is:
3022
3023 @example
3024 guix package @var{options}
3025 @end example
3026
3027 @cindex transactions
3028 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3029 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3030 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3031 want to roll back.
3032
3033 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3034 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3035
3036 @example
3037 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3038 @end example
3039
3040 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3041 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3042
3043 @itemize
3044 @item
3045 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3046 @item
3047 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3048 @item
3049 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3050 @item
3051 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3052 @item
3053 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3054 @end itemize
3055
3056 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3057 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3058 package} directly.
3059
3060 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3061 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3062 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3063 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3064
3065 @cindex profile
3066 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3067 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3068 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3069 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3070 variable, and so on.
3071 @cindex search paths
3072 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3073 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3074 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3075 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3076
3077 @example
3078 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3079 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
3080 @end example
3081
3082 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3083 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3084 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3085 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3086 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3087 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3088 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3089 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3090 package}.
3091
3092 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3093
3094 @table @code
3095
3096 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3097 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3098 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3099
3100 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3101 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3102 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3103 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3104
3105 If no version number is specified, the
3106 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3107 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3108 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3109 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3110 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3111 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3112
3113 @cindex propagated inputs
3114 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3115 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3116 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3117 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3118 package definitions).
3119
3120 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3121 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3122 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3123 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3124 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3125 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3126
3127 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3128 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3129 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3130 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3131
3132 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3133 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3134 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3135
3136 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3137 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3138 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3139 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3140
3141 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3142 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3143 multiple-output package.
3144
3145 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3146 @itemx -f @var{file}
3147 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3148
3149 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3150 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3151
3152 @lisp
3153 @include package-hello.scm
3154 @end lisp
3155
3156 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3157 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3158 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3159 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3160
3161 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3162 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3163 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3164 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3165
3166 @example
3167 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3168 @end example
3169
3170 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3171 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3172 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3173
3174 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3175 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3176 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3177 @code{glibc}.
3178
3179 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3180 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3181 @cindex upgrading packages
3182 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3183 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3184 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3185
3186 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3187 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3188 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3189 pull}).
3190
3191 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3192 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3193 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3194 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3195 from the tip of its development branch with:
3196
3197 @example
3198 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3199 @end example
3200
3201 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3202 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3203 checkout.
3204
3205 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3206 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3207 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3208 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3209
3210 @example
3211 guix install @var{package}
3212 @end example
3213
3214 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3215 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3216 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3217 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3218 substring ``emacs'':
3219
3220 @example
3221 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3222 @end example
3223
3224 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3225 @itemx -m @var{file}
3226 @cindex profile declaration
3227 @cindex profile manifest
3228 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3229 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3230 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3231
3232 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3233 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3234 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3235 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3236 so on.
3237
3238 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3239 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3240 of packages:
3241
3242 @findex packages->manifest
3243 @lisp
3244 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3245
3246 (packages->manifest
3247 (list emacs
3248 guile-2.0
3249 ;; Use a specific package output.
3250 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3251 @end lisp
3252
3253 @findex specifications->manifest
3254 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3255 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3256 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3257 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3258 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3259 objects, like this:
3260
3261 @lisp
3262 (specifications->manifest
3263 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3264 @end lisp
3265
3266 @item --roll-back
3267 @cindex rolling back
3268 @cindex undoing transactions
3269 @cindex transactions, undoing
3270 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3271 the last transaction.
3272
3273 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3274 before any other actions.
3275
3276 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3277 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3278 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3279
3280 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3281 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3282 generations in a profile is always linear.
3283
3284 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3285 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3286 @cindex generations
3287 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3288
3289 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3290 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3291 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3292 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3293 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3294
3295 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3296 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3297 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3298 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3299
3300 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3301 @cindex search paths
3302 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3303 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3304 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3305 of the installed packages.
3306
3307 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3308 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3309 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3310 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3311 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3312 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3313 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3314
3315 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3316 shell:
3317
3318 @example
3319 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3320 @end example
3321
3322 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3323 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3324 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3325 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3326
3327 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3328 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3329
3330 @example
3331 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3332 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3333 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3334 @end example
3335
3336 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3337 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3338 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3339
3340
3341 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3342 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3343 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3344
3345 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3346 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3347 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3348 installed:
3349
3350 @example
3351 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3352 @dots{}
3353 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3354 Hello, world!
3355 @end example
3356
3357 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3358 siblings that point to specific generations:
3359
3360 @example
3361 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3362 @end example
3363
3364 @item --list-profiles
3365 List all the user's profiles:
3366
3367 @example
3368 $ guix package --list-profiles
3369 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3370 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3371 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3372 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3373 @end example
3374
3375 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3376
3377 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3378 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3379 @cindex profile collisions
3380 @item --allow-collisions
3381 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3382
3383 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3384 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3385 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3386
3387 @item --bootstrap
3388 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3389 useful to distribution developers.
3390
3391 @end table
3392
3393 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3394 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3395 availability of packages:
3396
3397 @table @option
3398
3399 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3400 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3401 @anchor{guix-search}
3402 @cindex searching for packages
3403 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3404 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3405 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3406 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3407 GNU recutils manual}).
3408
3409 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3410 command, for instance:
3411
3412 @example
3413 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3414 name: jemalloc
3415 version: 4.5.0
3416 relevance: 6
3417
3418 name: glibc
3419 version: 2.25
3420 relevance: 1
3421
3422 name: libgc
3423 version: 7.6.0
3424 relevance: 1
3425 @end example
3426
3427 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3428 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3429
3430 @example
3431 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3432 name: elfutils
3433
3434 name: gmp
3435 @dots{}
3436 @end example
3437
3438 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3439 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3440 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3441 the @command{guix search} alias):
3442
3443 @example
3444 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3445 name: gnubg
3446 @dots{}
3447 @end example
3448
3449 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3450 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3451 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3452 keyboards.
3453
3454 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3455 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3456 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3457
3458 @example
3459 $ guix search crypto library | \
3460 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3461 @end example
3462
3463 @noindent
3464 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3465 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3466
3467 @item --show=@var{package}
3468 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3469 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3470 recutils manual}).
3471
3472 @example
3473 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3474 name: python
3475 version: 2.7.6
3476
3477 name: python
3478 version: 3.3.5
3479 @end example
3480
3481 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3482 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3483 @example
3484 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3485 name: python
3486 version: 3.4.3
3487 @end example
3488
3489
3490
3491 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3492 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3493 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3494 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3495 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3496
3497 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3498 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3499 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3500 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3501 the store.
3502
3503 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3504 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3505 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3506 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3507 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3508
3509 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3510 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3511 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3512
3513 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3514 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3515 @cindex generations
3516 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3517 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3518 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3519 shown.
3520
3521 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3522 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3523 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3524 location of this package in the store.
3525
3526 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3527 generations. Valid patterns include:
3528
3529 @itemize
3530 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3531 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3532 the first one.
3533
3534 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3535 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3536
3537 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3538 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3539 a range must be smaller than its end.
3540
3541 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3542 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3543 second one.
3544
3545 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3546 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3547 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3548 that are up to 20 days old.
3549 @end itemize
3550
3551 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3552 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3553 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3554 one.
3555
3556 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3557 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3558 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3559 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3560 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3561
3562 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3563 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3564
3565 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3566 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3567
3568 @end table
3569
3570 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3571 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3572 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3573 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3574 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3575 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3576 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3577 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3578
3579 @node Substitutes
3580 @section Substitutes
3581
3582 @cindex substitutes
3583 @cindex pre-built binaries
3584 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3585 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3586 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3587 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3588 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3589
3590 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3591 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3592 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3593 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3594
3595 @menu
3596 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3597 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3598 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3599 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3600 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3601 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3602 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3603 @end menu
3604
3605 @node Official Substitute Server
3606 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3607
3608 @cindex build farm
3609 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3610 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3611 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3612 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3613 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3614 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3615 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3616 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3617 option}).
3618
3619 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3620 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3621 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3622 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3623 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3624
3625 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3626 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3627 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3628 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3629 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3630 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3631 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3632 other substitute server.
3633
3634 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3635 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3636
3637 @cindex security
3638 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3639 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3640 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3641 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3642 mirror thereof, you
3643 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3644 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3645 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3646 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3647
3648 @quotation Note
3649 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3650 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} by default.
3651 @end quotation
3652
3653 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3654 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3655 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3656 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3657 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3658 Then, you can run something like this:
3659
3660 @example
3661 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3662 @end example
3663
3664 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3665 should change from something like:
3666
3667 @example
3668 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3669 The following derivations would be built:
3670 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3671 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3672 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3673 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3674 @dots{}
3675 @end example
3676
3677 @noindent
3678 to something like:
3679
3680 @example
3681 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3682 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3683 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3684 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3685 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3686 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3687 @dots{}
3688 @end example
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3692 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3693 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3694 possible, for future builds.
3695
3696 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3697 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3698 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3699 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3700 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3701 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3702
3703 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3704 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3705
3706 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3707 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3708 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3709 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3710 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3711 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3712 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3713
3714 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3715 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3716 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3717 substitutes they sign.
3718
3719 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3720 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3721 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3722 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3723 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3724 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3725
3726 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3727 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3728 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. The
3729 resulting operating system configuration will look something like:
3730
3731 @lisp
3732 (operating-system
3733 ;; @dots{}
3734 (services
3735 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3736 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3737 (modify-services %desktop-services
3738 (guix-service-type config =>
3739 (guix-configuration
3740 (inherit config)
3741 (substitute-urls
3742 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3743 %default-substitute-urls))
3744 (authorized-keys
3745 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3746 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3747 @end lisp
3748
3749 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3750 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3751 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3752 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3753 changes take effect:
3754
3755 @example
3756 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3757 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3758 @end example
3759
3760 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3761 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3762
3763 @enumerate
3764 @item
3765 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3766 systemd, this is normally
3767 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3768 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3769 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3770 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3771
3772 @example
3773 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'
3774 @end example
3775
3776 @item
3777 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3778
3779 @example
3780 systemctl daemon-reload
3781 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3782 @end example
3783
3784 @item
3785 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3786
3787 @example
3788 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3789 @end example
3790
3791 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3792 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3793 @end enumerate
3794
3795 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3796 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
3797 as a fallback. Of course you can list as many substitute servers as you
3798 like, with the caveat that substitute lookup can be slowed down if too
3799 many servers need to be contacted.
3800
3801 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3802 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3803 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3804
3805 @node Substitute Authentication
3806 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3807
3808 @cindex digital signatures
3809 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3810 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3811 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3812
3813 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3814 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3815 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3816 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3817 with this option:
3818
3819 @example
3820 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3821 @end example
3822
3823 @noindent
3824 @cindex reproducible builds
3825 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3826 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3827 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3828 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3829 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3830 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3831 below).
3832
3833 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3834 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3835 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3836 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3837 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3838 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3839
3840 @node Proxy Settings
3841 @subsection Proxy Settings
3842
3843 @vindex http_proxy
3844 @vindex https_proxy
3845 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS. The @env{http_proxy} and
3846 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3847 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3848 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3849 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3850 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3851
3852 @node Substitution Failure
3853 @subsection Substitution Failure
3854
3855 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3856 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3857 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3858 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3859 etc.
3860
3861 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3862 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3863 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3864 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3865 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3866 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3867 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3868 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3869 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3870 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3871 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3872 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3873 @option{--fallback} was given.
3874
3875 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3876 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3877 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3878 by a server.
3879
3880 @node On Trusting Binaries
3881 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3882
3883 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3884 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3885 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3886 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3887 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3888 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3889 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3890 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3891 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3892 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3893
3894 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3895 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3896 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3897 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3898 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3899 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3900 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3901 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3902 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3903 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3904 @command{guix build --check}}).
3905
3906 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3907 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3908 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3909
3910 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3911 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3912
3913 @cindex multiple-output packages
3914 @cindex package outputs
3915 @cindex outputs
3916
3917 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3918 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3919 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3920 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3921 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3922 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3923 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3924 files.
3925
3926 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3927 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3928 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3929 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3930 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3931 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3932 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3933
3934 @example
3935 guix install glib
3936 @end example
3937
3938 @cindex documentation
3939 The command to install its documentation is:
3940
3941 @example
3942 guix install glib:doc
3943 @end example
3944
3945 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3946 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3947 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3948 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3949 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3950 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3951 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3952 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3953 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3954
3955 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3956 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3957 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3958 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3959 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3960 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3961 guix package}).
3962
3963
3964 @node Invoking guix gc
3965 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3966
3967 @cindex garbage collector
3968 @cindex disk space
3969 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3970 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3971 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3972 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3973 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3974
3975 @cindex GC roots
3976 @cindex garbage collector roots
3977 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3978 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3979 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3980 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3981 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3982 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3983 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3984 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3985
3986 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3987 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3988 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3989 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3990 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3991
3992 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3993 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3994 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3995
3996 @example
3997 guix gc -F 5G
3998 @end example
3999
4000 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4001 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4002 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4003 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4004 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4005 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4006 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4007
4008 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4009 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4010 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4011 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4012 options are as follows:
4013
4014 @table @code
4015 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4016 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4017 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4018 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4019 specified.
4020
4021 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4022 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4023 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4024 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4025
4026 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4027
4028 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4029 @itemx -F @var{free}
4030 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4031 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4032 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4033
4034 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4035 nothing and exit immediately.
4036
4037 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4038 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4039 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4040 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4041 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4042
4043 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4044 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4045 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4046
4047 @example
4048 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4049 @end example
4050
4051 @item --delete
4052 @itemx -D
4053 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4054 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4055 they are still live.
4056
4057 @item --list-failures
4058 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4059
4060 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4061 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4062 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4063
4064 @item --list-roots
4065 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4066 roots.
4067
4068 @item --list-busy
4069 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4070 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4071
4072 @item --clear-failures
4073 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4074
4075 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4076 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4077
4078 @item --list-dead
4079 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4080 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4081
4082 @item --list-live
4083 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4084
4085 @end table
4086
4087 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4088
4089 @table @code
4090
4091 @item --references
4092 @itemx --referrers
4093 @cindex package dependencies
4094 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4095 as arguments.
4096
4097 @item --requisites
4098 @itemx -R
4099 @cindex closure
4100 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4101 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4102 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4103 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4104
4105 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4106 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4107 the graph of references.
4108
4109 @item --derivers
4110 @cindex derivation
4111 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4112 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4113
4114 For example, this command:
4115
4116 @example
4117 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
4118 @end example
4119
4120 @noindent
4121 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4122 installed in your profile.
4123
4124 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4125 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4126 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4127 @end table
4128
4129 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4130 store and to control disk usage.
4131
4132 @table @option
4133
4134 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4135 @cindex integrity, of the store
4136 @cindex integrity checking
4137 Verify the integrity of the store.
4138
4139 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4140 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4141
4142 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4143 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4144
4145 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4146 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4147 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4148 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4149 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4150
4151 @cindex repairing the store
4152 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4153 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4154 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4155 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4156 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4157 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4158 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4159 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4160
4161 @item --optimize
4162 @cindex deduplication
4163 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4164 @dfn{deduplication}.
4165
4166 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4167 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4168 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4169 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4170 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4171
4172 @end table
4173
4174 @node Invoking guix pull
4175 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4176
4177 @cindex upgrading Guix
4178 @cindex updating Guix
4179 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4180 @cindex pull
4181 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4182 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4183 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4184 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4185 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4186 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4187 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4188 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4189 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4190 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4191 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4192
4193 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4194 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4195
4196 @enumerate
4197 @item
4198 the @option{--channels} option;
4199 @item
4200 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4201 @item
4202 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4203 @item
4204 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4205 variable.
4206 @end enumerate
4207
4208 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4209 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4210 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4211 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4212 become available.
4213
4214 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4215 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4216 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4217 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4218 versa.
4219
4220 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4221 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4222 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4223 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4224 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4225
4226 @example
4227 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4228 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4229 @end example
4230
4231 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4232 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4233
4234 @example
4235 $ guix pull -l
4236 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4237 guix 65956ad
4238 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4239 branch: origin/master
4240 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4241
4242 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4243 guix e0cc7f6
4244 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4245 branch: origin/master
4246 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4247 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4248 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4249 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4250 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4251
4252 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4253 guix 844cc1c
4254 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4255 branch: origin/master
4256 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4257 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4258 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4259 @end example
4260
4261 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4262 describe the current status of Guix.
4263
4264 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4265 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4266 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4267 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4268
4269 @example
4270 $ guix pull --roll-back
4271 switched from generation 3 to 2
4272 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4273 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4274 @end example
4275
4276 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4277 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4278 @example
4279 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4280 switched from generation 3 to 2
4281 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4282 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4283 @end example
4284
4285 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4286 but it supports the following options:
4287
4288 @table @code
4289 @item --url=@var{url}
4290 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4291 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4292 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4293 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4294 string), or @var{branch}.
4295
4296 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4297 @cindex configuration file for channels
4298 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4299 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4300 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4301
4302 @item --channels=@var{file}
4303 @itemx -C @var{file}
4304 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4305 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4306 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4307 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4308 information.
4309
4310 @cindex channel news
4311 @item --news
4312 @itemx -N
4313 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4314 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4315 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4316
4317 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4318 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4319 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4320
4321 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4322 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4323 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4324 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4325 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4326 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4327
4328 @item --roll-back
4329 @cindex rolling back
4330 @cindex undoing transactions
4331 @cindex transactions, undoing
4332 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4333 undo the last transaction.
4334
4335 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4336 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4337 @cindex generations
4338 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4339
4340 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4341 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4342 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4343 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4344 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4345
4346 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4347 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4348 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4349 one.
4350
4351 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4352 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4353 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4354 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4355 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4356
4357 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4358
4359 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4360 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4361
4362 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4363 current generation only.
4364
4365 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4366 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4367 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4368
4369 @item --dry-run
4370 @itemx -n
4371 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4372 substituted but do not actually do it.
4373
4374 @item --allow-downgrades
4375 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4376 currently in use.
4377
4378 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4379 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4380 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4381 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4382 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4383
4384 @quotation Note
4385 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4386 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4387 @end quotation
4388
4389 @item --disable-authentication
4390 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4391
4392 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4393 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4394 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4395 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4396 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4397
4398 @quotation Note
4399 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4400 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4401 @end quotation
4402
4403 @item --system=@var{system}
4404 @itemx -s @var{system}
4405 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4406 the system type of the build host.
4407
4408 @item --bootstrap
4409 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4410 useful to Guix developers.
4411 @end table
4412
4413 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4414 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4415 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4416 information.
4417
4418 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4419 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4420
4421 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4422 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4423
4424 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4425 @cindex pinning, channels
4426 @cindex replicating Guix
4427 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4428
4429 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4430 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4431 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4432 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4433 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4434 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4435
4436 The general syntax is:
4437
4438 @example
4439 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4440 @end example
4441
4442 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4443 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4444 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4445
4446 @table @code
4447 @item --url=@var{url}
4448 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4449 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4450 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4451 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4452 string), or @var{branch}.
4453
4454 @item --channels=@var{file}
4455 @itemx -C @var{file}
4456 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4457 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4458 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4459 @end table
4460
4461 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4462 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4463
4464 @example
4465 guix time-machine -- build hello
4466 @end example
4467
4468 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4469 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4470 Time travel works in both directions!
4471
4472 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4473 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4474 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4475
4476 @node Inferiors
4477 @section Inferiors
4478
4479 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4480 @quotation Note
4481 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4482 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4483 @end quotation
4484
4485 @cindex inferiors
4486 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4487 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4488 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4489 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4490 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4491
4492 @cindex inferior packages
4493 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4494 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4495 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4496 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4497 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4498
4499 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4500 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4501 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4502 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4503 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4504 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4505 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4506 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4507 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4508
4509 @lisp
4510 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4511 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4512
4513 (define channels
4514 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4515 ;; extract guile-json.
4516 (list (channel
4517 (name 'guix)
4518 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4519 (commit
4520 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4521
4522 (define inferior
4523 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4524 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4525
4526 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4527 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4528 (packages->manifest
4529 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4530 (specification->package "guile")))
4531 @end lisp
4532
4533 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4534 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4535 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4536
4537 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4538 inferior:
4539
4540 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4541 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4542 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4543 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4544 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4545
4546 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4547 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4548 @end deffn
4549
4550 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4551 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4552 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4553 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4554 the inferior could not be launched.
4555 @end deffn
4556
4557 @cindex inferior packages
4558 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4559 packages.
4560
4561 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4562 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4563 @end deffn
4564
4565 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4566 [@var{version}]
4567 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4568 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4569 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4570 @end deffn
4571
4572 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4573 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4577 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4578 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4579 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4580 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4581 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4582 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4583 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4584 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4585 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4586 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4587 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4588 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4589 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4590 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4591 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4592 these procedures.
4593 @end deffn
4594
4595 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4596 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4597 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4598 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4599 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4600 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4601 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4602 declaration, and so on.
4603
4604 @node Invoking guix describe
4605 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4606
4607 @cindex reproducibility
4608 @cindex replicating Guix
4609 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4610 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4611 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4612 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4613 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4614 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4615 command answers these questions.
4616
4617 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4618 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4619 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4620
4621 @example
4622 $ guix describe
4623 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4624 guix e0fa68c
4625 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4626 branch: master
4627 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4628 @end example
4629
4630 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4631 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4632 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4633 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4634 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4635 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4636 also to replicate it.
4637
4638 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4639 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4640
4641 @example
4642 $ guix describe -f channels
4643 (list (channel
4644 (name 'guix)
4645 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4646 (commit
4647 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4648 (introduction
4649 (make-channel-introduction
4650 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4651 (openpgp-fingerprint
4652 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4653 @end example
4654
4655 @noindent
4656 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4657 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4658 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4659 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4660 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4661 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4662
4663 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4664 follows:
4665
4666 @table @code
4667 @item --format=@var{format}
4668 @itemx -f @var{format}
4669 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4670
4671 @table @code
4672 @item human
4673 produce human-readable output;
4674 @item channels
4675 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4676 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4677 guix pull});
4678 @item channels-sans-intro
4679 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4680 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4681 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4682 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4683 supported by these older versions;
4684 @item json
4685 @cindex JSON
4686 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4687 @item recutils
4688 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @item --list-formats
4692 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4693
4694 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4695 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4696 Display information about @var{profile}.
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @node Invoking guix archive
4700 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4701
4702 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4703 @cindex archive
4704 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4705 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4706 a machine that runs Guix.
4707 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4708 to the store on another machine.
4709
4710 @quotation Note
4711 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4712 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4713 @end quotation
4714
4715 @cindex exporting store items
4716 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4717
4718 @example
4719 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4720 @end example
4721
4722 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4723 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4724 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4725 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4726 output of @code{emacs}:
4727
4728 @example
4729 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4730 @end example
4731
4732 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4733 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4734 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4735
4736 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4737 one would run:
4738
4739 @example
4740 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4741 @end example
4742
4743 @noindent
4744 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4745 to another like this:
4746
4747 @example
4748 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4749 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4750 @end example
4751
4752 @noindent
4753 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4754 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4755 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4756 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4757 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4758 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4759 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4760
4761 @cindex nar, archive format
4762 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4763 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4764 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4765 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4766 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4767 bundle}.
4768
4769 The nar format is
4770 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4771 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4772 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4773 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4774 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4775 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4776 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4777 deterministic.
4778
4779 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4780 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4781 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4782
4783 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4784 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4785 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4786 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4787 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4788
4789 The main options are:
4790
4791 @table @code
4792 @item --export
4793 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4794 resulting archive to the standard output.
4795
4796 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4797 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4798
4799 @item -r
4800 @itemx --recursive
4801 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4802 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4803 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4804 exported store items.
4805
4806 @item --import
4807 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4808 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4809 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4810 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4811
4812 @item --missing
4813 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4814 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4815 the store.
4816
4817 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4818 @cindex signing, archives
4819 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4820 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4821 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4822 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4823 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4824 first boot.
4825
4826 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4827 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4828 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4829 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4830 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4831 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4832 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4833 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4834 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4835
4836 @item --authorize
4837 @cindex authorizing, archives
4838 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4839 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4840 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4841
4842 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4843 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4844 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4845 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4846 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4847 (SPKI)}.
4848
4849 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4850 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4851 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4852 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4853 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4854
4855 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4856 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4857
4858 @example
4859 $ wget -O - \
4860 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4861 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4862 @end example
4863
4864 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4865 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4866 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4867 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4868 unsafe.
4869
4870 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4871 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4872 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4873
4874 @item --list
4875 @itemx -t
4876 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4877 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4878 this example:
4879
4880 @example
4881 $ wget -O - \
4882 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4883 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4884 @end example
4885
4886 @end table
4887
4888 @c *********************************************************************
4889 @node Channels
4890 @chapter Channels
4891
4892 @cindex channels
4893 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4894 @cindex configuration file for channels
4895 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
4896 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
4897 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
4898 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
4899 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
4900 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
4901 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
4902 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
4903 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
4904 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
4905 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
4906 updates.
4907
4908 @menu
4909 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
4910 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
4911 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
4912 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
4913 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
4914 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
4915 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
4916 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
4917 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
4918 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
4919 @end menu
4920
4921 @node Specifying Additional Channels
4922 @section Specifying Additional Channels
4923
4924 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
4925 @cindex variant packages (channels)
4926 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
4927 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
4928 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
4929
4930 @vindex %default-channels
4931 @lisp
4932 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
4933 (cons (channel
4934 (name 'variant-packages)
4935 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
4936 %default-channels)
4937 @end lisp
4938
4939 @noindent
4940 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
4941 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
4942 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
4943 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
4944 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
4945 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
4946 modules:
4947
4948 @example
4949 $ guix pull --list-generations
4950 @dots{}
4951 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
4952 guix d894ab8
4953 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4954 branch: master
4955 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4956 variant-packages dd3df5e
4957 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
4958 branch: master
4959 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4960 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4961 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4962 @end example
4963
4964 @noindent
4965 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4966 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
4967 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
4968 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4969 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4970
4971 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
4972 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
4973
4974 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
4975 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
4976 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
4977 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
4978 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
4979
4980 @lisp
4981 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
4982 (list (channel
4983 (name 'guix)
4984 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
4985 (branch "super-hacks")))
4986 @end lisp
4987
4988 @noindent
4989 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
4990 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
4991 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
4992
4993 @node Replicating Guix
4994 @section Replicating Guix
4995
4996 @cindex pinning, channels
4997 @cindex replicating Guix
4998 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4999 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5000 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5001 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5002 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5003
5004 @lisp
5005 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5006 (list (channel
5007 (name 'guix)
5008 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5009 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5010 (channel
5011 (name 'variant-packages)
5012 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5013 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5014 @end lisp
5015
5016 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5017 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5018 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5019 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5020 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5021
5022 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5023 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5024 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5025 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5026 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5027 package it defines.
5028
5029 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5030 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5031 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5032 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5033
5034 @node Channel Authentication
5035 @section Channel Authentication
5036
5037 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5038 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5039 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5040 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5041 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5042 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5043 lead users to run malicious code.
5044
5045 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5046 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5047 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5048 along these lines:
5049
5050 @lisp
5051 (channel
5052 (name 'some-channel)
5053 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5054 (introduction
5055 (make-channel-introduction
5056 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5057 (openpgp-fingerprint
5058 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5059 @end lisp
5060
5061 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5062 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5063 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5064 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5065
5066 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5067 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5068 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5069 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5070 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5071
5072 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5073
5074 @node Creating a Channel
5075 @section Creating a Channel
5076
5077 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5078 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5079 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5080 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5081 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5082 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5083 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5084 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5085 from. Neat, no?
5086
5087 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5088 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5089 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5090 @quotation Warning
5091 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5092 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5093 of caution:
5094
5095 @itemize
5096 @item
5097 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5098 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5099 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5100 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5101 process.
5102
5103 @item
5104 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5105 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5106 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5107 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5108 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5109 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5110 either.
5111
5112 @item
5113 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5114 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5115 @end itemize
5116
5117 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5118 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5119 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5120 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5121 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5122 @end quotation
5123
5124 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5125 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5126 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5127 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5128 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5129 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5130 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5131 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5132 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5133 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5134
5135 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5136 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5137 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5138 on how to do it.
5139
5140
5141 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5142 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5143
5144 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5145 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5146 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5147 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5148
5149 @lisp
5150 (channel
5151 (version 0)
5152 (directory "guix"))
5153 @end lisp
5154
5155 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5156 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5157
5158 @cindex dependencies, channels
5159 @cindex meta-data, channels
5160 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5161 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5162 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5163 the channel repository.
5164
5165 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5166
5167 @lisp
5168 (channel
5169 (version 0)
5170 (dependencies
5171 (channel
5172 (name 'some-collection)
5173 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5174
5175 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5176 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5177 (introduction
5178 (channel-introduction
5179 (version 0)
5180 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5181 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5182 (channel
5183 (name 'some-other-collection)
5184 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5185 (branch "testing"))))
5186 @end lisp
5187
5188 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5189 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5190 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5191 channels are available.
5192
5193 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5194 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5195 dependencies to a minimum.
5196
5197 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5198 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5199
5200 @cindex channel authorizations
5201 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5202 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5203 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5204 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5205 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5206 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5207 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5208 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5209 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5210 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5211 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5212 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5213 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5214
5215 @lisp
5216 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5217
5218 (authorizations
5219 (version 0) ;current file format version
5220
5221 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5222 (name "alice"))
5223 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5224 (name "bob"))
5225 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5226 (name "charlie"))))
5227 @end lisp
5228
5229 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5230 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5231
5232 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5233 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5234 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5235 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5236
5237 @cindex channel introduction
5238 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5239 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5240 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5241 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5242 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5243 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5244
5245 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5246 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5247 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5248 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5249 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5250 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5251
5252 @lisp
5253 (channel
5254 (version 0)
5255 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5256 @end lisp
5257
5258 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5259 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5260
5261 @enumerate
5262 @item
5263 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5264 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5265 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5266
5267 @item
5268 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5269 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5270 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5271
5272 @item
5273 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5274 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5275 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5276 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5277 @end enumerate
5278
5279 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5280 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5281 about to push with an authorized key:
5282
5283 @example
5284 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5285 @end example
5286
5287 @noindent
5288 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5289 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5290
5291 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5292 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5293 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5294 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5295 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5296 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5297
5298 @node Primary URL
5299 @section Primary URL
5300
5301 @cindex primary URL, channels
5302 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5303 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5304
5305 @lisp
5306 (channel
5307 (version 0)
5308 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5309 @end lisp
5310
5311 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5312 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5313 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL. That way,
5314 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5315 not receive security updates.
5316
5317 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5318 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5319 the code it fetches is authentic.
5320
5321 @node Writing Channel News
5322 @section Writing Channel News
5323
5324 @cindex news, for channels
5325 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5326 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5327 an email, but that's not convenient.
5328
5329 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5330 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5331 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5332 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5333
5334 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5335 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5336
5337 @lisp
5338 (channel
5339 (version 0)
5340 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5341 @end lisp
5342
5343 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5344 something like this:
5345
5346 @lisp
5347 (channel-news
5348 (version 0)
5349 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5350 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5351 (fr "Oh la la"))
5352 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5353 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5354 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5355 (title (en "Added a great package")
5356 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5357 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5358 @end lisp
5359
5360 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5361 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5362 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5363 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5364 store the news file in another directory.
5365
5366 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5367 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5368 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5369 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5370
5371 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5372 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5373 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5374 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5375 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5376
5377 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5378 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5379 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5380 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5381 file containing the strings to translate:
5382
5383 @example
5384 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5385 @end example
5386
5387 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5388 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5389
5390
5391 @c *********************************************************************
5392 @node Development
5393 @chapter Development
5394
5395 @cindex software development
5396 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5397 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5398 this chapter is about.
5399
5400 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5401 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5402 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5403 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5404 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5405
5406 @menu
5407 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5408 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5409 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5410 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5411 @end menu
5412
5413 @node Invoking guix environment
5414 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5415
5416 @cindex reproducible build environments
5417 @cindex development environments
5418 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5419 @cindex environment, package build environment
5420 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5421 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5422 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5423 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5424 environment to use them.
5425
5426 The general syntax is:
5427
5428 @example
5429 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5430 @end example
5431
5432 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5433 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5434
5435 @example
5436 guix environment guile
5437 @end example
5438
5439 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5440 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5441 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5442 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5443 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5444 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5445 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5446 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5447 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5448 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5449 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5450 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5451 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5452 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5453 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5454
5455 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5456 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5457 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5458 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5459 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5460 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5461
5462 @example
5463 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5464 then
5465 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5466 fi
5467 @end example
5468
5469 @noindent
5470 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5471
5472 @example
5473 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5474 @end example
5475
5476 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5477 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5478 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5479 and Emacs are available:
5480
5481 @example
5482 guix environment guile emacs
5483 @end example
5484
5485 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5486 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5487 command from the rest of the arguments:
5488
5489 @example
5490 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5491 @end example
5492
5493 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5494 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5495 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5496 NumPy:
5497
5498 @example
5499 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5500 @end example
5501
5502 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5503 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5504 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5505 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5506 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5507 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5508 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5509 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5510 additionally includes Git and strace:
5511
5512 @example
5513 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5514 @end example
5515
5516 @cindex container
5517 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5518 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5519 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5520 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5521 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5522 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5523 working directory are mounted:
5524
5525 @example
5526 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5527 @end example
5528
5529 @quotation Note
5530 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5531 @end quotation
5532
5533 @cindex certificates
5534 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5535 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5536 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5537 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5538 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5539 applications won't display without it.
5540
5541 @example
5542 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5543 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5544 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5545 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5546 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5547 @end example
5548
5549 The available options are summarized below.
5550
5551 @table @code
5552 @item --root=@var{file}
5553 @itemx -r @var{file}
5554 @cindex persistent environment
5555 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5556 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5557 register it as a garbage collector root.
5558
5559 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5560 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5561
5562 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5563 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5564 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5565 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5566 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5567
5568 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5569 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5570 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5571 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5572
5573 For example, running:
5574
5575 @example
5576 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5577 @end example
5578
5579 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5580 PETSc package.
5581
5582 Running:
5583
5584 @example
5585 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5586 @end example
5587
5588 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5589
5590 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5591 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5592
5593 @example
5594 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5595 @end example
5596
5597 @item --load=@var{file}
5598 @itemx -l @var{file}
5599 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5600 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5601
5602 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5603 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5604
5605 @lisp
5606 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5607 @end lisp
5608
5609 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5610 @itemx -m @var{file}
5611 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5612 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5613 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5614
5615 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5616 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5617 manifest files.
5618
5619 @item --ad-hoc
5620 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5621 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5622 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5623 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5624
5625 For instance, the command:
5626
5627 @example
5628 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5629 @end example
5630
5631 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5632 available.
5633
5634 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5635 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5636 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5637 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5638
5639 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5640 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5641 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5642 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5643 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5644
5645 @item --pure
5646 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5647 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5648 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5649
5650 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5651 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5652 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5653 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5654 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5655 several times.
5656
5657 @example
5658 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5659 -- mpirun @dots{}
5660 @end example
5661
5662 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5663 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5664 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5665 @env{USER}, etc.).
5666
5667 @item --search-paths
5668 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5669 environment.
5670
5671 @item --system=@var{system}
5672 @itemx -s @var{system}
5673 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5674
5675 @item --container
5676 @itemx -C
5677 @cindex container
5678 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5679 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5680 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5681 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5682 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5683
5684 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5685 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5686 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5687
5688 @item --network
5689 @itemx -N
5690 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5691 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5692 device.
5693
5694 @item --link-profile
5695 @itemx -P
5696 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5697 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5698 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5699 actual profile within the container.
5700 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5701 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5702 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5703
5704 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5705 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5706 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5707 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5708 behave as expected within the environment.
5709
5710 @item --user=@var{user}
5711 @itemx -u @var{user}
5712 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5713 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5714 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5715 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5716 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5717 need not exist on the system.
5718
5719 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5720 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5721 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5722 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5723
5724 @example
5725 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5726 cd $HOME/wd
5727 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5728 --expose=$HOME/test \
5729 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5730 @end example
5731
5732 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5733 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5734 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5735
5736 @item --no-cwd
5737 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5738 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5739 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5740 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5741 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5742 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5743
5744 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5745 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5746 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5747 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5748 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5749 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5750 point in the container.
5751
5752 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5753 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5754 directory:
5755
5756 @example
5757 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5758 @end example
5759
5760 @end table
5761
5762 @command{guix environment}
5763 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5764 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5765 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5766
5767 @node Invoking guix pack
5768 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5769
5770 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5771 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5772 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5773 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5774
5775 @quotation Note
5776 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5777 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5778 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5779 @end quotation
5780
5781 @cindex pack
5782 @cindex bundle
5783 @cindex application bundle
5784 @cindex software bundle
5785 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5786 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5787 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5788 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5789 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5790 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5791 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5792 that you pretend to be shipping.
5793
5794 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5795 their dependencies, you can run:
5796
5797 @example
5798 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5799 @dots{}
5800 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5801 @end example
5802
5803 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5804 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5805 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5806 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5807 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5808 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5809
5810 Users of this pack would have to run
5811 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5812 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5813 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5814
5815 @example
5816 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5817 @end example
5818
5819 @noindent
5820 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5821
5822 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5823 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5824 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5825 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5826 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5827 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5828 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5829 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5830
5831 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5832 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5833 the following command:
5834
5835 @example
5836 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5837 @end example
5838
5839 @noindent
5840 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5841 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5842
5843 @example
5844 docker load < @var{file}
5845 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5846 @end example
5847
5848 @noindent
5849 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5850 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5851 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5852 documentation} for more information.
5853
5854 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5855 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5856 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5857 command:
5858
5859 @example
5860 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5861 @end example
5862
5863 @noindent
5864 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5865 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5866 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5867 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5868 @command{singularity exec}.
5869
5870 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5871
5872 @table @code
5873 @item --format=@var{format}
5874 @itemx -f @var{format}
5875 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5876
5877 The available formats are:
5878
5879 @table @code
5880 @item tarball
5881 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5882 specified binaries and symlinks.
5883
5884 @item docker
5885 This produces a tarball that follows the
5886 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5887 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5888 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5889 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5890
5891 @item squashfs
5892 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5893 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5894 procfs.
5895
5896 @quotation Note
5897 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5898 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5899 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5900 with something like:
5901
5902 @example
5903 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5904 @end example
5905
5906 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5907 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5908 such file or directory'' message.
5909 @end quotation
5910 @end table
5911
5912 @cindex relocatable binaries
5913 @item --relocatable
5914 @itemx -R
5915 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5916 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5917
5918 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5919 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5920 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5921 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5922 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
5923 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
5924 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
5925
5926 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5927
5928 @example
5929 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5930 @end example
5931
5932 @noindent
5933 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5934 home directory as a normal user, run:
5935
5936 @example
5937 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5938 ./mybin/sh
5939 @end example
5940
5941 @noindent
5942 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5943 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5944 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5945 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5946 software on a non-Guix machine.
5947
5948 @quotation Note
5949 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5950 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5951 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5952 turn it off.
5953
5954 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5955 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5956 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
5957 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
5958 following execution engines are supported:
5959
5960 @table @code
5961 @item default
5962 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
5963 supported (see below).
5964
5965 @item performance
5966 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
5967 not supported (see below).
5968
5969 @item userns
5970 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
5971 supported.
5972
5973 @item proot
5974 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
5975 provides the necessary
5976 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5977 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5978 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5979 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5980
5981 @item fakechroot
5982 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
5983 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
5984 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
5985 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
5986 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
5987 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
5988 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
5989 @end table
5990
5991 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
5992 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
5993 execution engines listed above by setting the
5994 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
5995 @end quotation
5996
5997 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
5998 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
5999 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6000 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6001 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6002 pack.
6003
6004 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6005 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6006 do:
6007
6008 @example
6009 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6010 @end example
6011
6012 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6013 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6014
6015 @example
6016 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6017 docker run @var{image-id}
6018 @end example
6019
6020 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6021 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6022 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6023
6024 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6025 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6026 @command{guix build}}).
6027
6028 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6029 @itemx -m @var{file}
6030 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6031 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6032 case the manifests are concatenated.
6033
6034 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6035 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6036 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6037 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6038 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6039 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6040 but not both.
6041
6042 @item --system=@var{system}
6043 @itemx -s @var{system}
6044 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6045 the system type of the build host.
6046
6047 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6048 @cindex cross-compilation
6049 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6050 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6051 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6052
6053 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6054 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6055 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6056 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6057 compression.
6058
6059 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6060 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6061 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6062 appear several times.
6063
6064 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6065 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6066 symlink target.
6067
6068 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6069 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6070
6071 @item --save-provenance
6072 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6073 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6074 (@pxref{Channels}).
6075
6076 Provenance information is saved in the
6077 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6078 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6079 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6080 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6081
6082 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6083 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6084 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6085 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6086 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6087
6088 @item --root=@var{file}
6089 @itemx -r @var{file}
6090 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6091 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6092 collector root.
6093
6094 @item --localstatedir
6095 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6096 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6097 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6098 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6099 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6100
6101 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6102 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6103 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6104 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6105 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6106
6107 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6108 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6109
6110 @item --derivation
6111 @itemx -d
6112 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6113
6114 @item --bootstrap
6115 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6116 useful to Guix developers.
6117 @end table
6118
6119 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6120 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6121 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6122
6123
6124 @node The GCC toolchain
6125 @section The GCC toolchain
6126
6127 @cindex GCC
6128 @cindex ld-wrapper
6129 @cindex linker wrapper
6130 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6131 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6132
6133 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6134 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6135 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6136 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6137 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6138
6139 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6140 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6141 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6142 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6143 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6144
6145 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6146 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6147 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6148
6149
6150 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6151 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6152
6153 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6154 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6155 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6156 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6157 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6158 parent commit(s).
6159
6160 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6161 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6162 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6163 with Guix.
6164
6165 The general syntax is:
6166
6167 @example
6168 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6169 @end example
6170
6171 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6172 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6173 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6174 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6175 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6176 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6177 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6178
6179 @table @code
6180 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6181 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6182 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6183 directory.
6184
6185 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6186 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6187 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6188 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6189 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6190 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6191 named @code{keyring}.
6192
6193 @item --stats
6194 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6195
6196 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6197 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6198 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6199 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6200
6201 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6202 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6203 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6204 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6205 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6206 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6207 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6208 @end table
6209
6210
6211 @c *********************************************************************
6212 @node Programming Interface
6213 @chapter Programming Interface
6214
6215 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6216 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6217 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6218 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6219 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6220 turned into concrete build actions.
6221
6222 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6223 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6224 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6225 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6226 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6227
6228 @cindex derivation
6229 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6230 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6231 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6232 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6233 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6234 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6235 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6236
6237 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6238 package definitions.
6239
6240 @menu
6241 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6242 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6243 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6244 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6245 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6246 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6247 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6248 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6249 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6250 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6251 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6252 @end menu
6253
6254 @node Package Modules
6255 @section Package Modules
6256
6257 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6258 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6259 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6260 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6261 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6262 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6263 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6264 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6265 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6266 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6267 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6268
6269 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6270 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6271 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6272 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6273 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6274 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6275
6276 @cindex customization, of packages
6277 @cindex package module search path
6278 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6279 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6280 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6281 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6282 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6283 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6284 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6285 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6286
6287 @enumerate
6288 @item
6289 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6290 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6291 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6292 environment variable described below.
6293
6294 @item
6295 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6296 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6297 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6298 channels.
6299 @end enumerate
6300
6301 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6302
6303 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6304 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6305 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6306 over the own modules of the distribution.
6307 @end defvr
6308
6309 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6310 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6311 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6312 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6313 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6314 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6315
6316 @node Defining Packages
6317 @section Defining Packages
6318
6319 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6320 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6321 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6322 package looks like this:
6323
6324 @lisp
6325 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6326 #:use-module (guix packages)
6327 #:use-module (guix download)
6328 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6329 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6330 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6331
6332 (define-public hello
6333 (package
6334 (name "hello")
6335 (version "2.10")
6336 (source (origin
6337 (method url-fetch)
6338 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6339 ".tar.gz"))
6340 (sha256
6341 (base32
6342 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6343 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6344 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6345 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6346 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6347 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6348 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6349 (license gpl3+)))
6350 @end lisp
6351
6352 @noindent
6353 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6354 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6355 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6356 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6357 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6358 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6359 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6360
6361 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6362 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6363 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6364
6365 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6366 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6367 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6368 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6369 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6370
6371 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6372
6373 @itemize
6374 @item
6375 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6376 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6377 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6378 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6379
6380 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6381 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6382
6383 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6384 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6385 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6386 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6387 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6388 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6389
6390 @cindex patches
6391 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6392 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6393 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6394
6395 @item
6396 @cindex GNU Build System
6397 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6398 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6399 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6400 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6401 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6402
6403 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6404 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6405 Utilities}, for more on this.
6406
6407 @item
6408 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6409 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6410 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6411 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6412
6413 @cindex quote
6414 @cindex quoting
6415 @findex '
6416 @findex quote
6417 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6418 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6419 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6420 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6421 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6422 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6423 Manual}).
6424
6425 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6426 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6427 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6428 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6429 Reference Manual}).
6430
6431 @item
6432 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6433 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6434 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6435 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6436
6437 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6438 @findex `
6439 @findex quasiquote
6440 @cindex comma (unquote)
6441 @findex ,
6442 @findex unquote
6443 @findex ,@@
6444 @findex unquote-splicing
6445 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6446 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6447 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6448 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6449 Reference Manual}).
6450
6451 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6452 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6453 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6454
6455 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6456 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6457 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6458 @end itemize
6459
6460 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6461
6462 Once a package definition is in place, the
6463 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6464 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6465 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6466 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6467 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6468 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6469 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6470 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6471 for style conformance.
6472 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6473 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6474 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6475 in a ``channel''.
6476
6477 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6478 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6479 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6480
6481 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6482 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6483 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6484 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6485 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6486
6487 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6488 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6489 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6490
6491 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6492 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6493 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6494 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6495 (@pxref{The Store}).
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @noindent
6499 @cindex cross-compilation
6500 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6501 package for some other system:
6502
6503 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6504 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6505 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6506 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6507
6508 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6509 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6510 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6514 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6515
6516 @menu
6517 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6518 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6519 @end menu
6520
6521
6522 @node package Reference
6523 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6524
6525 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6526 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6527
6528 @deftp {Data Type} package
6529 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6530
6531 @table @asis
6532 @item @code{name}
6533 The name of the package, as a string.
6534
6535 @item @code{version}
6536 The version of the package, as a string.
6537
6538 @item @code{source}
6539 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6540 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6541 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6542 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6543 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6544 @code{local-file}}).
6545
6546 @item @code{build-system}
6547 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6548 Systems}).
6549
6550 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6551 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6552 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6553
6554 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6555 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6556 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6557 @cindex inputs, of packages
6558 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6559 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6560 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6561 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6562 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6563 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6564 inputs:
6565
6566 @lisp
6567 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6568 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6569 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6570 @end lisp
6571
6572 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6573 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6574 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6575 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6576 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6577 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6578
6579 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6580 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6581 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6582 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6583
6584 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6585 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6586 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6587 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6588 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6589 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6590 propagated inputs).
6591
6592 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6593 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6594 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6595
6596 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6597 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6598 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6599 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6600 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6601 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6602
6603 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6604 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6605 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6606
6607 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6608 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6609 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6610 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6611
6612 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6613 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6614 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6615 for details.
6616
6617 @item @code{synopsis}
6618 A one-line description of the package.
6619
6620 @item @code{description}
6621 A more elaborate description of the package.
6622
6623 @item @code{license}
6624 @cindex license, of packages
6625 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6626 or a list of such values.
6627
6628 @item @code{home-page}
6629 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6630
6631 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6632 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6633 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6634
6635 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6636 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6637 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6638 automatically corrected.
6639 @end table
6640 @end deftp
6641
6642 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6643 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6644 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6645
6646 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6647 cross-compiling:
6648
6649 @lisp
6650 (package
6651 (name "guile")
6652 ;; ...
6653
6654 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6655 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6656 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6657 `(("self" ,this-package))
6658 '())))
6659 @end lisp
6660
6661 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6665 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6666 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6667 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6668
6669 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6670 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6671 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6672 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6673 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6674 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6675
6676 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6677 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6678 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6679
6680 @lisp
6681 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6682 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6683 @end lisp
6684
6685 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6686 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6687 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6688 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6689 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6690 for more on build systems.
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @node origin Reference
6694 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6695
6696 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6697 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6698 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6699 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6700 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6701 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6702
6703 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6704 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6705
6706 @table @asis
6707 @item @code{uri}
6708 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6709 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6710 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6711 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6712
6713 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6714 @item @code{method}
6715 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI. The procedure must
6716 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6717 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6718 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6719 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6720 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6721
6722 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6723 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6724 (see below).
6725
6726 @item @code{sha256}
6727 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6728 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6729 @code{hash} field described below.
6730
6731 @item @code{hash}
6732 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6733 @code{content-hash}.
6734
6735 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6736 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6737 guix hash}).
6738
6739 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6740 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6741 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6742 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6743 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6744 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6745
6746 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6747 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6748 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6749
6750 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6751 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6752 @code{%current-target-system}.
6753
6754 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6755 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6756 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6757 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6758
6759 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6760 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6761 command.
6762
6763 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6764 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6765 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6766 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6767
6768 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6769 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6770 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6771
6772 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6773 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6774 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6775 @end table
6776 @end deftp
6777
6778 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6779 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6780 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6781 it is @code{sha256}.
6782
6783 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6784 or it can be a bytevector.
6785
6786 The following forms are all equivalent:
6787
6788 @lisp
6789 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6790 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6791 sha256)
6792 (content-hash (base32
6793 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6794 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6795 sha256)
6796 @end lisp
6797
6798 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6799 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6800 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6801 @end deftp
6802
6803 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6804 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6805 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6806 described below.
6807
6808 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6809 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6810 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6811 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6812 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6813 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6814 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6815 downloaded file executable.
6816
6817 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6818 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6819
6820 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
6821 corresponding file name in the store.
6822 @end deffn
6823
6824 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
6825 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
6826 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
6827 the repository and revision to fetch.
6828
6829 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
6830 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6831 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6832 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6833 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
6837 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
6838 retrieve.
6839
6840 @table @asis
6841 @item @code{url}
6842 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
6843
6844 @item @code{commit}
6845 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string,
6846 either the full SHA1 commit or a ``short'' commit string; the latter is
6847 not recommended) or the tag to fetch.
6848
6849 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
6850 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
6851 @end table
6852
6853 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
6854 repository:
6855
6856 @lisp
6857 (git-reference
6858 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6859 (commit "v2.10"))
6860 @end lisp
6861
6862 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
6863 commit:
6864
6865 @lisp
6866 (git-reference
6867 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6868 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
6869 @end lisp
6870 @end deftp
6871
6872 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
6873 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
6874 support of the Mercurial version control system.
6875
6876 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6877 [name]
6878 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6879 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6880 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6881 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
6882 @end deffn
6883
6884 @node Defining Package Variants
6885 @section Defining Package Variants
6886
6887 @cindex customizing packages
6888 @cindex variants, of packages
6889 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
6890 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
6891 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
6892 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
6893 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6894 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
6895 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
6896 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
6897 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
6898
6899 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
6900 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
6901 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
6902 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
6903 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
6904 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
6905 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
6906
6907 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
6908 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
6909 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
6910 vintage!):
6911
6912 @lisp
6913 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
6914
6915 (define hello-2.2
6916 (package
6917 (inherit hello)
6918 (version "2.2")
6919 (source (origin
6920 (method url-fetch)
6921 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6922 ".tar.gz"))
6923 (sha256
6924 (base32
6925 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
6926 @end lisp
6927
6928 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
6929 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
6930 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
6931 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
6932 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
6933 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
6934 new package definition; the original one remains available.
6935
6936 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
6937 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
6938 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
6939 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
6940 dependency like so:
6941
6942 @lisp
6943 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
6944 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
6945
6946 (define gdb-sans-guile
6947 (package
6948 (inherit gdb)
6949 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
6950 (package-inputs gdb)))))
6951 @end lisp
6952
6953 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
6954 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
6955 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6956 Manual}).
6957
6958 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
6959 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
6960 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
6961 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
6962 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
6963 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
6964 depends on it:
6965
6966 @lisp
6967 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
6968 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
6969 (package
6970 (name name)
6971 (version "3.0")
6972 ;; several fields omitted
6973 (inputs
6974 `(("lua" ,lua)))
6975 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
6976
6977 (define-public lua5.1-socket
6978 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
6979
6980 (define-public lua5.2-socket
6981 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
6982 @end lisp
6983
6984 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
6985 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
6986 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
6987 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
6988 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
6989 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6990
6991 @cindex package transformations
6992 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
6993 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
6994 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
6995 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
6996
6997 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
6998 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
6999 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7000 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7001
7002 @lisp
7003 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7004 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7005 @end lisp
7006
7007 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7008 to that transformation.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7012
7013 @example
7014 guix build guix \
7015 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7016 --with-debug-info=zlib
7017 @end example
7018
7019 @noindent
7020 ... would look like this:
7021
7022 @lisp
7023 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7024
7025 (define transform
7026 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7027 (options->transformation
7028 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7029 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7030
7031 (packages->manifest
7032 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7033 @end lisp
7034
7035 @cindex input rewriting
7036 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7037 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7038 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7039 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7040 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7041 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7042 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7043
7044 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7045 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7046 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7047
7048 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7049 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7050 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7051 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7052 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7053 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7054 and the second one is the replacement.
7055
7056 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7057 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @noindent
7061 Consider this example:
7062
7063 @lisp
7064 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7065 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7066 ;; recursively.
7067 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7068
7069 (define git-with-libressl
7070 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7071 @end lisp
7072
7073 @noindent
7074 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7075 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7076 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7077 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7078 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7079
7080 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7081 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7082
7083 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7084 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7085 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7086 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7087 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7088 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7089 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7093
7094 @lisp
7095 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7096 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7097 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7098 @end lisp
7099
7100 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7101 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7102 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7103
7104 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7105 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7106 graph.
7107
7108 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7109 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7110 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7111 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7112 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7113 @end deffn
7114
7115
7116 @node Build Systems
7117 @section Build Systems
7118
7119 @cindex build system
7120 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7121 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7122 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7123 dependencies of that build procedure.
7124
7125 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7126 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7127 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7128
7129 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7130 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7131 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7132 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7133 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7134 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7135 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7136 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7137 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7138 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7139
7140 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7141 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7142 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7143 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7144 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7145 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7146 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7147
7148 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7149 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7150 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7151
7152 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7153 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7154 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7155 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7156
7157 @cindex build phases
7158 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7159 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7160 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7161 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
7162 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
7163 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
7164
7165 @table @code
7166 @item unpack
7167 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
7168 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
7169 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
7170
7171 @item patch-source-shebangs
7172 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
7173 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
7174 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
7175
7176 @item configure
7177 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
7178 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
7179 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
7180
7181 @item build
7182 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
7183 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7184 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
7185
7186 @item check
7187 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
7188 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
7189 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
7190 check -j}.
7191
7192 @item install
7193 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
7194
7195 @item patch-shebangs
7196 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
7197
7198 @item strip
7199 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
7200 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
7201 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
7202 @end table
7203
7204 @vindex %standard-phases
7205 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
7206 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
7207 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
7208 procedure implements the actual phase.
7209
7210 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7211 them.
7212
7213 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7214 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7215 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7216 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7217 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7218 have to mention them.
7219 @end defvr
7220
7221 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7222 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7223 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7224 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7225 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7226
7227 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7228 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7229 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7230 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7231
7232 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7233 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7234 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7235 parameters, respectively.
7236
7237 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7238 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7239 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7240 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7241 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7242
7243 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7244 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7245 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7246 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7247 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7248 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7249 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7250
7251 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7252 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7253 ``jar'' task will be run.
7254
7255 @end defvr
7256
7257 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7258 @cindex Android distribution
7259 @cindex Android NDK build system
7260 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7261 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7262 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7263
7264 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7265 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7266 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7267
7268 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7269 has no conflicting files.
7270
7271 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7272 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7273
7274 @end defvr
7275
7276 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7277 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7278 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7279
7280 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7281 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7282 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7283 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7284
7285 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7286 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7287 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7288 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7289 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7290 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7291
7292 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7293 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7294 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7295
7296 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7297 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7298 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7299
7300 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7301 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7302 They should be called in a build phase after the
7303 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7304 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7305 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7306 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7307
7308 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7309 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7310 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7311 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7312 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7313 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7314 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7315 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7316
7317 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7318 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7319 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7320 names.
7321
7322 @end defvr
7323
7324 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7325 @cindex Rust programming language
7326 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7327 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7328 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7329 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7330
7331 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7332 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7333
7334 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
7335 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7336 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7337 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7338 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7339 should be added to the package definition via the
7340 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7341
7342 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7343 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7344 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7345 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7346 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs the binaries
7347 defined by the crate.
7348 @end defvr
7349
7350 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7351 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7352 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7353 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7354 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7355
7356 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7357 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7358
7359 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7360 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7361 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7362
7363 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7364
7365 @lisp
7366 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7367 @end lisp
7368
7369 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7370 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7371 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7372 @end defvr
7373
7374 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7375 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7376 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7377 mostly just moving files around.
7378
7379 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7380 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7381 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7382 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7383
7384 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7385 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7386 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7387 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7388
7389 @itemize
7390 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7391 @itemize
7392 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7393 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7394 @end itemize
7395
7396 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7397 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7398 as above.
7399 @itemize
7400 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7401 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7402 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7403 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7404 @itemize
7405 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7406 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7407 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7408 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7409 list.
7410 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7411 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7412 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7413 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7414 on top of the inclusions.
7415 @end itemize
7416 @end itemize
7417 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7418 @var{target}.
7419 @end itemize
7420
7421 Examples:
7422
7423 @itemize
7424 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7425 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7426 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7427 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7428 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7429 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7430 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7431 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7432 @end itemize
7433 @end defvr
7434
7435
7436 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7437 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7438 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7439 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7440 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7441 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7442 yet.
7443
7444 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7445 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7446 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7447
7448 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7449 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7450 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7451 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7452 Other parameters are documented below.
7453
7454 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7455 following phases changed:
7456
7457 @table @code
7458
7459 @item build
7460 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7461 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7462 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7463 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7464 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7465 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7466 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7467 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7468
7469 @item check
7470 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7471 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7472 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7473 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7474 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7475 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7476
7477 @item install
7478 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7482
7483 @table @code
7484
7485 @item install-doc
7486 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7487 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7488 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7489 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7490 @end table
7491 @end defvr
7492
7493 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7494 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7495 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7496 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7497
7498 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7499 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7500 parameter.
7501
7502 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7503 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7504 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7505 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7506 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7507 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7508 @end defvr
7509
7510 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7511 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7512 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7513 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7514 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7515 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7516 system.
7517
7518 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7519 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7520 parameter.
7521
7522 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7523 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7524 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7525
7526 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7527 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7528 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7529
7530 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7531 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7532 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7533 @code{dune}.
7534 @end defvr
7535
7536 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7537 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7538 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7539 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7540 Go build mechanisms}.
7541
7542 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7543 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7544 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7545 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7546 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7547 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7548 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7549 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7550 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7551 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7552
7553 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7554 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7555 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7556 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7557 @end defvr
7558
7559 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7560 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7561 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7562
7563 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7564 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7565
7566 @table @code
7567 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7568 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7569 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7570 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7571 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7572 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7573 environment variables.
7574
7575 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7576 process by listing their names in the
7577 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7578 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7579 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7580 GLib and GTK+.
7581
7582 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7583 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7584 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7585 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7586 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7587 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7588 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7589 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7590 @end table
7591
7592 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7593 @end defvr
7594
7595 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7596 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7597 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7598 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7599 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7600 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7601 installs documentation.
7602
7603 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7604 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7605
7606 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7607 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7608 @end defvr
7609
7610 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7611 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7612 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7613 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7614 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7615 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7616 Tests are run with @code{Pkg.test}.
7617
7618 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
7619 package, correctly capitalized.
7620
7621 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
7622 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
7623 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
7624 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
7625
7626 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7627 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7628 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7629 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7630 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7631 and their uuid.
7632 @end defvr
7633
7634 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7635 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7636 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7637 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7638 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7639 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7640 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7641
7642 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7643 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7644 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7645 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7646 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7647 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7648 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7649 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7650 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7651
7652 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7653 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7654
7655 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7656 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7657 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7658 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7659 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7660
7661 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7662 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7663 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7664 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7665 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7666
7667 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7668 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7669
7670 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7671 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7672 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7673 also exported.
7674 @end defvr
7675
7676 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7677 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7678 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7679
7680 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7681 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7682 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7683 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7684 output.
7685
7686 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7687 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7688 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7689 @end defvr
7690
7691 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7692 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7693 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7694 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7695 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7696 try some of them.
7697
7698 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7699 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7700 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7701 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7702 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7703 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7704 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7705 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7706 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7707
7708 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7709 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7710 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7711 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7712
7713 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7714 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7715 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7716
7717 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7718 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7719 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7720 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7721 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7722 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7723 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7724
7725 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7726 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7727 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7728 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7729 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7730 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7731 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7732 @end defvr
7733
7734 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7735 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7736 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7737 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7738 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7739
7740 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7741 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7742 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7743
7744 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7745 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
7746 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
7747 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
7748 interpreter version.
7749
7750 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
7751 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
7752 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
7753 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
7754 @end defvr
7755
7756 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
7757 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
7758 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
7759 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
7760 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
7761 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
7762 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
7763 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
7764 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
7765 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
7766 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
7767 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
7768
7769 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
7770 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
7771 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7772
7773 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
7774 @end defvr
7775
7776 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
7777 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
7778 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
7779
7780 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7781 @code{cmake-build-system}:
7782
7783 @table @code
7784 @item check-setup
7785 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
7786 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
7787 For now this only sets some environment variables:
7788 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
7789 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
7790 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
7791
7792 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
7793 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
7794
7795 @item qt-wrap
7796 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
7797 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
7798 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
7799 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
7800 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
7801
7802 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
7803 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
7804 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
7805 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
7806 or such.
7807
7808 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
7809 @end table
7810 @end defvr
7811
7812 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
7813 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
7814 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
7815 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
7816 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
7817 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
7818 run after installation using the R function
7819 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
7820 @end defvr
7821
7822 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
7823 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
7824 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
7825 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
7826 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
7827 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
7828 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
7829 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
7830
7831 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
7832 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
7833 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7834 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
7835 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
7836 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7837 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
7838 @end defvr
7839
7840 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
7841 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
7842 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
7843 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
7844 files in the inputs.
7845
7846 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
7847 different engine and format can be specified with the
7848 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
7849 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
7850 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
7851 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
7852 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
7853 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
7854
7855 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
7856 install the built files under the texmf tree.
7857 @end defvr
7858
7859 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
7860 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
7861 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
7862 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
7863
7864 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
7865 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
7866 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
7867 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
7868 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
7869 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
7870 a traditional source release tarball.
7871
7872 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
7873 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
7874 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
7875 @end defvr
7876
7877 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
7878 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
7879 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
7880 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
7881 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
7882 script.
7883
7884 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
7885 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
7886 @code{#:python} parameter.
7887 @end defvr
7888
7889 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
7890 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
7891 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
7892 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
7893 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
7894 the package.
7895
7896 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
7897 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
7898 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
7899 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
7900 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
7901 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
7902 @end defvr
7903
7904 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
7905 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
7906 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
7907 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
7908 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
7909 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
7910 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
7911 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
7912 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
7913 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
7914 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
7915 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
7916 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
7917 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
7918
7919 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
7920 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
7921 @end defvr
7922
7923 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
7924 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
7925 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
7926 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
7927 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
7928
7929 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
7930 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
7931 @end defvr
7932
7933 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
7934 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
7935 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
7936 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
7937
7938 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
7939 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
7940 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
7941 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
7942 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
7943 @end defvr
7944
7945 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
7946 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
7947 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
7948 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
7949 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
7950 locations in the output directory.
7951 @end defvr
7952
7953 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
7954 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
7955 implements the build procedure for packages that use
7956 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
7957
7958 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
7959 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
7960 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
7961 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
7962 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
7963
7964 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
7965 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
7966
7967 @table @code
7968
7969 @item configure
7970 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
7971 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
7972 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
7973 @code{#:build-type}.
7974
7975 @item build
7976 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
7977 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
7978
7979 @item check
7980 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
7981 which is @code{"test"} by default.
7982
7983 @item install
7984 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
7985 @end table
7986
7987 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
7988
7989 @table @code
7990
7991 @item fix-runpath
7992 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
7993 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
7994 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
7995 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
7996 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
7997 required for the program to run.
7998
7999 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8000 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8001 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8002
8003 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8004 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8005 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8006 @end table
8007 @end defvr
8008
8009 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8010 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8011
8012 @cindex build phases
8013 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8014 following phases changed:
8015
8016 @table @code
8017
8018 @item configure
8019 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8020 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8021
8022 @item build
8023 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8024 kernel module.
8025
8026 @item install
8027 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8028 kernel module.
8029 @end table
8030
8031 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8032 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8033 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8034 @end defvr
8035
8036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8037 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8038 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8039 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8040 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8041
8042 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8043 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8044 @code{node}.
8045 @end defvr
8046
8047 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8048 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8049 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8050 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8051
8052 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8053 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8054
8055 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8056 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8057 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8058 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8059 @end defvr
8060
8061 @node Build Phases
8062 @section Build Phases
8063
8064 @cindex build phases, for packages
8065 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8066 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8067 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8068 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8069 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8070
8071 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8072 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the standard
8073 phases include an @code{unpack} phase to unpack the source code tarball,
8074 a @command{configure} phase to run @code{./configure}, a @code{build}
8075 phase to run @command{make}, and (among others) an @code{install} phase
8076 to run @command{make install}; @pxref{Build Systems}, for a more
8077 detailed view of these phases. Likewise, @code{cmake-build-system}
8078 inherits these phases, but its @code{configure} phase runs
8079 @command{cmake} instead of @command{./configure}. Other build systems,
8080 such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list of
8081 standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8082 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8083 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8084
8085 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8086 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8087 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8088 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8089 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8090 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8091
8092 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8093 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8094 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8095 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8096 details!}:
8097
8098 @lisp
8099 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8100
8101 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8102 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8103 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8104
8105 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8106 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8107 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8108 (invoke "./configure"
8109 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8110
8111 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8112 ;; Compile.
8113 (invoke "make"))
8114
8115 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8116 #:allow-other-keys)
8117 ;; Run the test suite.
8118 (if tests?
8119 (invoke "make" test-target)
8120 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8121
8122 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8123 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8124 (invoke "make" "install"))
8125
8126 (define %standard-phases
8127 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8128 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8129 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8130 (cons 'configure configure)
8131 (cons 'build build)
8132 (cons 'check check)
8133 (cons 'install install)))
8134 @end lisp
8135
8136 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8137 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8138 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8139 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8140 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8141 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8142 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8143 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8144
8145 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8146 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8147 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8148 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8149 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8150
8151 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8152 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8153 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8154 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8155 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8156 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8157 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8158 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8159 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8160 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8161 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8162 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8163 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8164 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8165 @code{tests?} is false.
8166
8167 @cindex build phases, customizing
8168 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8169 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8170 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8171 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8172 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8173 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8174 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8175 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8176
8177 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8178 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8179 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8180 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8181
8182 @lisp
8183 (define-public example
8184 (package
8185 (name "example")
8186 ;; other fields omitted
8187 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8188 (arguments
8189 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8190 (delete 'configure)
8191 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8192 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8193 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8194 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8195 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8196 (substitute* "Makefile"
8197 (("PREFIX =.*")
8198 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8199 out "\n")))
8200 #true))))))))
8201 @end lisp
8202
8203 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8204 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8205 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8206 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8207
8208 @cindex code staging
8209 @cindex staging, of code
8210 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8211 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8212 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8213 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8214 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8215 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8216
8217 @node Build Utilities
8218 @section Build Utilities
8219
8220 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8221 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8222 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8223 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8224 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8225 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8226
8227 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8228 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8229 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8230
8231 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8232 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8233 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8234 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8235
8236 @lisp
8237 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8238 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8239 #~(begin
8240 ;; Put it in scope.
8241 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8242
8243 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8244 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8245 @end lisp
8246
8247 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8248 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8249
8250 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8251
8252 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8253
8254 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8255
8256 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8257 Return the directory name of the store.
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8261 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8265 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8266 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8270 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8271 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8272 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8273 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @subsection File Types
8277
8278 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8279
8280 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8281 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8282 @end deffn
8283
8284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8285 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8289 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8290 @end deffn
8291
8292 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8293 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8294 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8295 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8296 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8300 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8301 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8302 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @subsection File Manipulation
8306
8307 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8308 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8309 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8310 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8311 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8312
8313 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8314 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8315
8316 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8317 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8318 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8319 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8320 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8321 exception.
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8325 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8329 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8330 under the same name.
8331 @end deffn
8332
8333 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8334 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8338 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8339 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8340 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8341 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8342 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8343 @var{log} port.
8344 @end deffn
8345
8346 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8347 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8348 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8349 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8350 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8354 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8355 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8356 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8357 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8358
8359 @lisp
8360 (substitute* file
8361 (("hello")
8362 "good morning\n")
8363 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8364 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8365 @end lisp
8366
8367 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8368 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8369 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8370 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8371
8372 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8373 corresponding match substring.
8374
8375 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8376 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8377
8378 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8379 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @subsection File Search
8383
8384 @cindex file, searching
8385 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8386
8387 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8388 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8389 name matches @var{regexp}.
8390 @end deffn
8391
8392 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8393 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8394 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8395 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8396 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8397 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8398 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8399 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8400 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8401 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8402 raise an exception upon error.
8403 @end deffn
8404
8405 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8406 the root of the Guix source tree:
8407
8408 @lisp
8409 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8410 (find-files ".")
8411 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8412
8413 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8414 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8415 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8416
8417 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8418 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8419 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8420 @end lisp
8421
8422 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8423 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8424 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8425 @end deffn
8426
8427 @subsection Build Phases
8428
8429 @cindex build phases
8430 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8431 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8432 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8433 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8434 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8435 Phases}).
8436
8437 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8438 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8439 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8440
8441 @cindex build phases, modifying
8442 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8443 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8444 have one of the following forms:
8445
8446 @lisp
8447 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8448 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8449 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8450 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8451 @end lisp
8452
8453 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8454 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8458 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8459 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8460 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8461 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8462 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8463 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8464 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8465 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8466
8467 @lisp
8468 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8469 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8470 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8471 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8472 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8473 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8474 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8475 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8476 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8477 (("^exec grep")
8478 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8479 #t))))
8480 @end lisp
8481
8482 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8483 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8484 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8485 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8486 executable files to be installed:
8487
8488 @lisp
8489 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8490 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8491 (replace 'install
8492 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8493 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8494 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8495 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8496 "/bin")))
8497 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8498 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8499 #t))))
8500 @end lisp
8501
8502 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8503
8504 @node The Store
8505 @section The Store
8506
8507 @cindex store
8508 @cindex store items
8509 @cindex store paths
8510
8511 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8512 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8513 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8514 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8515 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8516 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8517 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8518 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8519 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8520
8521 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8522 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8523 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8524 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8525
8526 @quotation Note
8527 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8528 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8529 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8530
8531 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8532 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8533 accidental modifications.
8534 @end quotation
8535
8536 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8537 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8538 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8539 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8540 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8541
8542 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8543 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8544 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8545 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8546 supported URI schemes are:
8547
8548 @table @code
8549 @item file
8550 @itemx unix
8551 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8552 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8553 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8554
8555 @item guix
8556 @cindex daemon, remote access
8557 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8558 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8559 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8560 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8561 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8562 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8563
8564 @example
8565 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8566 @end example
8567
8568 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8569 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8570 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8571
8572 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8573 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8574 @option{--listen}}).
8575
8576 @item ssh
8577 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8578 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH. This
8579 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8580 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8581 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8582 like this:
8583
8584 @example
8585 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8586 @end example
8587
8588 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8589 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8590 @end table
8591
8592 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8593
8594 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8595 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8596 @quotation Note
8597 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8598 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8599 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8600 @end quotation
8601 @end defvr
8602
8603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8604 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8605 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8606 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8607 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8608
8609 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8610 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8611 @end deffn
8612
8613 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8614 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8618 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8619 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8620 @end defvr
8621
8622 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8623 argument.
8624
8625 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8626 @cindex invalid store items
8627 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8628 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8629 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8630 build).
8631
8632 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8633 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8637 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8638 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8639 resulting store path.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8643 [@var{mode}]
8644 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8645 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8646 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8647 @end deffn
8648
8649 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8650 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8651 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8652 Store Monad}).
8653
8654 @c FIXME
8655 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8656
8657 @node Derivations
8658 @section Derivations
8659
8660 @cindex derivations
8661 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8662 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8663 following pieces of information:
8664
8665 @itemize
8666 @item
8667 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8668 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8669
8670 @item
8671 @cindex build-time dependencies
8672 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8673 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8674 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8675 etc.).
8676
8677 @item
8678 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8679
8680 @item
8681 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8682 to be passed.
8683
8684 @item
8685 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8686
8687 @end itemize
8688
8689 @cindex derivation path
8690 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8691 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8692 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8693 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
8694 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
8695 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
8696 Store}).
8697
8698 @cindex fixed-output derivations
8699 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
8700 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
8701 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
8702 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
8703 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
8704 method and tools being used.
8705
8706 @cindex references
8707 @cindex run-time dependencies
8708 @cindex dependencies, run-time
8709 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
8710 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
8711 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
8712 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
8713 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
8714 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
8715
8716 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
8717 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
8718 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
8719 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
8720
8721 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
8722 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8723 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
8724 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
8725 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8726 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
8727 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
8728 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
8729 @code{<derivation>} object.
8730
8731 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
8732 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
8733 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
8734 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
8735 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
8736 containing this output.
8737
8738 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
8739 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
8740 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
8741 a simple text format.
8742
8743 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
8744 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
8745 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
8746 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
8747
8748 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
8749 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
8750 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
8751 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
8752 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
8753 derivations that download files.
8754
8755 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
8756 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
8757 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
8758 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
8759
8760 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
8761 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
8762 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
8763 host CPU instruction set.
8764
8765 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
8766 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @noindent
8770 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
8771 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
8772 to a Bash executable in the store:
8773
8774 @lisp
8775 (use-modules (guix utils)
8776 (guix store)
8777 (guix derivations))
8778
8779 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
8780 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
8781 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
8782 (derivation store "foo"
8783 bash `("-e" ,builder)
8784 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
8785 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
8786 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
8787 @end lisp
8788
8789 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
8790 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
8791 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
8792 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
8793 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
8794
8795 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
8796 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
8797 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
8798 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
8799
8800 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
8801 @var{name} @var{exp} @
8802 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
8803 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8804 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8805 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8806 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8807 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8808 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
8809 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
8810 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
8811 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
8812 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
8813 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
8814 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
8815 gnu-build-system))}.
8816
8817 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
8818 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
8819 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
8820 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
8821 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
8822 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
8823 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
8824
8825 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
8826 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
8827 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
8828
8829 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
8830 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
8831 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
8832 @var{substitutable?}.
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @noindent
8836 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
8837 containing one file:
8838
8839 @lisp
8840 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
8841 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
8842 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
8843 (lambda (p)
8844 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
8845 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
8846
8847 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
8848 @end lisp
8849
8850
8851 @node The Store Monad
8852 @section The Store Monad
8853
8854 @cindex monad
8855
8856 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
8857 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
8858 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
8859 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
8860
8861 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
8862 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
8863 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
8864 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
8865 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
8866
8867 @cindex monadic values
8868 @cindex monadic functions
8869 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
8870 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
8871 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
8872 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
8873 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
8874 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
8875 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
8876 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
8877 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
8878
8879 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
8880
8881 @lisp
8882 (define (sh-symlink store)
8883 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
8884 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
8885 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
8886 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
8887 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
8888 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
8889 @end lisp
8890
8891 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
8892 as a monadic function:
8893
8894 @lisp
8895 (define (sh-symlink)
8896 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
8897 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
8898 (gexp->derivation "sh"
8899 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
8900 #$output))))
8901 @end lisp
8902
8903 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
8904 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
8905 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
8906 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
8907 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
8908
8909 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
8910 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
8911 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8912
8913 @lisp
8914 (define (sh-symlink)
8915 (gexp->derivation "sh"
8916 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
8917 #$output)))
8918 @end lisp
8919
8920 @c See
8921 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
8922 @c for the funny quote.
8923 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
8924 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
8925 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
8926 @code{run-with-store}:
8927
8928 @lisp
8929 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
8930 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
8931 @end lisp
8932
8933 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
8934 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
8935 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
8936 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
8937
8938 @example
8939 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
8940 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
8941 @end example
8942
8943 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
8944 automatically run through the store:
8945
8946 @example
8947 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
8948 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
8949 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
8950 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
8951 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
8952 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
8953 scheme@@(guile-user)>
8954 @end example
8955
8956 @noindent
8957 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
8958 @code{store-monad} REPL.
8959
8960 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
8961 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
8962
8963 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
8964 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
8965 in @var{monad}.
8966 @end deffn
8967
8968 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
8969 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
8970 @end deffn
8971
8972 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
8973 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
8974 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
8975 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
8976 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
8977 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
8978 in this example:
8979
8980 @lisp
8981 (run-with-state
8982 (with-monad %state-monad
8983 (>>= (return 1)
8984 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
8985 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
8986 'some-state)
8987
8988 @result{} 4
8989 @result{} some-state
8990 @end lisp
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
8994 @var{body} ...
8995 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
8996 @var{body} ...
8997 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
8998 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
8999 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9000 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9001 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9002 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9003 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9004 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9005 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9006 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9007
9008 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9009 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9010 @end deffn
9011
9012 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9013 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9014 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9015 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9016
9017 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9018 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9019 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9023 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9024 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9025 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9026 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9027 @end deffn
9028
9029 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9030 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9031 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9032 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9033 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @cindex state monad
9037 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9038 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9039 monadic procedure calls.
9040
9041 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9042 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9043 the state that is threaded.
9044
9045 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9046 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9047 increments the current state value:
9048
9049 @lisp
9050 (define (square x)
9051 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9052 (mbegin %state-monad
9053 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9054 (return (* x x)))))
9055
9056 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9057 @result{} (0 1 4)
9058 @result{} 3
9059 @end lisp
9060
9061 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9062 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9063 @end defvr
9064
9065 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9066 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9070 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9071 monadic value.
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9075 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9076 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9080 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9081 The state is assumed to be a list.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9085 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9086 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9090 store)} module, is as follows.
9091
9092 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9093 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9094
9095 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9096 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9097 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9098 @end defvr
9099
9100 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9101 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9102 open store connection.
9103 @end deffn
9104
9105 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9106 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9107 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9108 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9109 @end deffn
9110
9111 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9112 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9113 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9114 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9118 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9119 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9120 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9121 @var{name} is omitted.
9122
9123 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9124 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9125 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9126
9127 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9128 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9129 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9130 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9131
9132 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9133
9134 @lisp
9135 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9136 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9137 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9138 (return (list a b))))
9139
9140 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9141 @end lisp
9142
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9146 monadic procedures:
9147
9148 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9149 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9150 [#:output "out"]
9151 Return as a monadic
9152 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9153 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9154 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9155 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9156
9157 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9158 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9159 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9163 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9164 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9165 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9166 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169
9170 @node G-Expressions
9171 @section G-Expressions
9172
9173 @cindex G-expression
9174 @cindex build code quoting
9175 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9176 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9177 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9178 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9179 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9180
9181 @cindex code staging
9182 @cindex staging, of code
9183 @cindex strata of code
9184 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9185 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9186 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9187 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9188 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9189 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9190 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9191 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9192 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9193 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9194 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9195
9196 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9197 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9198 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9199 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9200 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9201 expressions.
9202
9203 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9204 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9205 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9206 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9207 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9208 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9209 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9210 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9211
9212 @itemize
9213 @item
9214 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9215 processes.
9216
9217 @item
9218 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9219 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9220 introduced.
9221
9222 @item
9223 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9224 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9225 processes that use them.
9226 @end itemize
9227
9228 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9229 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9230 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9231 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9232 such that these objects can also be inserted
9233 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9234 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9235 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9236 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9237 below).
9238
9239 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9240
9241 @lisp
9242 (define build-exp
9243 #~(begin
9244 (mkdir #$output)
9245 (chdir #$output)
9246 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9247 "list-files")))
9248 @end lisp
9249
9250 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9251 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9252 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9253
9254 @lisp
9255 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9256 @end lisp
9257
9258 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9259 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9260 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9261 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9262 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9263 output of the derivation.
9264
9265 @cindex cross compilation
9266 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9267 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9268 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9269 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9270 native package build:
9271
9272 @lisp
9273 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9274 #~(begin
9275 (mkdir #$output)
9276 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9277 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9278 "-s"
9279 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9280 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9281 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9282 @end lisp
9283
9284 @noindent
9285 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9286 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9287 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9288
9289 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9290 @findex with-imported-modules
9291 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9292 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9293 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9294 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9295
9296 @lisp
9297 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9298 #~(begin
9299 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9300 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9301 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9302 #~(begin
9303 #$build
9304 (display "success!\n")
9305 #t)))
9306 @end lisp
9307
9308 @noindent
9309 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9310 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9311 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9312
9313 @cindex module closure
9314 @findex source-module-closure
9315 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9316 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9317 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9318 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9319 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9320 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9321
9322 @lisp
9323 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9324
9325 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9326 '((guix build utils)
9327 (gnu build vm)))
9328 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9329 #~(begin
9330 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9331 (gnu build vm))
9332 @dots{})))
9333 @end lisp
9334
9335 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9336 @findex with-extensions
9337 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9338 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9339 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9340 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9341
9342 @lisp
9343 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9344
9345 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9346 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9347 #~(begin
9348 (use-modules (json))
9349 @dots{})))
9350 @end lisp
9351
9352 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9353
9354 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9355 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9356 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9357 or more of the following forms:
9358
9359 @table @code
9360 @item #$@var{obj}
9361 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9362 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9363 supported types, for example a package or a
9364 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9365 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9366
9367 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9368 objects are substituted similarly.
9369
9370 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9371 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9372
9373 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9374
9375 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9376 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9377 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9378 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9379 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9380
9381 @item #+@var{obj}
9382 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9383 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9384 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9385 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9386 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9387
9388 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9389 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9390 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9391 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9392
9393 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9394
9395 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9396 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9397 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9398 containing list.
9399
9400 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9401 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9402 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9403 @var{lst}.
9404
9405 @end table
9406
9407 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9408 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9412 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9413 in their execution environment.
9414
9415 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9416 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9417 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9418
9419 @lisp
9420 `((guix build utils)
9421 (guix gcrypt)
9422 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9423 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9424 @end lisp
9425
9426 @noindent
9427 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9428 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9429
9430 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9431 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9432 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9433 @end deffn
9434
9435 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9436 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9437 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9438 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9439 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9440
9441 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9442 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9443 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9444 @var{body}@dots{}.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9448 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9452 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9453 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9454 information about monads).
9455
9456 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9457 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9458 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9459 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9460 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9461 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9462 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9463 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9464 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9465 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9466 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9467 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9468 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9469 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9470 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9471 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9472 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9473 to by @var{exp}.
9474
9475 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9476 Its meaning is to
9477 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9478 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9479 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9480 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9481 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9482
9483 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9484 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9485
9486 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9487 applicable.
9488
9489 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9490 following forms:
9491
9492 @example
9493 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9494 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9495 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9496 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9497 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9498 @end example
9499
9500 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9501 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9502 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9503 text format.
9504
9505 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9506 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9507 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9508 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9509 referenced by the outputs.
9510
9511 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9512 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9513
9514 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9515 @end deffn
9516
9517 @cindex file-like objects
9518 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9519 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9520 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9521 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9522
9523 @lisp
9524 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9525 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9526 @end lisp
9527
9528 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9529 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9530 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9531 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9532 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9533 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9534 content is directly passed as a string.
9535
9536 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9537 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9538 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9539 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9540 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9541 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9542 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9543 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9544 base name of @var{file}.
9545
9546 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9547 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9548 permission bits are kept.
9549
9550 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9551 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9552 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9553 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9554
9555 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9556 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9560 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9561 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9562
9563 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9564 @end deffn
9565
9566 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9567 [#:local-build? #t]
9568 [#:options '()]
9569 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9570 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9571 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9572 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9573
9574 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9575 @end deffn
9576
9577 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9578 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9579 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9580 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9581 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9582 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9583
9584 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9585 command:
9586
9587 @lisp
9588 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9589
9590 (gexp->script "list-files"
9591 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9592 "ls"))
9593 @end lisp
9594
9595 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9596 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9597 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9598
9599 @example
9600 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9601 !#
9602 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9603 @end example
9604 @end deffn
9605
9606 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9607 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9608 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9609 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9610 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9611
9612 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9613 @end deffn
9614
9615 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9616 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9617 [#:splice? #f] @
9618 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9619 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9620 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9621 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9622
9623 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9624 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9625 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9626 @var{module-path}.
9627
9628 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9629 or a subset thereof.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9633 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9634 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9635 @var{exp}.
9636
9637 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9638 @end deffn
9639
9640 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9641 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9642 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9643 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9644 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9645 references to all these.
9646
9647 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9648 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9649 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9650 like this:
9651
9652 @lisp
9653 (define (profile.sh)
9654 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9655 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9656 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9657 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9658 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9659 @end lisp
9660
9661 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9662 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9663 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9664 @end deffn
9665
9666 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9667 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9668 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9669 as in:
9670
9671 @lisp
9672 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9673 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9674 @end lisp
9675
9676 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9680 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9681 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9682 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9683 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9684
9685 @lisp
9686 (file-union "etc"
9687 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9688 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9689 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9690 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9691 @end lisp
9692
9693 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
9694 @end deffn
9695
9696 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
9697 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
9698 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
9699
9700 @lisp
9701 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
9702 @end lisp
9703
9704 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
9708 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
9709 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
9710 @var{suffix} is a string.
9711
9712 As an example, consider this gexp:
9713
9714 @lisp
9715 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9716 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
9717 "/bin/uname")))
9718 @end lisp
9719
9720 The same effect could be achieved with:
9721
9722 @lisp
9723 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9724 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
9725 "/bin/uname")))
9726 @end lisp
9727
9728 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
9729 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
9730 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
9731 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
9732 @end deffn
9733
9734 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
9735 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
9736 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
9737 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
9738
9739 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
9740 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
9741 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
9742 cross-compiling.
9743
9744 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
9745 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
9746
9747 @lisp
9748 #~(system*
9749 #+(let-system system
9750 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
9751 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
9752 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
9753 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
9754 (else
9755 (error "dunno!"))))
9756 "-net" "user" #$image)
9757 @end lisp
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
9761 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
9762 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
9763 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
9764 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
9765 derivation or store item.
9766
9767 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
9768 for a given object:
9769
9770 @lisp
9771 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
9772 coreutils)
9773 @end lisp
9774
9775 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
9776 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
9777 @end deffn
9778
9779
9780 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
9781 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
9782 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
9783 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
9784
9785 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9786 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
9787 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
9788 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
9789 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
9790
9791 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
9792 [#:target #f]
9793 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
9794 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
9795 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
9796 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @node Invoking guix repl
9800 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
9801
9802 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
9803 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
9804 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
9805 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
9806 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
9807 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
9808 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9809 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
9810 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
9811 dependencies are available in the search path.
9812
9813 The general syntax is:
9814
9815 @example
9816 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
9817 @end example
9818
9819 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
9820 executed as a Guile scripts:
9821
9822 @example
9823 guix repl my-script.scm
9824 @end example
9825
9826 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
9827 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
9828
9829 @example
9830 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
9831 @end example
9832
9833 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
9834 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
9835 lines at the top of the script:
9836
9837 @example
9838 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
9839 @code{!#}
9840 @end example
9841
9842 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
9843
9844 @example
9845 $ guix repl
9846 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
9847 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
9848 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
9849 @end example
9850
9851 @cindex inferiors
9852 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
9853 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
9854 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
9855 of Guix.
9856
9857 The available options are as follows:
9858
9859 @table @code
9860 @item --type=@var{type}
9861 @itemx -t @var{type}
9862 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
9863
9864 @table @code
9865 @item guile
9866 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
9867 @item machine
9868 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
9869 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
9870 @end table
9871
9872 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
9873 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
9874 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
9875 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
9876
9877 @table @code
9878 @item --listen=tcp:37146
9879 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
9880
9881 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
9882 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
9883 @end table
9884
9885 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9886 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9887 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9888 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9889
9890 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9891 the script or REPL.
9892
9893 @item -q
9894 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
9895 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
9896 @end table
9897
9898 @c *********************************************************************
9899 @node Utilities
9900 @chapter Utilities
9901
9902 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
9903 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
9904 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
9905 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
9906
9907 @menu
9908 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
9909 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
9910 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
9911 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
9912 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
9913 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
9914 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
9915 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
9916 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
9917 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
9918 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
9919 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
9920 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
9921 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
9922 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
9923 @end menu
9924
9925 @node Invoking guix build
9926 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
9927
9928 @cindex package building
9929 @cindex @command{guix build}
9930 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
9931 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
9932 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
9933 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
9934 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
9935
9936 The general syntax is:
9937
9938 @example
9939 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
9940 @end example
9941
9942 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
9943 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
9944 resulting directories:
9945
9946 @example
9947 guix build emacs guile
9948 @end example
9949
9950 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
9951
9952 @example
9953 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
9954 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
9955 @end example
9956
9957 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
9958 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
9959 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
9960 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
9961 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
9962 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9963
9964 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
9965 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
9966 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
9967 needed.
9968
9969 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
9970 described in the subsections below.
9971
9972 @menu
9973 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
9974 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
9975 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
9976 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
9977 @end menu
9978
9979 @node Common Build Options
9980 @subsection Common Build Options
9981
9982 A number of options that control the build process are common to
9983 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
9984 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
9985 following:
9986
9987 @table @code
9988
9989 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9990 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9991 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9992 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9993
9994 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9995 the command-line tools.
9996
9997 @item --keep-failed
9998 @itemx -K
9999 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10000 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10001 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10002 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10003 build issues.
10004
10005 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10006 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10007 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10008
10009 @item --keep-going
10010 @itemx -k
10011 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10012 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10013
10014 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10015 derivations has failed.
10016
10017 @item --dry-run
10018 @itemx -n
10019 Do not build the derivations.
10020
10021 @anchor{fallback-option}
10022 @item --fallback
10023 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10024 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10025
10026 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10027 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10028 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10029 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10030 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10031
10032 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10033 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10034 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10035
10036 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10037 disabled.
10038
10039 @item --no-substitutes
10040 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10041 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10042 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10043
10044 @item --no-grafts
10045 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10046 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10047 information on grafts.
10048
10049 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10050 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10051 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10052
10053 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10054 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10055 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10056 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10057
10058 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10059 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10060 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10061
10062 @item --no-offload
10063 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10064 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10065 builds to remote machines.
10066
10067 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10068 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10069 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10070
10071 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10072 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10073
10074 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10075 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10076 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10077
10078 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10079 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10080
10081 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10082 @c most programs honor it.
10083 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10084 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10085 @item -v @var{level}
10086 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10087 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
10088 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
10089 output on standard error.
10090
10091 @item --cores=@var{n}
10092 @itemx -c @var{n}
10093 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10094 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10095
10096 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10097 @itemx -M @var{n}
10098 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10099 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10100 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10101
10102 @item --debug=@var{level}
10103 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10104 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10105 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10106
10107 @end table
10108
10109 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10110 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10111 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10112 derivations)} module.
10113
10114 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10115 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10116 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10117
10118 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10119 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10120 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10121 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10122 below:
10123
10124 @example
10125 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10126 @end example
10127
10128 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10129 the parsed command-line options.
10130 @end defvr
10131
10132
10133 @node Package Transformation Options
10134 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10135
10136 @cindex package variants
10137 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10138 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10139 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10140 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10141 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10142 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10143 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10144
10145 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10146 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10147 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10148
10149 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10150 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10151 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10152 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10153
10154 @table @code
10155
10156 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10157 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10158 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10159 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10160 its version number.
10161 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10162 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10163
10164 When @var{package} is omitted,
10165 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10166 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10167 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10168 package is @code{guile}.
10169
10170 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10171 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10172
10173 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10174 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10175 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10176 the @code{ed} package:
10177
10178 @example
10179 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10180 @end example
10181
10182 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10183 candidates:
10184
10185 @example
10186 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10187 @end example
10188
10189 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10190
10191 @example
10192 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10193 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10194 @end example
10195
10196 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10197 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10198 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10199 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10200 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10201
10202 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10203 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10204 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10205
10206 @example
10207 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10208 @end example
10209
10210 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10211 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10212 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10213
10214 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10215 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10216
10217 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10218 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10219 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10220 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10221 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10222 information on grafts.
10223
10224 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10225 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10226 they currently refer to:
10227
10228 @example
10229 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10230 @end example
10231
10232 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10233 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10234 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10235 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10236 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10237 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10238 care!
10239
10240 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10241 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10242 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10243 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10244 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10245 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10246
10247 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10248 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10249 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10250 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10251 Inkscape:
10252
10253 @example
10254 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10255 @end example
10256
10257 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10258 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10259
10260 @quotation Note
10261 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10262 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10263 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10264 that case, an error is raised.
10265
10266 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10267 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10268 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10269 @end quotation
10270
10271 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10272 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10273 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10274 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10275 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10276
10277 Consider this example:
10278
10279 @example
10280 guix build octave-cli \
10281 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10282 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10283 @end example
10284
10285 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10286 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10287 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10288 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10289 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10290
10291 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10292 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10293 compiler:
10294
10295 @example
10296 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10297 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10298 @end example
10299
10300 @quotation Note
10301 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10302 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10303 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP. By rebuilding all
10304 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10305 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10306 @var{package} wisely.
10307 @end quotation
10308
10309 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10310 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10311 @cindex latest commit, building
10312 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10313 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10314 recursively.
10315
10316 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10317 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10318
10319 @example
10320 guix build python-numpy \
10321 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10322 @end example
10323
10324 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10325 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10326
10327 @cindex continuous integration
10328 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10329 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10330 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10331 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10332 integration (CI).
10333
10334 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10335 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10336 in a while to save disk space.
10337
10338 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10339 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10340 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10341 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10342 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10343 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10344
10345 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10346 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10347 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10348 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10349
10350 @example
10351 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10352 @end example
10353
10354 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10355 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10356 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10357 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
10358
10359 @cindex test suite, skipping
10360 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10361 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10362 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10363 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10364 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10365 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10366
10367 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10368 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10369 rebuilt, as in this example:
10370
10371 @example
10372 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10373 @end example
10374
10375 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10376 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10377 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10378 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10379
10380 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10381 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10382 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10383 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10384 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10385
10386 @end table
10387
10388 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10389 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10390 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10391 interfaces available.
10392
10393 @node Additional Build Options
10394 @subsection Additional Build Options
10395
10396 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10397 build}.
10398
10399 @table @code
10400
10401 @item --quiet
10402 @itemx -q
10403 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10404 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10405 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10406
10407 @item --file=@var{file}
10408 @itemx -f @var{file}
10409 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10410 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10411
10412 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10413 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10414
10415 @lisp
10416 @include package-hello.scm
10417 @end lisp
10418
10419 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10420 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10421 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10422 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10423
10424 @example
10425 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10426 @end example
10427
10428 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10429 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10430 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10431 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10432
10433 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10434 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10435 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10436
10437 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10438 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10439 version 1.8 of Guile.
10440
10441 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10442 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10443 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10444
10445 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10446 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10447 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10448
10449 @item --source
10450 @itemx -S
10451 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10452 themselves.
10453
10454 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10455 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10456 source tarball.
10457
10458 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10459 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10460 Packages}).
10461
10462 @cindex source, verification
10463 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10464 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10465 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10466 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10467 hash.
10468
10469 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10470 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10471 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10472 the packages.
10473
10474 @item --sources
10475 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10476 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10477 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10478 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10479 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10480 optional argument values:
10481
10482 @table @code
10483 @item package
10484 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10485 as the @option{--source} option.
10486
10487 @item all
10488 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10489 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10490
10491 @example
10492 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10493 The following derivations will be built:
10494 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10495 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10496 @end example
10497
10498 @item transitive
10499 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10500 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10501 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10502
10503 @example
10504 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10505 The following derivations will be built:
10506 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10507 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10508 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10509 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10510 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10511 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10512 @dots{}
10513 @end example
10514
10515 @end table
10516
10517 @item --system=@var{system}
10518 @itemx -s @var{system}
10519 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10520 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10521 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10522 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10523
10524 @quotation Note
10525 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10526 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10527 information on cross-compilation.
10528 @end quotation
10529
10530 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10531 different personalities. For instance, passing
10532 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10533 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10534 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10535
10536 @quotation Note
10537 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10538 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10539 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10540 @end quotation
10541
10542 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10543 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10544 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10545 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10546
10547 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10548 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10549 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10550
10551 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10552 @cindex cross-compilation
10553 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10554 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10555 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10556
10557 @anchor{build-check}
10558 @item --check
10559 @cindex determinism, checking
10560 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10561 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10562 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10563 identical.
10564
10565 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10566 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10567 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10568 background information and tools.
10569
10570 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10571 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10572 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10573
10574 @item --repair
10575 @cindex repairing store items
10576 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10577 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10578 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10579
10580 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10581
10582 @item --derivations
10583 @itemx -d
10584 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10585 packages.
10586
10587 @item --root=@var{file}
10588 @itemx -r @var{file}
10589 @cindex GC roots, adding
10590 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10591 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10592 collector root.
10593
10594 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10595 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10596 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10597 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10598 more on GC roots.
10599
10600 @item --log-file
10601 @cindex build logs, access
10602 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10603 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10604 missing.
10605
10606 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10607 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10608
10609 @example
10610 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
10611 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
10612 guix build --log-file guile
10613 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10614 @end example
10615
10616 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10617 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10618 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10619
10620 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10621 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10622
10623 @example
10624 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10625 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10626 @end example
10627
10628 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10629 @end table
10630
10631 @node Debugging Build Failures
10632 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
10633
10634 @cindex build failures, debugging
10635 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
10636 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
10637 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
10638 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
10639 build daemon uses.
10640
10641 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
10642 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
10643 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
10644 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
10645
10646 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
10647 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
10648 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
10649 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
10650 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
10651
10652 @example
10653 $ guix build foo -K
10654 @dots{} @i{build fails}
10655 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10656 $ source ./environment-variables
10657 $ cd foo-1.2
10658 @end example
10659
10660 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
10661 troubleshoot your build process.
10662
10663 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
10664 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
10665 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
10666 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
10667 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10668
10669 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
10670 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
10671
10672 @example
10673 $ guix build -K foo
10674 @dots{}
10675 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10676 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
10677 [env]# source ./environment-variables
10678 [env]# cd foo-1.2
10679 @end example
10680
10681 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
10682 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
10683 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
10684 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
10685 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
10686 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
10687 info on grafts).
10688
10689 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
10690 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
10691
10692 @example
10693 [env]# rm /bin/sh
10694 @end example
10695
10696 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
10697 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
10698
10699 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
10700 can run:
10701
10702 @example
10703 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
10704 @end example
10705
10706 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
10707 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
10708 similar to the one the daemon uses.
10709
10710
10711 @node Invoking guix edit
10712 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
10713
10714 @cindex @command{guix edit}
10715 @cindex package definition, editing
10716 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
10717 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
10718 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
10719 For instance:
10720
10721 @example
10722 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
10723 @end example
10724
10725 @noindent
10726 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
10727 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
10728 and that of Vim.
10729
10730 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
10731 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
10732 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
10733 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
10734 for packages currently in the store.
10735
10736 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
10737 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
10738 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
10739 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
10740
10741 @node Invoking guix download
10742 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
10743
10744 @cindex @command{guix download}
10745 @cindex downloading package sources
10746 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
10747 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
10748 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
10749 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
10750 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
10751 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
10752
10753 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
10754 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
10755 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
10756 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
10757 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
10758 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10759
10760 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
10761 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
10762 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
10763 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
10764 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
10765 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
10766 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
10767
10768 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
10769 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
10770 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
10771 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
10772
10773 The following options are available:
10774
10775 @table @code
10776 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10777 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10778 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
10779 hash}, for more information.
10780
10781 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10782 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10783 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
10784 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
10785
10786 @item --no-check-certificate
10787 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
10788
10789 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
10790 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
10791 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
10792
10793 @item --output=@var{file}
10794 @itemx -o @var{file}
10795 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
10796 store.
10797 @end table
10798
10799 @node Invoking guix hash
10800 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
10801
10802 @cindex @command{guix hash}
10803 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
10804 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
10805 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
10806 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10807
10808 The general syntax is:
10809
10810 @example
10811 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
10812 @end example
10813
10814 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
10815 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
10816 following options:
10817
10818 @table @code
10819
10820 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10821 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10822 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
10823 default.
10824
10825 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
10826 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
10827 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
10828 Reference Manual}).
10829
10830 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10831 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10832 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
10833
10834 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
10835 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
10836
10837 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
10838 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
10839 in the definitions of packages.
10840
10841 @item --recursive
10842 @itemx -r
10843 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
10844
10845 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
10846 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
10847 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
10848 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
10849 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
10850 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
10851 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
10852 @c it exists.
10853
10854 @item --exclude-vcs
10855 @itemx -x
10856 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
10857 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
10858
10859 @vindex git-fetch
10860 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
10861 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
10862 Reference}):
10863
10864 @example
10865 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
10866 $ cd foo
10867 $ guix hash -rx .
10868 @end example
10869 @end table
10870
10871 @node Invoking guix import
10872 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
10873
10874 @cindex importing packages
10875 @cindex package import
10876 @cindex package conversion
10877 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
10878 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
10879 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
10880 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
10881 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
10882 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
10883 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10884
10885 The general syntax is:
10886
10887 @example
10888 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
10889 @end example
10890
10891 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
10892 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
10893 options specific to @var{importer}.
10894
10895 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
10896 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
10897 gnupg} if needed.
10898
10899 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
10900
10901 @table @code
10902 @item gnu
10903 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
10904 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
10905 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
10906
10907 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
10908 license needs to be figured out manually.
10909
10910 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
10911 GNU@tie{}Hello:
10912
10913 @example
10914 guix import gnu hello
10915 @end example
10916
10917 Specific command-line options are:
10918
10919 @table @code
10920 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
10921 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
10922 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
10923 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
10924 @end table
10925
10926 @item pypi
10927 @cindex pypi
10928 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
10929 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
10930 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
10931 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
10932 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
10933 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
10934
10935 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
10936 package:
10937
10938 @example
10939 guix import pypi itsdangerous
10940 @end example
10941
10942 @table @code
10943 @item --recursive
10944 @itemx -r
10945 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
10946 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
10947 in Guix.
10948 @end table
10949
10950 @item gem
10951 @cindex gem
10952 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
10953 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
10954 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
10955 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
10956 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
10957 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
10958 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
10959 as an exercise to the packager.
10960
10961 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
10962
10963 @example
10964 guix import gem rails
10965 @end example
10966
10967 @table @code
10968 @item --recursive
10969 @itemx -r
10970 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
10971 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
10972 in Guix.
10973 @end table
10974
10975 @item cpan
10976 @cindex CPAN
10977 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
10978 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
10979 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
10980 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
10981 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
10982 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
10983 list of dependencies.
10984
10985 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
10986 module:
10987
10988 @example
10989 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
10990 @end example
10991
10992 @item cran
10993 @cindex CRAN
10994 @cindex Bioconductor
10995 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
10996 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
10997 statistical and graphical environment}.
10998
10999 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11000
11001 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11002
11003 @example
11004 guix import cran Cairo
11005 @end example
11006
11007 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11008 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11009 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11010
11011 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11012 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11013 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11014 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11015
11016 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11017 package archive.
11018
11019 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11020
11021 @example
11022 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11023 @end example
11024
11025 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11026 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11027 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11028
11029 @example
11030 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11031 @end example
11032
11033 @item texlive
11034 @cindex TeX Live
11035 @cindex CTAN
11036 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11037 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11038 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11039
11040 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11041 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11042 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11043 versioned archives.
11044
11045 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11046 TeX package:
11047
11048 @example
11049 guix import texlive fontspec
11050 @end example
11051
11052 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11053 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11054 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11055 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11056
11057 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11058 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11059 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11060
11061 @example
11062 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11063 @end example
11064
11065 @item json
11066 @cindex JSON, import
11067 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11068 example package definition in JSON format:
11069
11070 @example
11071 @{
11072 "name": "hello",
11073 "version": "2.10",
11074 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11075 "build-system": "gnu",
11076 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11077 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11078 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11079 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11080 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11081 @}
11082 @end example
11083
11084 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11085 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11086 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11087 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11088
11089 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11090 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11091
11092 @example
11093 @{
11094 @dots{}
11095 "source": @{
11096 "method": "url-fetch",
11097 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11098 "sha256": @{
11099 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11100 @}
11101 @}
11102 @dots{}
11103 @}
11104 @end example
11105
11106 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11107 and outputs a package expression:
11108
11109 @example
11110 guix import json hello.json
11111 @end example
11112
11113 @item nix
11114 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
11115 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
11116 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
11117 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
11118 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
11119 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
11120 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
11121 package definition.
11122
11123 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
11124 by their canonical upstream variant.
11125
11126 Usually, you will first need to do:
11127
11128 @example
11129 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
11130 @end example
11131
11132 @noindent
11133 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
11134
11135 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
11136 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
11137 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
11138
11139 @example
11140 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
11141 @end example
11142
11143 @item hackage
11144 @cindex hackage
11145 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11146 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11147 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11148 dependencies.
11149
11150 Specific command-line options are:
11151
11152 @table @code
11153 @item --stdin
11154 @itemx -s
11155 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11156 @item --no-test-dependencies
11157 @itemx -t
11158 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11159 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11160 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11161 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11162 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11163 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11164 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11165 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11166 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11167 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11168 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11169 @item --recursive
11170 @itemx -r
11171 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11172 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11173 in Guix.
11174 @end table
11175
11176 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11177 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11178 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11179
11180 @example
11181 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11182 @end example
11183
11184 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11185 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11186
11187 @example
11188 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11189 @end example
11190
11191 @item stackage
11192 @cindex stackage
11193 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11194 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11195 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11196 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11197 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11198 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11199
11200 Specific command-line options are:
11201
11202 @table @code
11203 @item --no-test-dependencies
11204 @itemx -t
11205 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11206 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11207 @itemx -l @var{version}
11208 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11209 release is used.
11210 @item --recursive
11211 @itemx -r
11212 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11213 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11214 in Guix.
11215 @end table
11216
11217 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11218 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11219
11220 @example
11221 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11222 @end example
11223
11224 @item elpa
11225 @cindex elpa
11226 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11227 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11228
11229 Specific command-line options are:
11230
11231 @table @code
11232 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11233 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11234 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11235 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11236 are:
11237 @itemize -
11238 @item
11239 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11240 identifier. This is the default.
11241
11242 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11243 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11244 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11245 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11246 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11247
11248 @item
11249 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11250 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11251
11252 @item
11253 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11254 identifier.
11255 @end itemize
11256
11257 @item --recursive
11258 @itemx -r
11259 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11260 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11261 in Guix.
11262 @end table
11263
11264 @item crate
11265 @cindex crate
11266 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11267 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11268
11269 @example
11270 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11271 @end example
11272
11273 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11274
11275 @example
11276 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11277 @end example
11278
11279 Additional options include:
11280
11281 @table @code
11282 @item --recursive
11283 @itemx -r
11284 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11285 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11286 in Guix.
11287 @end table
11288
11289 @item opam
11290 @cindex OPAM
11291 @cindex OCaml
11292 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11293 repository used by the OCaml community.
11294 @end table
11295
11296 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11297 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11298 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11299
11300 @node Invoking guix refresh
11301 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11302
11303 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11304 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
11305 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
11306 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
11307 upstream version, like this:
11308
11309 @example
11310 $ guix refresh
11311 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11312 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11313 @end example
11314
11315 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11316 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11317
11318 @example
11319 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11320 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11321 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11322 @end example
11323
11324 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11325 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11326 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11327 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11328 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11329 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11330 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11331
11332 @table @code
11333
11334 @item --recursive
11335 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11336
11337 @example
11338 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11339 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
11340 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11341 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11342 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11343 @dots{}
11344 @end example
11345
11346 @end table
11347
11348 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11349 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11350 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11351 to that effect:
11352
11353 @lisp
11354 (define-public network-manager
11355 (package
11356 (name "network-manager")
11357 ;; @dots{}
11358 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11359 @end lisp
11360
11361 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11362 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11363 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11364 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11365 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11366 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11367 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11368
11369 When the public
11370 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11371 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11372 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11373 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11374
11375 The following options are supported:
11376
11377 @table @code
11378
11379 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11380 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11381 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11382
11383 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11384
11385 @example
11386 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11387 @end example
11388
11389 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11390 the packages).
11391
11392 @item --update
11393 @itemx -u
11394 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11395 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11396 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11397
11398 @example
11399 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11400 @end example
11401
11402 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11403
11404 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11405 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11406 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11407 @code{non-core}.
11408
11409 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11410 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11411 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11412 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11413 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11414 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11415
11416 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11417 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11418 inconvenient.
11419
11420 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11421 @itemx -m @var{file}
11422 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11423 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11424
11425 @item --type=@var{updater}
11426 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11427 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11428 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11429
11430 @table @code
11431 @item gnu
11432 the updater for GNU packages;
11433 @item savannah
11434 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11435 @item gnome
11436 the updater for GNOME packages;
11437 @item kde
11438 the updater for KDE packages;
11439 @item xorg
11440 the updater for X.org packages;
11441 @item kernel.org
11442 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11443 @item elpa
11444 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11445 @item cran
11446 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11447 @item bioconductor
11448 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11449 @item cpan
11450 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11451 @item pypi
11452 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11453 @item gem
11454 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11455 @item github
11456 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11457 @item hackage
11458 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11459 @item stackage
11460 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11461 @item crate
11462 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11463 @item launchpad
11464 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11465 @end table
11466
11467 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11468 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11469
11470 @example
11471 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11472 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11473 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11474 @end example
11475
11476 @end table
11477
11478 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11479 names, as in this example:
11480
11481 @example
11482 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
11483 @end example
11484
11485 @noindent
11486 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
11487 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
11488 effect in this case.
11489
11490 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
11491 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
11492 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
11493 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
11494
11495 @table @code
11496
11497 @item --list-updaters
11498 @itemx -L
11499 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11500
11501 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11502 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11503
11504 @item --list-dependent
11505 @itemx -l
11506 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
11507 result of upgrading one or more packages.
11508
11509 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
11510 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
11511 dependents of a package.
11512
11513 @end table
11514
11515 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
11516 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
11517 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
11518
11519 @example
11520 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
11521 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
11522 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
11523 @end example
11524
11525 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
11526 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
11527
11528 @table @code
11529
11530 @item --list-transitive
11531 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
11532
11533 @example
11534 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
11535 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
11536 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
11537 @end example
11538
11539 @end table
11540
11541 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
11542 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
11543
11544 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
11545
11546 @table @code
11547
11548 @item --gpg=@var{command}
11549 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
11550 for in @code{$PATH}.
11551
11552 @item --keyring=@var{file}
11553 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
11554 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
11555 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
11556 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
11557 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
11558
11559 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
11560 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
11561 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
11562 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
11563 @option{--key-download} below).
11564
11565 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
11566 commands like this one:
11567
11568 @example
11569 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
11570 @end example
11571
11572 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
11573
11574 @example
11575 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
11576 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
11577 @end example
11578
11579 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
11580 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
11581
11582 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11583 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
11584 of:
11585
11586 @table @code
11587 @item always
11588 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
11589 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
11590
11591 @item never
11592 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
11593
11594 @item interactive
11595 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
11596 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
11597 @end table
11598
11599 @item --key-server=@var{host}
11600 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
11601
11602 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11603 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11604 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11605
11606 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11607 the command-line tools.
11608
11609 @end table
11610
11611 The @code{github} updater uses the
11612 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
11613 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
11614 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
11615 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
11616 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
11617 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
11618 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
11619 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
11620 otherwise.
11621
11622
11623 @node Invoking guix lint
11624 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
11625
11626 @cindex @command{guix lint}
11627 @cindex package, checking for errors
11628 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
11629 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
11630 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
11631 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
11632 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
11633
11634 @table @code
11635 @item synopsis
11636 @itemx description
11637 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
11638 descriptions and synopses.
11639
11640 @item inputs-should-be-native
11641 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
11642
11643 @item source
11644 @itemx home-page
11645 @itemx mirror-url
11646 @itemx github-url
11647 @itemx source-file-name
11648 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
11649 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
11650 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
11651 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
11652 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
11653 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
11654
11655 @item source-unstable-tarball
11656 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
11657 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
11658 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
11659
11660 @item derivation
11661 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
11662 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
11663
11664 @item profile-collisions
11665 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
11666 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
11667 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
11668 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
11669 on propagated inputs.
11670
11671 @item archival
11672 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
11673 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
11674 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
11675 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
11676
11677 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
11678 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
11679 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
11680 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
11681 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
11682 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
11683 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
11684
11685 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
11686 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
11687 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
11688 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
11689
11690 Software Heritage
11691 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
11692 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
11693 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
11694 that limit has been reset.
11695
11696 @item cve
11697 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11698 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
11699 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
11700 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
11701 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
11702 NIST}.
11703
11704 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
11705
11706 @itemize
11707 @item
11708 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11709 @item
11710 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11711 @end itemize
11712
11713 @noindent
11714 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
11715 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
11716
11717 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
11718 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
11719 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
11720 that Guix uses, as in this example:
11721
11722 @lisp
11723 (package
11724 (name "grub")
11725 ;; @dots{}
11726 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
11727 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
11728 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
11729 @end lisp
11730
11731 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
11732 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
11733 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
11734 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
11735 declare them as in this example:
11736
11737 @lisp
11738 (package
11739 (name "t1lib")
11740 ;; @dots{}
11741 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
11742 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
11743 "CVE-2011-1553"
11744 "CVE-2011-1554"
11745 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
11746 @end lisp
11747
11748 @item formatting
11749 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
11750 use of tabulations, etc.
11751 @end table
11752
11753 The general syntax is:
11754
11755 @example
11756 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
11757 @end example
11758
11759 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
11760 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
11761
11762 @table @code
11763 @item --list-checkers
11764 @itemx -l
11765 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
11766 and exit.
11767
11768 @item --checkers
11769 @itemx -c
11770 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11771 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11772
11773 @item --exclude
11774 @itemx -x
11775 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
11776 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
11777
11778 @item --no-network
11779 @itemx -n
11780 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
11781
11782 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11783 @itemx -L @var{directory}
11784 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11785 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11786
11787 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11788 the command-line tools.
11789
11790 @end table
11791
11792 @node Invoking guix size
11793 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
11794
11795 @cindex size
11796 @cindex package size
11797 @cindex closure
11798 @cindex @command{guix size}
11799 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
11800 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
11801 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
11802 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
11803 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
11804 @command{guix size} can highlight.
11805
11806 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
11807 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
11808 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
11809 example:
11810
11811 @example
11812 $ guix size coreutils
11813 store item total self
11814 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
11815 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
11816 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
11817 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
11818 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
11819 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
11820 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
11821 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
11822 total: 78.9 MiB
11823 @end example
11824
11825 @cindex closure
11826 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
11827 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
11828 would be returned by:
11829
11830 @example
11831 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
11832 @end example
11833
11834 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
11835 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
11836 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
11837 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
11838 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
11839 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
11840
11841 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
11842 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
11843 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
11844 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
11845 on the system anyway.)
11846
11847 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
11848 a build result is straightforward:
11849
11850 @example
11851 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
11852 @end example
11853
11854 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
11855 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
11856 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
11857 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
11858 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
11859 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
11860 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
11861 Coreutils}).
11862
11863 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
11864 reports information based on the available substitutes
11865 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
11866 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
11867
11868 You can also specify several package names:
11869
11870 @example
11871 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
11872 store item total self
11873 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
11874 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
11875 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
11876 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
11877 @dots{}
11878 total: 102.3 MiB
11879 @end example
11880
11881 @noindent
11882 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
11883 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
11884 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
11885
11886 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
11887 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
11888 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
11889 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
11890 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
11891
11892 The available options are:
11893
11894 @table @option
11895
11896 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
11897 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
11898 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
11899
11900 @item --sort=@var{key}
11901 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
11902
11903 @table @code
11904 @item self
11905 the size of each item (the default);
11906 @item closure
11907 the total size of the item's closure.
11908 @end table
11909
11910 @item --map-file=@var{file}
11911 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
11912
11913 For the example above, the map looks like this:
11914
11915 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
11916 produced by @command{guix size}}
11917
11918 This option requires that
11919 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
11920 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
11921 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
11922
11923 @item --system=@var{system}
11924 @itemx -s @var{system}
11925 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
11926
11927 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11928 @itemx -L @var{directory}
11929 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11930 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11931
11932 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11933 the command-line tools.
11934 @end table
11935
11936 @node Invoking guix graph
11937 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
11938
11939 @cindex DAG
11940 @cindex @command{guix graph}
11941 @cindex package dependencies
11942 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
11943 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
11944 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
11945 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
11946 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
11947 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
11948 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
11949 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
11950 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
11951 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
11952 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
11953 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
11954 packages. The general syntax is:
11955
11956 @example
11957 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
11958 @end example
11959
11960 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
11961 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
11962 dependencies:
11963
11964 @example
11965 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
11966 @end example
11967
11968 The output looks like this:
11969
11970 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
11971
11972 Nice little graph, no?
11973
11974 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
11975 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
11976
11977 @example
11978 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
11979 @end example
11980
11981 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
11982 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
11983 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
11984 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
11985 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
11986
11987 @table @code
11988 @item package
11989 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
11990 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
11991 filters out many details.
11992
11993 @item reverse-package
11994 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
11995
11996 @example
11997 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
11998 @end example
11999
12000 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12001 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12002 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12003
12004 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12005 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12006 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12007 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12008
12009 @item bag-emerged
12010 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12011
12012 For instance, the following command:
12013
12014 @example
12015 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12016 @end example
12017
12018 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12019
12020 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12021
12022 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12023 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12024
12025 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12026 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12027 here, for conciseness.
12028
12029 @item bag
12030 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12031 dependencies.
12032
12033 @item bag-with-origins
12034 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12035
12036 @item reverse-bag
12037 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12038 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12039
12040 @example
12041 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12042 @end example
12043
12044 @noindent
12045 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12046 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12047 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12048 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12049
12050 @item derivation
12051 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12052 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12053 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12054 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12055
12056 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12057 name instead of a package name, as in:
12058
12059 @example
12060 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
12061 @end example
12062
12063 @item module
12064 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12065 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12066 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12067
12068 @example
12069 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12070 @end example
12071 @end table
12072
12073 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12074 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12075
12076 @table @code
12077 @item references
12078 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12079 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12080
12081 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12082 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12083
12084 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12085 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12086 (which can be big!):
12087
12088 @example
12089 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12090 @end example
12091
12092 @item referrers
12093 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12094 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12095
12096 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12097 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12098 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12099 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12100 to it.
12101
12102 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12103 collected.
12104
12105 @end table
12106
12107 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12108 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12109 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12110 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12111 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12112 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12113 etc.):
12114
12115 @example
12116 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12117 emacs@@26.3
12118 mailutils@@3.9
12119 libunistring@@0.9.10
12120 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12121 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12122 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12123 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12124 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12125 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12126 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12127 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12128 @end example
12129
12130 The available options are the following:
12131
12132 @table @option
12133 @item --type=@var{type}
12134 @itemx -t @var{type}
12135 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12136 the values listed above.
12137
12138 @item --list-types
12139 List the supported graph types.
12140
12141 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12142 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12143 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12144
12145 @item --list-backends
12146 List the supported graph backends.
12147
12148 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12149
12150 @item --path
12151 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12152 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12153 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12154 @code{libreoffice}:
12155
12156 @example
12157 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12158 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12159 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12160 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12161 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12162 @end example
12163
12164 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12165 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12166 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12167
12168 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12169
12170 @example
12171 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12172 @end example
12173
12174 @item --system=@var{system}
12175 @itemx -s @var{system}
12176 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12177
12178 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12179 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12180
12181 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12182 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12183 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12184 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12185
12186 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12187 the command-line tools.
12188 @end table
12189
12190 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12191 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12192 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12193 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12194 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12195 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12196
12197 @example
12198 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12199 @end example
12200
12201 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12202
12203 @node Invoking guix publish
12204 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12205
12206 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12207 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12208 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12209 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12210
12211 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12212 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12213 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12214 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12215 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
12216
12217 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12218 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12219 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12220 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12221 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12222
12223 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12224 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12225 guix archive}).
12226
12227 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12228 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12229 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12230 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12231
12232 The general syntax is:
12233
12234 @example
12235 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12236 @end example
12237
12238 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12239 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12240
12241 @example
12242 guix publish
12243 @end example
12244
12245 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12246 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12247
12248 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12249 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12250 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12251 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12252 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12253 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12254 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12255
12256 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12257 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12258 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12259 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12260 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12261 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12262
12263 @example
12264 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12265 @end example
12266
12267 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12268 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12269
12270 @cindex build logs, publication
12271 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12272
12273 @example
12274 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12275 @end example
12276
12277 @noindent
12278 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12279 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12280 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12281 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12282 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12283 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12284 Bzip2 compression.
12285
12286 The following options are available:
12287
12288 @table @code
12289 @item --port=@var{port}
12290 @itemx -p @var{port}
12291 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12292
12293 @item --listen=@var{host}
12294 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12295 accept connections from any interface.
12296
12297 @item --user=@var{user}
12298 @itemx -u @var{user}
12299 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12300 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12301
12302 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12303 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12304 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12305 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
12306 is used.
12307
12308 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12309 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12310 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12311
12312 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
12313 increase in CPU usage; see
12314 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
12315 page}.
12316
12317 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12318 the compressed streams are not
12319 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12320 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12321 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12322 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12323 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12324 to its responses.
12325
12326 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12327 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12328 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12329 the one they support.
12330
12331 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12332 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12333 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12334 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12335
12336 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12337 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12338 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12339 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12340 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12341 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12342 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12343
12344 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12345 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12346 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12347 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12348 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12349 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12350 the best possible bandwidth.
12351
12352 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12353 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12354 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12355 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12356 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12357 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12358
12359 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12360 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12361 @option{--workers} below.
12362
12363 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12364 when they have expired.
12365
12366 @item --workers=@var{N}
12367 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12368 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12369
12370 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12371 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12372 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12373 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12374
12375 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12376 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12377 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12378 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12379
12380 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12381 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12382 item in the store, may be deleted.
12383
12384 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12385 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12386 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12387 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12388 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12389
12390 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12391 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12392 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12393 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12394
12395 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12396 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12397 not popular.
12398
12399 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12400 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12401 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12402
12403 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12404 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12405 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12406
12407 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12408 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12409 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12410 the store items being published.
12411
12412 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12413 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12414 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12415 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12416 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12417 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12418
12419 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12420 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12421 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12422 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12423 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12424 @end table
12425
12426 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12427 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12428 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12429 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12430
12431 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12432 instructions:
12433
12434 @itemize
12435 @item
12436 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12437
12438 @example
12439 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12440 /etc/systemd/system/
12441 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12442 @end example
12443
12444 @item
12445 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12446
12447 @example
12448 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12449 # start guix-publish
12450 @end example
12451
12452 @item
12453 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
12454 @end itemize
12455
12456 @node Invoking guix challenge
12457 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
12458
12459 @cindex reproducible builds
12460 @cindex verifiable builds
12461 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
12462 @cindex challenge
12463 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
12464 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
12465 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
12466 answer.
12467
12468 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
12469 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
12470 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
12471 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
12472 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
12473 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
12474 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
12475
12476 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
12477 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
12478 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
12479 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
12480 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
12481 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
12482 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
12483 any given store item.
12484
12485 The command output looks like this:
12486
12487 @smallexample
12488 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12489 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
12490 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12491 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
12492 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12493 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12494 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
12495 differing files:
12496 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
12497 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
12498
12499 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
12500 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
12501 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
12502 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
12503 differing file:
12504 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
12505
12506 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
12507 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12508 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12509 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
12510 differing file:
12511 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
12512
12513 @dots{}
12514
12515 6,406 store items were analyzed:
12516 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
12517 - 525 (8.2%) differed
12518 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
12519 @end smallexample
12520
12521 @noindent
12522 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
12523 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
12524 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
12525 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
12526 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
12527
12528 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
12529 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
12530 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
12531 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
12532 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
12533 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
12534 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
12535 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
12536 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
12537 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
12538 more information.
12539
12540 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
12541 to run:
12542
12543 @example
12544 guix challenge git \
12545 --diff=diffoscope \
12546 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12547 @end example
12548
12549 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
12550 information about files that differ.
12551
12552 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
12553 archive}):
12554
12555 @example
12556 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
12557 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
12558 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
12559 @end example
12560
12561 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
12562 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
12563 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
12564 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
12565 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
12566 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
12567 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
12568
12569 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
12570 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
12571 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
12572 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
12573 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
12574 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
12575 the problem.
12576
12577 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
12578 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
12579 same build result as you did with:
12580
12581 @example
12582 $ guix challenge @var{package}
12583 @end example
12584
12585 @noindent
12586 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
12587 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
12588
12589 The general syntax is:
12590
12591 @example
12592 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12593 @end example
12594
12595 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
12596 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
12597 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
12598 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
12599 errors).
12600
12601 The one option that matters is:
12602
12603 @table @code
12604
12605 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12606 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
12607 URLs to compare to.
12608
12609 @item --diff=@var{mode}
12610 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
12611
12612 @table @asis
12613 @item @code{simple} (the default)
12614 Show the list of files that differ.
12615
12616 @item @code{diffoscope}
12617 @itemx @var{command}
12618 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
12619 two directories whose contents do not match.
12620
12621 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
12622 of Diffoscope.
12623
12624 @item @code{none}
12625 Do not show further details about the differences.
12626 @end table
12627
12628 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
12629 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
12630 can compare them.
12631
12632 @item --verbose
12633 @itemx -v
12634 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
12635 information about mismatches.
12636
12637 @end table
12638
12639 @node Invoking guix copy
12640 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
12641
12642 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
12643 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
12644 @cindex sharing store items across machines
12645 @cindex transferring store items across machines
12646 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
12647 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
12648 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
12649 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
12650 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
12651 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
12652
12653 @example
12654 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
12655 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12656 @end example
12657
12658 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
12659 they are not actually sent.
12660
12661 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
12662 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
12663
12664 @example
12665 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
12666 @end example
12667
12668 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
12669 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
12670 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
12671
12672 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
12673 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
12674 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
12675 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
12676 store item authentication.
12677
12678 The general syntax is:
12679
12680 @example
12681 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
12682 @end example
12683
12684 You must always specify one of the following options:
12685
12686 @table @code
12687 @item --to=@var{spec}
12688 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
12689 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
12690 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
12691 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
12692 @end table
12693
12694 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
12695 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
12696
12697 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
12698 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
12699 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
12700
12701
12702 @node Invoking guix container
12703 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
12704 @cindex container
12705 @cindex @command{guix container}
12706 @quotation Note
12707 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
12708 is subject to radical change in the future.
12709 @end quotation
12710
12711 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
12712 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
12713 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
12714 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
12715 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
12716
12717 The general syntax is:
12718
12719 @example
12720 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
12721 @end example
12722
12723 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
12724 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
12725
12726 The following actions are available:
12727
12728 @table @code
12729 @item exec
12730 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
12731
12732 The syntax is:
12733
12734 @example
12735 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
12736 @end example
12737
12738 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
12739 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
12740 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
12741 will be passed to @var{program}.
12742
12743 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
12744 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
12745 process ID is 9001:
12746
12747 @example
12748 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
12749 @end example
12750
12751 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
12752 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
12753
12754 @end table
12755
12756 @node Invoking guix weather
12757 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
12758
12759 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
12760 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
12761 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
12762 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
12763 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
12764 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12765 publish}).
12766
12767 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
12768 @cindex availability of substitutes
12769 @cindex substitute availability
12770 @cindex weather, substitute availability
12771 Here's a sample run:
12772
12773 @example
12774 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
12775 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
12776 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
12777 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12778 https://guix.example.org
12779 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
12780 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
12781 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
12782 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
12783 33.5 requests per second
12784
12785 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
12786 867 queued builds
12787 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
12788 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
12789 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
12790 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
12791 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
12792 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
12793 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
12794 @end example
12795
12796 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
12797 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
12798 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
12799 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
12800 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
12801 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
12802 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
12803 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
12804 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
12805 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
12806 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
12807
12808 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
12809 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
12810 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
12811 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
12812 those substitutes.
12813
12814 The general syntax is:
12815
12816 @example
12817 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12818 @end example
12819
12820 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
12821 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
12822 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
12823 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
12824 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
12825 available substitutes is below 100%.
12826
12827 The available options are listed below.
12828
12829 @table @code
12830 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12831 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
12832 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
12833 servers is queried.
12834
12835 @item --system=@var{system}
12836 @itemx -s @var{system}
12837 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
12838 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
12839 substitutes for several system types.
12840
12841 @item --manifest=@var{file}
12842 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
12843 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
12844 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
12845 guix package}).
12846
12847 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
12848 are concatenated.
12849
12850 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
12851 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
12852 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
12853 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
12854 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
12855 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
12856 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
12857
12858 @example
12859 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
12860 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
12861 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
12862 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
12863 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
12864 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
12865 @dots{}
12866 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
12867 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
12868 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
12869 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
12870 @dots{}
12871 @end example
12872
12873 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
12874 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
12875 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
12876
12877 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
12878 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
12879 fail to build.
12880
12881 @item --display-missing
12882 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
12883 @end table
12884
12885 @node Invoking guix processes
12886 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
12887
12888 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
12889 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
12890 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
12891 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
12892 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
12893 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
12894
12895 @example
12896 $ sudo guix processes
12897 SessionPID: 19002
12898 ClientPID: 19090
12899 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
12900
12901 SessionPID: 19402
12902 ClientPID: 19367
12903 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
12904
12905 SessionPID: 19444
12906 ClientPID: 19419
12907 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
12908 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
12909 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
12910 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
12911 ChildPID: 20495
12912 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
12913 ChildPID: 27733
12914 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
12915 ChildPID: 27793
12916 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
12917 @end example
12918
12919 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
12920 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
12921 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
12922 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
12923 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
12924
12925 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
12926 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
12927 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
12928 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
12929 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
12930 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
12931
12932 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
12933 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
12934 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
12935 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
12936
12937 @example
12938 $ sudo guix processes | \
12939 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
12940 ClientPID: 19419
12941 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
12942 @end example
12943
12944 Additional options are listed below.
12945
12946 @table @code
12947 @item --format=@var{format}
12948 @itemx -f @var{format}
12949 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
12950
12951 @table @code
12952 @item recutils
12953 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
12954 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
12955
12956 @item normalized
12957 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
12958 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
12959 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
12960 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
12961 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
12962 using @command{guix build}.
12963
12964 @example
12965 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
12966 recsel \
12967 -j Session \
12968 -t ChildProcess \
12969 -p Session.PID,PID \
12970 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
12971 PID: 4435
12972 Session_PID: 4278
12973
12974 PID: 4554
12975 Session_PID: 4278
12976
12977 PID: 4646
12978 Session_PID: 4278
12979 @end example
12980 @end table
12981 @end table
12982
12983 @node System Configuration
12984 @chapter System Configuration
12985
12986 @cindex system configuration
12987 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
12988 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
12989 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
12990 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
12991 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
12992
12993 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
12994 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
12995 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
12996 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
12997 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
12998 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
12999 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13000 the own tools of the system.
13001 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13002
13003 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13004 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13005 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13006 instance to support new system services.
13007
13008 @menu
13009 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13010 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13011 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13012 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13013 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13014 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13015 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13016 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13017 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13018 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13019 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13020 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13021 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13022 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13023 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13024 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13025 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13026 @end menu
13027
13028 @node Using the Configuration System
13029 @section Using the Configuration System
13030
13031 The operating system is configured by providing an
13032 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13033 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13034 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13035 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13036
13037 @findex operating-system
13038 @lisp
13039 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13040 @end lisp
13041
13042 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13043 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13044 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13045 which case they get a default value.
13046
13047 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13048 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13049 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13050 @command{guix system}.
13051
13052 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13053
13054 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13055 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13056 @cindex UEFI boot
13057 @cindex EFI boot
13058 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13059 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13060 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13061 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13062 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13063
13064 @lisp
13065 (bootloader-configuration
13066 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13067 (target "/boot/efi"))
13068 @end lisp
13069
13070 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13071 configuration options.
13072
13073 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13074
13075 @vindex %base-packages
13076 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13077 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13078 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13079 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13080 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13081 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13082 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13083 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13084 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13085 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13086 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13087 of a package:
13088
13089 @lisp
13090 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13091 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13092
13093 (operating-system
13094 ;; ...
13095 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
13096 %base-packages)))
13097 @end lisp
13098
13099 @findex specification->package
13100 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
13101 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13102 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13103 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13104 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13105 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13106 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13107 version:
13108
13109 @lisp
13110 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13111
13112 (operating-system
13113 ;; ...
13114 (packages (append (map specification->package
13115 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13116 %base-packages)))
13117 @end lisp
13118
13119 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13120
13121 @cindex services
13122 @vindex %base-services
13123 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13124 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13125 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13126 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13127 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13128 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13129 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13130 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13131 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13132
13133 @cindex customization, of services
13134 @findex modify-services
13135 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13136 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13137 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13138
13139 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
13140 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
13141 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
13142 following in your operating system declaration:
13143
13144 @lisp
13145 (define %my-services
13146 ;; My very own list of services.
13147 (modify-services %base-services
13148 (guix-service-type config =>
13149 (guix-configuration
13150 (inherit config)
13151 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13152 (substitute-urls
13153 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13154 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13155 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13156 (mingetty-configuration
13157 (inherit config)
13158 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13159 (auto-login "guest")))))
13160
13161 (operating-system
13162 ;; @dots{}
13163 (services %my-services))
13164 @end lisp
13165
13166 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13167 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13168 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
13169 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13170 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13171 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13172 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13173 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13174 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13175
13176 @cindex encrypted disk
13177 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13178 root partition, the X11 display
13179 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13180 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13181 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13182
13183 @lisp
13184 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13185 @end lisp
13186
13187 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13188 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13189
13190 @lisp
13191 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13192 @end lisp
13193
13194 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13195 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13196 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13197
13198 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13199 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13200 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13201
13202 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13203 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13204 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13205 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13206 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13207 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13208
13209 @lisp
13210 (remove (lambda (service)
13211 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13212 %desktop-services)
13213 @end lisp
13214
13215 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13216
13217 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13218 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13219 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13220 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13221 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13222
13223 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13224 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13225 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13226 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13227 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13228 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13229 system, should you ever need to.
13230
13231 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13232 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13233 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13234 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13235 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13236 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13237 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13238 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13239 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13240 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13241
13242 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13243 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13244 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13245 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13246 system}).
13247
13248 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13249
13250 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13251 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13252 Monad}):
13253
13254 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13255 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13256 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13257
13258 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13259 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13260 instantiate @var{os}.
13261 @end deffn
13262
13263 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13264 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13265 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13266
13267
13268 @node operating-system Reference
13269 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13270
13271 This section summarizes all the options available in
13272 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13273 System}).
13274
13275 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13276 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13277 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13278 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13279
13280 @table @asis
13281 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13282 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13283 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13284 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13285 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13286
13287 @cindex hurd
13288 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13289 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13290 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13291 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13292 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13293
13294 @quotation Warning
13295 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13296 @end quotation
13297
13298 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13299 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13300 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13301
13302 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13303 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13304 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13305
13306 @item @code{bootloader}
13307 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13308
13309 @item @code{label}
13310 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13311 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13312
13313 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13314 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13315 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13316 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
13317
13318 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13319 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13320 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13321 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13322
13323 @quotation Note
13324 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13325 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13326 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13327 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13328 Window System.
13329 @end quotation
13330
13331 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13332 @cindex initrd
13333 @cindex initial RAM disk
13334 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13335 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13336
13337 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13338 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13339 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13340 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13341
13342 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13343 @cindex firmware
13344 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13345
13346 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13347 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13348 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13349 supported hardware.
13350
13351 @item @code{host-name}
13352 The host name.
13353
13354 @item @code{hosts-file}
13355 @cindex hosts file
13356 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13357 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13358 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13359 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13360
13361 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13362 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13363
13364 @item @code{file-systems}
13365 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13366
13367 @cindex swap devices
13368 @cindex swap space
13369 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13370 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13371 files to be used for ``swap
13372 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13373 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13374
13375 @table @code
13376 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13377 Use the swap partition with the given UUID. You can learn the UUID of a
13378 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13379 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13380
13381 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13382 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13383 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13384 Linux swap partition.
13385
13386 @item (list "/swapfile")
13387 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13388
13389 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13390 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13391 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13392 instead.
13393 @end table
13394
13395 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13396 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13397 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13398 @ref{File Systems}.
13399
13400 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13401 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13402 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13403
13404 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13405 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13406
13407 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13408 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13409 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13410 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13411
13412 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13413
13414 @lisp
13415 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13416 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13417 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13418 (activate-readline)")))
13419 @end lisp
13420
13421 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13422 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13423 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13424
13425 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13426 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13427 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13428 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13429
13430 @lisp
13431 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13432 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13433 %base-packages) ; the default set
13434 @end lisp
13435
13436 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13437 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13438 package}).
13439
13440 @item @code{timezone}
13441 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
13442
13443 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
13444 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
13445 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
13446
13447 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
13448 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
13449 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
13450
13451 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
13452 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
13453 run time. @xref{Locales}.
13454
13455 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
13456 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
13457 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
13458 considerations that justify this option.
13459
13460 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
13461 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
13462 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
13463 details.
13464
13465 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
13466 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
13467
13468 @cindex essential services
13469 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
13470 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
13471 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
13472 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
13473 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
13474
13475 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
13476 @cindex PAM
13477 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
13478 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
13479 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
13480
13481 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
13482 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
13483 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
13484
13485 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
13486 @cindex sudoers file
13487 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
13488 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
13489
13490 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
13491 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
13492 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
13493 @code{sudo}.
13494
13495 @end table
13496
13497 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
13498 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
13499 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
13500
13501 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
13502 the definition of the @code{label} field:
13503
13504 @lisp
13505 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13506
13507 (operating-system
13508 ;; ...
13509 (label (package-full-name
13510 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
13511 @end lisp
13512
13513 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
13514 system definition.
13515 @end deffn
13516
13517 @end deftp
13518
13519 @node File Systems
13520 @section File Systems
13521
13522 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
13523 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
13524 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
13525 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
13526
13527 @lisp
13528 (file-system
13529 (mount-point "/home")
13530 (device "/dev/sda3")
13531 (type "ext4"))
13532 @end lisp
13533
13534 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
13535 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
13536
13537 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
13538 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
13539 contain the following members:
13540
13541 @table @asis
13542 @item @code{type}
13543 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
13544 @code{"ext4"}.
13545
13546 @item @code{mount-point}
13547 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
13548
13549 @item @code{device}
13550 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
13551 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
13552 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
13553 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
13554 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
13555 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
13556 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
13557 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
13558 mounted.}.
13559
13560 @findex file-system-label
13561 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
13562 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
13563 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
13564 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
13565
13566 @lisp
13567 (file-system
13568 (mount-point "/home")
13569 (type "ext4")
13570 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13571 @end lisp
13572
13573 @findex uuid
13574 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
13575 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
13576 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
13577 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
13578 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
13579 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
13580 like this:
13581
13582 @lisp
13583 (file-system
13584 (mount-point "/home")
13585 (type "ext4")
13586 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
13587 @end lisp
13588
13589 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
13590 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
13591 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
13592 This is required so that
13593 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
13594 corresponding device mapping established.
13595
13596 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
13597 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
13598 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
13599 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
13600 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
13601 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
13602 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
13603 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
13604 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13605 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
13606
13607 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
13608 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
13609 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
13610 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
13611 options for various file systems. Note that the
13612 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
13613 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
13614 file system options given as an association list to the string
13615 representation, and vice-versa.
13616
13617 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
13618 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
13619 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
13620 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
13621 is not automatically mounted.
13622
13623 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
13624 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
13625 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
13626 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
13627 instance, for the root file system.
13628
13629 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
13630 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
13631 errors before being mounted.
13632
13633 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
13634 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
13635
13636 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
13637 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
13638 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
13639 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
13640 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
13641
13642 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
13643 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
13644 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
13645 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
13646
13647 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
13648 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
13649 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
13650
13651 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
13652 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13653 @end table
13654 @end deftp
13655
13656 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
13657 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
13658 string:
13659
13660 @lisp
13661 (file-system-label "home")
13662 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
13663 @end lisp
13664
13665 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
13666 than by device name. See above for examples.
13667 @end deffn
13668
13669 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
13670 variables.
13671
13672 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
13673 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
13674 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
13675 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
13676 these.
13677 @end defvr
13678
13679 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
13680 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
13681 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
13682 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13683 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
13684 @command{xterm}.
13685 @end defvr
13686
13687 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
13688 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
13689 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
13690 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13691 @end defvr
13692
13693 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
13694 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
13695 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
13696 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
13697 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
13698
13699 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
13700 read-write in its own ``name space.''
13701 @end defvr
13702
13703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
13704 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
13705 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
13706 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13707 @end defvr
13708
13709 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
13710 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
13711 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
13712 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13713 @end defvr
13714
13715 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
13716 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
13717
13718 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
13719 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
13720 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
13721
13722 @lisp
13723 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
13724 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
13725
13726 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
13727 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
13728 @end lisp
13729
13730 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
13731 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
13732
13733 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
13734 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
13735 @end deffn
13736
13737
13738 @node Btrfs file system
13739 @subsection Btrfs file system
13740
13741 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
13742 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
13743 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
13744 System.
13745
13746 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
13747 example, by:
13748
13749 @lisp
13750 (file-system
13751 (mount-point "/home")
13752 (type "btrfs")
13753 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13754 @end lisp
13755
13756 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
13757 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
13758 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
13759 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
13760
13761 @lisp
13762 (file-system
13763 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
13764 (mount-point "/")
13765 (type "btrfs")
13766 (options "subvol=rootfs")
13767 (dependencies mapped-devices))
13768 @end lisp
13769
13770 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
13771 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
13772 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
13773 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
13774 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
13775 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
13776 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
13777 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
13778 path of a subvolume.
13779
13780 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
13781 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
13782 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
13783 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
13784 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
13785 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
13786 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
13787
13788 @example
13789 / (top level)
13790 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
13791 ├── gnu (normal directory)
13792 ├── store (normal directory)
13793 [...]
13794 @end example
13795
13796 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
13797 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
13798 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
13799
13800 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
13801 directories:
13802
13803 @example
13804 / (top level)
13805 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
13806 ├── gnu (normal directory)
13807 ├── store (subvolume)
13808 [...]
13809 @end example
13810
13811 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
13812 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
13813 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
13814 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
13815 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
13816
13817 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
13818
13819 @example
13820 / (top level)
13821 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
13822 ├── root-current (subvolume)
13823 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
13824 [...]
13825 @end example
13826
13827 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
13828 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
13829 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
13830 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
13831 a file system declaration such as:
13832
13833 @lisp
13834 (file-system
13835 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
13836 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
13837 (type "btrfs")
13838 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
13839 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
13840 @end lisp
13841
13842 @node Mapped Devices
13843 @section Mapped Devices
13844
13845 @cindex device mapping
13846 @cindex mapped devices
13847 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
13848 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
13849 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
13850 with additional processing over the data that flows through
13851 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
13852 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
13853 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
13854 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
13855 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
13856 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
13857 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
13858 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
13859 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
13860 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
13861 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
13862 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
13863
13864 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
13865 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
13866
13867 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
13868 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
13869 the system boots up.
13870
13871 @table @code
13872 @item source
13873 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
13874 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
13875 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
13876 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
13877
13878 @item target
13879 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
13880 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
13881 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
13882 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
13883 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
13884 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
13885 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
13886 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
13887
13888 @item targets
13889 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
13890 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
13891
13892 @item type
13893 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
13894 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
13895 @end table
13896 @end deftp
13897
13898 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
13899 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
13900 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
13901 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
13902 @end defvr
13903
13904 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
13905 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
13906 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
13907 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
13908 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
13909 @end defvr
13910
13911 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
13912 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
13913 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
13914 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
13915 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
13916 @code{lvm2} package.
13917 @end defvr
13918
13919 @cindex disk encryption
13920 @cindex LUKS
13921 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
13922 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
13923 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
13924 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
13925 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
13926 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
13927 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
13928
13929 @lisp
13930 (mapped-device
13931 (source "/dev/sda3")
13932 (target "home")
13933 (type luks-device-mapping))
13934 @end lisp
13935
13936 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
13937 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
13938 command like:
13939
13940 @example
13941 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
13942 @end example
13943
13944 and use it as follows:
13945
13946 @lisp
13947 (mapped-device
13948 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
13949 (target "home")
13950 (type luks-device-mapping))
13951 @end lisp
13952
13953 @cindex swap encryption
13954 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
13955 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
13956 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
13957 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
13958 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
13959
13960 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
13961 may be declared as follows:
13962
13963 @lisp
13964 (mapped-device
13965 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
13966 (target "/dev/md0")
13967 (type raid-device-mapping))
13968 @end lisp
13969
13970 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
13971 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
13972 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
13973 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
13974 automatically later.
13975
13976 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
13977 be declared as follows:
13978
13979 @lisp
13980 (mapped-device
13981 (source "vg0")
13982 (target (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
13983 (type lvm-device-mapping))
13984 @end lisp
13985
13986 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
13987 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
13988 (@pxref{File Systems}).
13989
13990 @node User Accounts
13991 @section User Accounts
13992
13993 @cindex users
13994 @cindex accounts
13995 @cindex user accounts
13996 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
13997 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
13998 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
13999
14000 @lisp
14001 (user-account
14002 (name "alice")
14003 (group "users")
14004 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14005 "audio" ;sound card
14006 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14007 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14008 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14009 @end lisp
14010
14011 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14012 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14013
14014 @lisp
14015 (user-account
14016 (name "bob")
14017 (group "users")
14018 (comment "Alice's bro")
14019 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14020 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14021 @end lisp
14022
14023 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14024 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14025 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14026 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14027 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14028 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14029 as declared.
14030
14031 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14032 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14033 be specified:
14034
14035 @table @asis
14036 @item @code{name}
14037 The name of the user account.
14038
14039 @item @code{group}
14040 @cindex groups
14041 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14042 this account belongs to.
14043
14044 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14045 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14046 account belongs to.
14047
14048 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14049 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14050 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14051 account is created.
14052
14053 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14054 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14055
14056 @item @code{home-directory}
14057 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14058
14059 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14060 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14061 if it does not exist yet.
14062
14063 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14064 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14065 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14066 Bash executable like this:
14067
14068 @lisp
14069 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14070 @end lisp
14071
14072 @noindent
14073 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14074
14075 @lisp
14076 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14077 @end lisp
14078
14079 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14080 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14081 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14082 graphical login managers do not list them.
14083
14084 @anchor{user-account-password}
14085 @cindex password, for user accounts
14086 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14087 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14088 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14089 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14090 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14091 reconfiguration.
14092
14093 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14094 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14095 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14096
14097 @lisp
14098 (user-account
14099 (name "charlie")
14100 (group "users")
14101
14102 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14103 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14104 @end lisp
14105
14106 @quotation Note
14107 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14108 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14109 care.
14110 @end quotation
14111
14112 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14113 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14114 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14115
14116 @end table
14117 @end deftp
14118
14119 @cindex groups
14120 User group declarations are even simpler:
14121
14122 @lisp
14123 (user-group (name "students"))
14124 @end lisp
14125
14126 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14127 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14128
14129 @table @asis
14130 @item @code{name}
14131 The name of the group.
14132
14133 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14134 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14135 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14136
14137 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14138 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14139 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14140
14141 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14142 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14143 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14144
14145 @end table
14146 @end deftp
14147
14148 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14149 expect:
14150
14151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14152 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14153 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14154 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14155 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14156 @end defvr
14157
14158 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14159 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14160 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14161
14162 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14163 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14164 @end defvr
14165
14166 @node Keyboard Layout
14167 @section Keyboard Layout
14168
14169 @cindex keyboard layout
14170 @cindex keymap
14171 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14172 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14173 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14174 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14175 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14176 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14177 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14178
14179 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14180 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14181
14182 @itemize
14183 @item
14184 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14185 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14186 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14187 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14188
14189 @item
14190 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14191 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14192 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14193
14194 @item
14195 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14196 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14197 @end itemize
14198
14199 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14200 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14201
14202 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14203 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14204 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14205 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14206 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14207 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14208 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14209 about.
14210
14211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14212 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14213 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14214
14215 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14216 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14217 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14218 @end deffn
14219
14220 Here are a few examples:
14221
14222 @lisp
14223 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14224 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14225 (keyboard-layout "de")
14226
14227 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14228 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14229
14230 ;; The Catalan layout.
14231 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14232
14233 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14234 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14235
14236 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14237 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14238 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14239 ;; accented letters.
14240 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14241 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14242
14243 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14244 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14245
14246 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14247 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14248 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14249 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14250 @end lisp
14251
14252 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14253 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14254
14255 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14256 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14257 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14258 configuration would look like:
14259
14260 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14261 @lisp
14262 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14263 ;; and for Xorg.
14264
14265 (operating-system
14266 ;; ...
14267 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14268 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14269 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14270 (target "/boot/efi")
14271 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14272 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14273 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14274 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14275 %desktop-services)))
14276 @end lisp
14277
14278 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14279 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14280 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14281 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14282 GDM.
14283
14284 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14285 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14286
14287 @itemize
14288 @item
14289 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14290 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14291
14292 @item
14293 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14294 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14295 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14296
14297 @example
14298 setxkbmap us dvorak
14299 @end example
14300
14301 @item
14302 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14303 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14304 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14305 French bépo layout:
14306
14307 @example
14308 loadkeys fr-bepo
14309 @end example
14310 @end itemize
14311
14312 @node Locales
14313 @section Locales
14314
14315 @cindex locale
14316 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14317 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14318 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14319 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14320 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14321 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14322
14323 @cindex locale definition
14324 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14325 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14326 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14327
14328 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14329 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14330 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14331 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14332 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14333 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14334 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14335 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14336
14337 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14338 that field may be:
14339
14340 @lisp
14341 (cons (locale-definition
14342 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14343 %default-locale-definitions)
14344 @end lisp
14345
14346 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14347 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14348
14349 @lisp
14350 (list (locale-definition
14351 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14352 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14353 @end lisp
14354
14355 @vindex LOCPATH
14356 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14357 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14358 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14359 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14360 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14361 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14362
14363 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14364 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14365
14366 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14367 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14368
14369 @table @asis
14370
14371 @item @code{name}
14372 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14373 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14374
14375 @item @code{source}
14376 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14377 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14378
14379 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14380 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14381 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14382 IANA}.
14383
14384 @end table
14385 @end deftp
14386
14387 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14388 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14389 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14390 declarations.
14391
14392 @cindex locale name
14393 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14394 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14395 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14396 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14397 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14398 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14399 @end defvr
14400
14401 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14402
14403 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14404 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14405 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14406 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14407 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14408 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14409 another.
14410
14411 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14412 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14413 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14414 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14415 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14416 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14417 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14418 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14419 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14420 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14421 programs will not abort.
14422
14423 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14424 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14425 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14426 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14427
14428 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14429 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14430 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14431
14432 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14433 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14434 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14435 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14436 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14437 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14438
14439 @lisp
14440 (use-package-modules base)
14441
14442 (operating-system
14443 ;; @dots{}
14444 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
14445 @end lisp
14446
14447 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
14448 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
14449 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
14450
14451
14452 @node Services
14453 @section Services
14454
14455 @cindex system services
14456 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
14457 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
14458 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
14459 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
14460 configuring network access.
14461
14462 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
14463 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
14464 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
14465 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
14466 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
14467 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
14468
14469 @example
14470 # herd status
14471 @end example
14472
14473 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
14474 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
14475 service and its associated actions:
14476
14477 @example
14478 # herd doc nscd
14479 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
14480
14481 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
14482 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
14483 @end example
14484
14485 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
14486 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
14487 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
14488
14489 @example
14490 # herd stop nscd
14491 Service nscd has been stopped.
14492 # herd restart xorg-server
14493 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
14494 Service xorg-server has been started.
14495 @end example
14496
14497 The following sections document the available services, starting with
14498 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
14499 declaration.
14500
14501 @menu
14502 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
14503 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
14504 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
14505 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
14506 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
14507 * X Window:: Graphical display.
14508 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
14509 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
14510 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
14511 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
14512 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
14513 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
14514 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
14515 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
14516 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
14517 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
14518 * Web Services:: Web servers.
14519 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
14520 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
14521 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
14522 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
14523 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
14524 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
14525 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
14526 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
14527 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
14528 * Game Services:: Game servers.
14529 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
14530 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
14531 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
14532 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
14533 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
14534 @end menu
14535
14536 @node Base Services
14537 @subsection Base Services
14538
14539 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
14540 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
14541 this module are listed below.
14542
14543 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
14544 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
14545 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
14546 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
14547 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
14548 more.
14549
14550 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
14551 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
14552 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
14553 this:
14554
14555 @lisp
14556 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
14557 (service openssh-service-type))
14558 %base-services)
14559 @end lisp
14560 @end defvr
14561
14562 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
14563 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
14564 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
14565
14566 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
14567 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
14568 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
14569
14570 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
14571 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
14572 @lisp
14573 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
14574 @end lisp
14575
14576 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
14577 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
14578 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
14579 change it to:
14580
14581 @lisp
14582 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
14583 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
14584 @end lisp
14585
14586 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
14587 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
14588 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
14589 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
14590 (see below).
14591 @end defvr
14592
14593 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
14594 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
14595
14596 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
14597 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
14598 symlink:
14599
14600 @lisp
14601 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
14602 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
14603 @end lisp
14604 @end deffn
14605
14606 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
14607 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
14608 @end deffn
14609
14610 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
14611 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
14612 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
14613 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
14614 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
14615
14616 @lisp
14617 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
14618 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
14619 font-tamzen
14620 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
14621 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
14622 font-terminus
14623 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
14624 @end lisp
14625 @end defvr
14626
14627 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
14628 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
14629 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
14630 among other things.
14631 @end deffn
14632
14633 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
14634 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
14635
14636 @table @asis
14637
14638 @item @code{motd}
14639 @cindex message of the day
14640 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
14641
14642 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14643 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
14644 the 'root' account has just been created.
14645
14646 @end table
14647 @end deftp
14648
14649 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
14650 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
14651 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
14652 other things.
14653 @end deffn
14654
14655 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
14656 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
14657 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
14658
14659 @table @asis
14660
14661 @item @code{tty}
14662 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14663
14664 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14665 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
14666 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
14667 user name and password must be entered to log in.
14668
14669 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
14670 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
14671 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
14672 the name of the log-in program.
14673
14674 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
14675 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
14676 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
14677
14678 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
14679 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
14680
14681 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
14682 The Mingetty package to use.
14683
14684 @end table
14685 @end deftp
14686
14687 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
14688 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
14689 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
14690 among other things.
14691 @end deffn
14692
14693 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
14694 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
14695 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
14696 man page for more information.
14697
14698 @table @asis
14699
14700 @item @code{tty}
14701 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
14702 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
14703 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
14704
14705 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
14706 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
14707 from it and use that.
14708
14709 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
14710 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
14711 serial port from it and use that.
14712
14713 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
14714 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
14715 correct values.
14716
14717 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
14718 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
14719 descending order.
14720
14721 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
14722 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
14723 variable.
14724
14725 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
14726 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
14727 disabled.
14728
14729 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14730 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14731 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14732
14733 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
14734 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
14735
14736 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
14737 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
14738 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
14739
14740 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
14741 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
14742 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
14743 specified in @var{login-program}.
14744
14745 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
14746 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
14747
14748 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
14749 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
14750 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
14751
14752 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
14753 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
14754 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
14755
14756 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
14757 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
14758 the login prompt.
14759
14760 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
14761 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
14762 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
14763 Shadow tool suite.
14764
14765 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
14766 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
14767 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
14768 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
14769
14770 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
14771 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
14772 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
14773
14774 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14775 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
14776 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
14777 systems.
14778
14779 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
14780 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
14781 @file{/etc/issue} file.
14782
14783 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
14784 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
14785 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
14786 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
14787 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
14788 options that could be parsed by the login program.
14789
14790 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
14791 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
14792 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
14793 lazily spawning shells.
14794
14795 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
14796 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
14797 path as a string.
14798
14799 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
14800 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
14801 specified terminal.
14802
14803 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
14804 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
14805 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
14806 character.
14807
14808 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
14809 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
14810 within @var{timeout} seconds.
14811
14812 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
14813 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
14814 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
14815 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
14816 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
14817 Unicode characters.
14818
14819 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
14820 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
14821 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
14822 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
14823 @var{init-string} option.
14824
14825 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
14826 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
14827 locks.
14828
14829 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
14830 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
14831 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
14832
14833 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
14834 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
14835 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
14836 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
14837
14838 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
14839 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
14840 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
14841
14842 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
14843 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
14844 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
14845 types their login name.
14846
14847 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
14848 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
14849 to before login.
14850
14851 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
14852 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
14853 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
14854
14855 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
14856 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
14857 @command{login} program.
14858
14859 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
14860 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
14861 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
14862
14863 @end table
14864 @end deftp
14865
14866 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
14867 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
14868 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
14869 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
14870 @end deffn
14871
14872 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
14873 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
14874 implements virtual console log-in.
14875
14876 @table @asis
14877
14878 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
14879 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14880
14881 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
14882 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
14883 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
14884
14885 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
14886 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
14887
14888 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14889 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14890 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14891
14892 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
14893 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
14894
14895 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
14896 The Kmscon package to use.
14897
14898 @end table
14899 @end deftp
14900
14901 @cindex name service cache daemon
14902 @cindex nscd
14903 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
14904 [#:name-services '()]
14905 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
14906 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
14907 Service Switch}, for an example.
14908
14909 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
14910
14911 @table @code
14912 @item invalidate
14913 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
14914 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
14915 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
14916
14917 @example
14918 herd invalidate nscd hosts
14919 @end example
14920
14921 @noindent
14922 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
14923
14924 @item statistics
14925 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
14926 and caches.
14927 @end table
14928
14929 @end deffn
14930
14931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
14932 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
14933 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
14934 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
14935 @end defvr
14936
14937 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
14938 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
14939 configuration.
14940
14941 @table @asis
14942
14943 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
14944 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
14945 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
14946
14947 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
14948 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
14949 command.
14950
14951 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
14952 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
14953 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
14954
14955 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
14956 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
14957 debugging output is logged.
14958
14959 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
14960 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
14961 below.
14962
14963 @end table
14964 @end deftp
14965
14966 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
14967 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
14968
14969 @table @asis
14970
14971 @item @code{database}
14972 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
14973 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
14974 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
14975 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
14976
14977 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
14978 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
14979 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
14980 negative lookup result remains in cache.
14981
14982 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
14983 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
14984 @var{database}.
14985
14986 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
14987 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
14988 them into account.
14989
14990 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
14991 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
14992
14993 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
14994 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
14995
14996 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
14997 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
14998
14999 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15000 @c settings, so leave them out.
15001
15002 @end table
15003 @end deftp
15004
15005 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15006 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15007 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15008
15009 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15010 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15011 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15012 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15013 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15014 @end defvr
15015
15016 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15017 @cindex syslog
15018 @cindex logging
15019 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15020 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15021
15022 @table @asis
15023 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15024 The syslog daemon to use.
15025
15026 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15027 The syslog configuration file to use.
15028
15029 @end table
15030 @end deftp
15031
15032 @anchor{syslog-service}
15033 @cindex syslog
15034 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15035 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15036
15037 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15038 information on the configuration file syntax.
15039 @end deffn
15040
15041 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15042 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15043 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15044 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15045 @end defvr
15046
15047 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15048 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15049 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15050 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15051
15052 @table @asis
15053 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15054 The Guix package to use.
15055
15056 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15057 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15058
15059 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15060 Number of build user accounts to create.
15061
15062 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15063 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15064 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15065 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
15066 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15067
15068 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15069 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15070 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15071 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15072 self-contained.
15073
15074 @quotation Note
15075 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15076 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15077 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15078 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15079 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15080 @end quotation
15081
15082 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15083 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15084 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15085 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15086 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15087 See @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15088
15089 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15090 Whether to use substitutes.
15091
15092 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15093 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15094
15095 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15096 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. You will need to do
15097 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15098 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15099 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15100 exactly that:
15101
15102 @lisp
15103 (guix-configuration
15104 (substitute-urls
15105 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15106 %default-substitute-urls))
15107 (authorized-keys
15108 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15109 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15110 @end lisp
15111
15112 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15113 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15114 substitutes.
15115
15116 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15117 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15118 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15119 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15120 disables the timeout.
15121
15122 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15123 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15124 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15125
15126 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15127 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15128 and DNS-SD.
15129
15130 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15131 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15132
15133 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15134 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15135 are written.
15136
15137 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15138 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15139 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15140 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15141 derivations and substitutes.
15142
15143 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15144 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15145
15146 @example
15147 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15148 @end example
15149
15150 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15151
15152 @example
15153 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15154 @end example
15155
15156 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15157 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15158
15159 @end table
15160 @end deftp
15161
15162 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15163 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15164 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15165 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15166 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15167 creation of such rule files.
15168
15169 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15170 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15171 @end deffn
15172
15173 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15174 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15175 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15176
15177 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15178 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15179 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15180
15181 @lisp
15182 (define %example-udev-rule
15183 (udev-rule
15184 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15185 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15186 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15187 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15188 @end lisp
15189 @end deffn
15190
15191 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15192 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15193 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15194 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15195 This works by creating a singleton service type
15196 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15197 instance.
15198
15199 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15200 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15201
15202 @lisp
15203 (operating-system
15204 ;; @dots{}
15205 (services
15206 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15207 %desktop-services)))
15208 @end lisp
15209 @end deffn
15210
15211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15212 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15213 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15214
15215 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15216
15217 @lisp
15218 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15219 (guix packages) ;for origin
15220 @dots{})
15221
15222 (define %android-udev-rules
15223 (file->udev-rule
15224 "51-android-udev.rules"
15225 (let ((version "20170910"))
15226 (origin
15227 (method url-fetch)
15228 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15229 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15230 (sha256
15231 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15232 @end lisp
15233 @end deffn
15234
15235 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15236 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15237 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15238 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15239 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15240 packages android)} module.
15241
15242 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15243 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15244 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15245 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15246 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15247 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15248 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15249 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15250
15251 @lisp
15252 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15253 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15254 @dots{})
15255
15256 (operating-system
15257 ;; @dots{}
15258 (users (cons (user-account
15259 ;; @dots{}
15260 (supplementary-groups
15261 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15262 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15263 ;; @dots{}
15264 (services
15265 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15266 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15267 %desktop-services)))
15268 @end lisp
15269
15270 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15271 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15272 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15273 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15274 readable.
15275 @end defvr
15276
15277 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15278 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15279 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15280 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15281 @end defvr
15282
15283 @cindex mouse
15284 @cindex gpm
15285 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15286 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15287 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15288 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15289 and paste text.
15290
15291 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15292 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15293 @end defvr
15294
15295 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15296 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15297
15298 @table @asis
15299 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15300 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15301 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15302 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15303 more information.
15304
15305 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15306 The GPM package to use.
15307
15308 @end table
15309 @end deftp
15310
15311 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15312 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15313 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15314 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15315 object, as described below.
15316
15317 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15318 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15319 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15320 @end deffn
15321
15322 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15323 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15324 service.
15325
15326 @table @asis
15327 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15328 The Guix package to use.
15329
15330 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15331 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15332
15333 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15334 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15335 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15336
15337 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
15338 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15339 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15340 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15341
15342 @lisp
15343 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15344 @end lisp
15345
15346 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15347 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
15348
15349 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15350
15351 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15352 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15353 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15354
15355 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15356 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15357 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15358 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15359 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15360 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15361
15362 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15363 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15364 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15365 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15366
15367 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15368 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15369 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15370 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15371 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15372
15373 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15374 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15375 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15376 for more information.
15377 @end table
15378 @end deftp
15379
15380 @anchor{rngd-service}
15381 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15382 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15383 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15384 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15385 @var{device} does not exist.
15386 @end deffn
15387
15388 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15389 @cindex session limits
15390 @cindex ulimit
15391 @cindex priority
15392 @cindex realtime
15393 @cindex jackd
15394 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15395
15396 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15397 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15398 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15399 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15400 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
15401
15402 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15403 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15404
15405 @lisp
15406 (pam-limits-service
15407 (list
15408 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15409 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
15410 @end lisp
15411
15412 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
15413 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
15414 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
15415 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
15416 @end deffn
15417
15418 @node Scheduled Job Execution
15419 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
15420
15421 @cindex cron
15422 @cindex mcron
15423 @cindex scheduling jobs
15424 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
15425 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
15426 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
15427 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
15428 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
15429 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
15430
15431 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
15432 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
15433 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
15434 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
15435 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
15436 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
15437 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15438
15439 @lisp
15440 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
15441 (use-package-modules base idutils)
15442
15443 (define updatedb-job
15444 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
15445 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
15446 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
15447 (lambda ()
15448 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
15449 "updatedb"
15450 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
15451
15452 (define garbage-collector-job
15453 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
15454 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
15455 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
15456 "guix gc -F 1G"))
15457
15458 (define idutils-job
15459 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
15460 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
15461 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
15462 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
15463 #:user "charlie"))
15464
15465 (operating-system
15466 ;; @dots{}
15467
15468 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
15469 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
15470 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
15471 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
15472 mcron-service-type
15473 (list garbage-collector-job
15474 updatedb-job
15475 idutils-job))
15476 %base-services)))
15477 @end lisp
15478
15479 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
15480 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
15481 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
15482 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
15483 illustrates that.
15484
15485 @lisp
15486 (define %battery-alert-job
15487 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
15488 #~(job
15489 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
15490 #$(program-file
15491 "battery-alert.scm"
15492 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
15493 '((guix build utils)))
15494 #~(begin
15495 (use-modules (guix build utils)
15496 (ice-9 popen)
15497 (ice-9 regex)
15498 (ice-9 textual-ports)
15499 (srfi srfi-2))
15500
15501 (define %min-level 20)
15502
15503 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
15504 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
15505 OPEN_READ
15506 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
15507 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
15508 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
15509 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
15510 ((< level %min-level)))
15511 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
15512 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
15513 @end lisp
15514
15515 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
15516 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
15517 reference of the mcron service.
15518
15519 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
15520 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
15521
15522 @example
15523 # herd schedule mcron
15524 @end example
15525
15526 @noindent
15527 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
15528 also specify the number of tasks to display:
15529
15530 @example
15531 # herd schedule mcron 10
15532 @end example
15533
15534 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
15535 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
15536 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
15537
15538 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
15539 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
15540 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
15541 mcron jobs to run.
15542 @end defvr
15543
15544 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
15545 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
15546
15547 @table @asis
15548 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
15549 The mcron package to use.
15550
15551 @item @code{jobs}
15552 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
15553 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
15554 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
15555 @end table
15556 @end deftp
15557
15558
15559 @node Log Rotation
15560 @subsection Log Rotation
15561
15562 @cindex rottlog
15563 @cindex log rotation
15564 @cindex logging
15565 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
15566 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
15567 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
15568 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
15569 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15570
15571 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
15572 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
15573 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
15574 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
15575 produce log files already take care of that):
15576
15577 @lisp
15578 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
15579 (use-service-modules admin)
15580
15581 (define my-log-files
15582 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
15583 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
15584
15585 (operating-system
15586 ;; @dots{}
15587 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
15588 rottlog-service-type
15589 (list (log-rotation
15590 (frequency 'daily)
15591 (files my-log-files))))
15592 %base-services)))
15593 @end lisp
15594
15595 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
15596 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
15597 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
15598
15599 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
15600 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
15601
15602 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
15603 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
15604 @end defvr
15605
15606 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
15607 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
15608
15609 @table @asis
15610 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
15611 The Rottlog package to use.
15612
15613 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
15614 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
15615 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15616
15617 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
15618 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
15619
15620 @item @code{jobs}
15621 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
15622 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
15623 @end table
15624 @end deftp
15625
15626 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
15627 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
15628
15629 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
15630 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
15631 defined like this:
15632
15633 @lisp
15634 (log-rotation
15635 (frequency 'daily)
15636 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
15637 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
15638 "rotate 6"
15639 "notifempty"
15640 "nocompress")))
15641 @end lisp
15642
15643 The list of fields is as follows:
15644
15645 @table @asis
15646 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
15647 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
15648
15649 @item @code{files}
15650 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
15651
15652 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
15653 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
15654 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
15655
15656 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
15657 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
15658 @end table
15659 @end deftp
15660
15661 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
15662 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
15663 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
15664 @end defvr
15665
15666 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
15667 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
15668 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
15669 "/var/log/maillog")}.
15670 @end defvr
15671
15672 @node Networking Services
15673 @subsection Networking Services
15674
15675 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
15676 the network interface.
15677
15678 @cindex DHCP, networking service
15679 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
15680 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
15681 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
15682 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
15683 @end defvr
15684
15685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
15686 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
15687 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
15688 For example:
15689
15690 @lisp
15691 (service dhcpd-service-type
15692 (dhcpd-configuration
15693 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
15694 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
15695 @end lisp
15696 @end deffn
15697
15698 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
15699 @table @asis
15700 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
15701 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
15702 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
15703 directory. The default package is the
15704 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
15705 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15706 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
15707 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
15708 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
15709 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
15710 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
15711 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
15712 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
15713 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
15714 details.
15715 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
15716 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
15717 will be created if it does not exist.
15718 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
15719 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
15720 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15721 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
15722 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
15723 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
15724 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
15725 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
15726 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15727 @end table
15728 @end deftp
15729
15730 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
15731 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
15732 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
15733 @end defvr
15734
15735 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
15736 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
15737 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
15738 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
15739 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
15740 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
15741 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
15742 interface.
15743
15744 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
15745 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
15746 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
15747 to handle.
15748
15749 For example:
15750
15751 @lisp
15752 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
15753 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
15754 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
15755 @end lisp
15756 @end deffn
15757
15758 @cindex wicd
15759 @cindex wireless
15760 @cindex WiFi
15761 @cindex network management
15762 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
15763 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
15764 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
15765
15766 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
15767 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
15768 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
15769 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
15770 @end deffn
15771
15772 @cindex ModemManager
15773
15774 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
15775 This is the service type for the
15776 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
15777 service. The value for this service type is a
15778 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
15779
15780 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15781 Services}).
15782 @end defvr
15783
15784 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
15785 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
15786
15787 @table @asis
15788 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
15789 The ModemManager package to use.
15790
15791 @end table
15792 @end deftp
15793
15794 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
15795 @cindex Modeswitching
15796
15797 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
15798 This is the service type for the
15799 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
15800 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
15801
15802 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
15803 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
15804 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
15805 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
15806 plugged in.
15807
15808 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15809 Services}).
15810 @end defvr
15811
15812 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
15813 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
15814
15815 @table @asis
15816 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
15817 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
15818
15819 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
15820 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
15821 USB_ModeSwitch.
15822
15823 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
15824 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
15825 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
15826 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
15827 file is used.
15828
15829 @end table
15830 @end deftp
15831
15832 @cindex NetworkManager
15833
15834 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
15835 This is the service type for the
15836 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
15837 service. The value for this service type is a
15838 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
15839
15840 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
15841 Services}).
15842 @end defvr
15843
15844 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
15845 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
15846
15847 @table @asis
15848 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
15849 The NetworkManager package to use.
15850
15851 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
15852 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
15853 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
15854
15855 @table @samp
15856 @item default
15857 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
15858 provided by currently active connections.
15859
15860 @item dnsmasq
15861 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
15862 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
15863 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
15864
15865 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
15866 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
15867 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
15868 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
15869 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
15870
15871 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
15872 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
15873 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
15874 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
15875 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
15876 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
15877
15878 @example
15879 nmcli connection add type tun \
15880 connection.interface-name tap0 \
15881 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
15882 ipv4.method shared \
15883 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
15884 @end example
15885
15886 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
15887 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
15888 @command{qemu-system-...}.
15889
15890 @item none
15891 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
15892 @end table
15893
15894 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
15895 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
15896 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
15897 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
15898
15899 @end table
15900 @end deftp
15901
15902 @cindex Connman
15903 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
15904 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
15905 a network connection manager.
15906
15907 Its value must be an
15908 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
15909
15910 @lisp
15911 (service connman-service-type
15912 (connman-configuration
15913 (disable-vpn? #t)))
15914 @end lisp
15915
15916 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
15917 @end deffn
15918
15919 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
15920 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
15921
15922 @table @asis
15923 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
15924 The connman package to use.
15925
15926 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
15927 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
15928 @end table
15929 @end deftp
15930
15931 @cindex WPA Supplicant
15932 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
15933 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
15934 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
15935 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
15936 @end defvr
15937
15938 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
15939 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
15940
15941 It takes the following parameters:
15942
15943 @table @asis
15944 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
15945 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
15946
15947 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
15948 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
15949
15950 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
15951 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
15952
15953 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
15954 Where to store the PID file.
15955
15956 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
15957 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
15958 WPA supplicant will control.
15959
15960 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15961 Optional configuration file to use.
15962
15963 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15964 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
15965 @end table
15966 @end deftp
15967
15968 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
15969 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
15970 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
15971 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
15972 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
15973 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
15974 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
15975
15976 @lisp
15977 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
15978 (service hostapd-service-type
15979 (hostapd-configuration
15980 (interface "wlan1")
15981 (ssid "My Network")
15982 (channel 12)))
15983 @end lisp
15984 @end defvr
15985
15986 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
15987 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
15988 the following fields:
15989
15990 @table @asis
15991 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
15992 The hostapd package to use.
15993
15994 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
15995 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
15996
15997 @item @code{ssid}
15998 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
15999 network.
16000
16001 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16002 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16003
16004 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16005 The WiFi channel to use.
16006
16007 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16008 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16009 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16010 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16011
16012 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16013 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16014 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16015 configuration file reference.
16016 @end table
16017 @end deftp
16018
16019 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16020 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16021 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16022 Linux kernel
16023 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16024 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16025 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16026
16027 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16028 @end defvr
16029
16030 @cindex iptables
16031 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16032 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16033 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16034 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16035 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16036 22 is shown below.
16037
16038 @lisp
16039 (service iptables-service-type
16040 (iptables-configuration
16041 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16042 :INPUT ACCEPT
16043 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16044 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16045 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16046 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16047 COMMIT
16048 "))
16049 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16050 :INPUT ACCEPT
16051 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16052 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16053 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16054 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16055 COMMIT
16056 "))))
16057 @end lisp
16058 @end defvr
16059
16060 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16061 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16062
16063 @table @asis
16064 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16065 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16066 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16067 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16068 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16069 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16070 objects}).
16071 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16072 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16073 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16074 objects}).
16075 @end table
16076 @end deftp
16077
16078 @cindex nftables
16079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16080 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16081 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16082 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16083 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16084 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16085 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
16086 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16087
16088 @lisp
16089 (service nftables-service-type)
16090 @end lisp
16091 @end defvr
16092
16093 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16094 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16095
16096 @table @asis
16097 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16098 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16099 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16100 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16101 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16102 @end table
16103 @end deftp
16104
16105 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16106 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16107 @cindex real time clock
16108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16109 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16110 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16111 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16112
16113 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16114 below.
16115 @end defvr
16116
16117 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16118 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16119
16120 @table @asis
16121 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16122 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16123 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16124 definition below.
16125
16126 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16127 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16128 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16129
16130 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16131 The NTP package to use.
16132 @end table
16133 @end deftp
16134
16135 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16136 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16137 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16138 @end defvr
16139
16140 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16141 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16142
16143 @table @asis
16144 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16145 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16146 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16147
16148 @item @code{address}
16149 The address of the server, as a string.
16150
16151 @item @code{options}
16152 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16153 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16154 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16155 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16156
16157 @example
16158 (ntp-server
16159 (type 'server)
16160 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16161 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16162 @end example
16163 @end table
16164 @end deftp
16165
16166 @cindex OpenNTPD
16167 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16168 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16169 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16170 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16171
16172 @lisp
16173 (service
16174 openntpd-service-type
16175 (openntpd-configuration
16176 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16177 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16178 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16179 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
16180 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
16181
16182 @end lisp
16183 @end deffn
16184
16185 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16186 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16187 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16188 @end defvr
16189
16190 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16191 @table @asis
16192 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16193 The openntpd executable to use.
16194 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16195 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16196 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16197 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16198 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16199 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16200 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16201 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16202 information.
16203 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16204 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16205 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16206 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16207 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16208 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16209 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16210 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16211 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16212 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16213 a constraint.
16214 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16215 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16216 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16217 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16218 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
16219 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
16220 than 180 seconds.
16221 @end table
16222 @end deftp
16223
16224 @cindex inetd
16225 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16226 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16227 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16228 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16229 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16230
16231 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16232 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16233 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16234 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16235 gateway @code{hostname}:
16236
16237 @lisp
16238 (service
16239 inetd-service-type
16240 (inetd-configuration
16241 (entries (list
16242 (inetd-entry
16243 (name "echo")
16244 (socket-type 'stream)
16245 (protocol "tcp")
16246 (wait? #f)
16247 (user "root"))
16248 (inetd-entry
16249 (node "127.0.0.1")
16250 (name "smtp")
16251 (socket-type 'stream)
16252 (protocol "tcp")
16253 (wait? #f)
16254 (user "root")
16255 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16256 (arguments
16257 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16258 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16259 @end lisp
16260
16261 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16262 @end deffn
16263
16264 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16265 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16266
16267 @table @asis
16268 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16269 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16270
16271 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16272 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16273 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16274 @end table
16275 @end deftp
16276
16277 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16278 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16279 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16280 requests.
16281
16282 @table @asis
16283 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16284 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16285 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16286 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16287 description of all options.
16288 @item @code{name}
16289 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16290 @item @code{socket-type}
16291 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16292 @code{'seqpacket}.
16293 @item @code{protocol}
16294 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16295 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16296 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16297 listening to new service requests.
16298 @item @code{user}
16299 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16300 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16301 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16302 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16303 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16304 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16305 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16306 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16307 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16308 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16309 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16310 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16311 @end table
16312
16313 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16314 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16315 @end deftp
16316
16317 @cindex Tor
16318 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
16319 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
16320 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
16321 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
16322 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
16323
16324 @end defvr
16325
16326 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
16327 @table @asis
16328 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
16329 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
16330 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
16331 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
16332 implementation.
16333
16334 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
16335 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
16336 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
16337 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
16338 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
16339 syntax.
16340
16341 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
16342 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
16343 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
16344 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
16345 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
16346 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
16347
16348 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
16349 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
16350 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
16351 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
16352 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
16353 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16354 @code{tor} group.
16355
16356 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
16357 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
16358 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
16359 @code{SocksPort} option.
16360 @end table
16361 @end deftp
16362
16363 @cindex hidden service
16364 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
16365 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
16366 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
16367
16368 @example
16369 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
16370 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
16371 @end example
16372
16373 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
16374 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
16375
16376 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
16377 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
16378 service.
16379
16380 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
16381 project's documentation} for more information.
16382 @end deffn
16383
16384 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
16385
16386 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
16387 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
16388 files.
16389
16390 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
16391 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
16392 The value for this service type is a
16393 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
16394
16395 @lisp
16396 (service rsync-service-type)
16397 @end lisp
16398
16399 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
16400 @end deffn
16401
16402 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
16403 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
16404
16405 @table @asis
16406 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
16407 @code{rsync} package to use.
16408
16409 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
16410 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
16411 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
16412 @code{root} user and group.
16413
16414 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
16415 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
16416
16417 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
16418 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
16419
16420 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
16421 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
16422
16423 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
16424 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
16425
16426 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
16427 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16428
16429 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
16430 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16431
16432 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
16433 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
16434
16435 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
16436 I/O timeout in seconds.
16437
16438 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
16439 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
16440
16441 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
16442 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
16443
16444 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16445 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16446 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
16447
16448 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16449 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16450
16451 @end table
16452 @end deftp
16453
16454 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
16455 @cindex SSH
16456 @cindex SSH server
16457
16458 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
16459 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
16460 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
16461 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
16462 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
16463 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
16464 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
16465 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
16466 only by root.
16467
16468 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
16469 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
16470 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
16471 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
16472 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
16473
16474 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
16475 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
16476 require interaction.
16477
16478 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
16479 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
16480 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
16481 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
16482
16483 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
16484 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
16485 or addresses.
16486
16487 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
16488 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
16489 root.
16490
16491 The other options should be self-descriptive.
16492 @end deffn
16493
16494 @cindex SSH
16495 @cindex SSH server
16496 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
16497 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
16498 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
16499 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
16500
16501 @lisp
16502 (service openssh-service-type
16503 (openssh-configuration
16504 (x11-forwarding? #t)
16505 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
16506 (authorized-keys
16507 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
16508 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
16509 @end lisp
16510
16511 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
16512
16513 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
16514 example:
16515
16516 @lisp
16517 (service-extension openssh-service-type
16518 (const `(("charlie"
16519 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
16520 @end lisp
16521 @end deffn
16522
16523 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
16524 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
16525
16526 @table @asis
16527 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
16528 The Openssh package to use.
16529
16530 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
16531 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
16532
16533 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
16534 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
16535
16536 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
16537 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
16538 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
16539 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
16540 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
16541
16542 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16543 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
16544 not.
16545
16546 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16547 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
16548 other authentication methods.
16549
16550 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16551 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
16552 false, users have to use other authentication method.
16553
16554 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16555 This is used only by protocol version 2.
16556
16557 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
16558 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
16559 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
16560 @option{-Y} will work.
16561
16562 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16563 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
16564
16565 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16566 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
16567
16568 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
16569 Whether to allow gateway ports.
16570
16571 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
16572 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
16573 PAM).
16574
16575 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
16576 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
16577 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
16578 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
16579 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
16580 module processing for all authentication types.
16581
16582 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
16583 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
16584 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
16585 @code{password-authentication?}.
16586
16587 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
16588 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
16589 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
16590
16591 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
16592 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
16593
16594 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
16595 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
16596 subsystem request.
16597
16598 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
16599 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
16600 @lisp
16601 (service openssh-service-type
16602 (openssh-configuration
16603 (subsystems
16604 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
16605 @end lisp
16606
16607 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
16608 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
16609
16610 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
16611 @code{man sshd_config}.
16612
16613 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
16614 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
16615 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
16616 if this variable is set.
16617
16618 @lisp
16619 (service openssh-service-type
16620 (openssh-configuration
16621 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
16622 @end lisp
16623
16624 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
16625 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
16626 @cindex SSH authorized keys
16627 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
16628 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
16629 keys. For example:
16630
16631 @lisp
16632 (openssh-configuration
16633 (authorized-keys
16634 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
16635 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
16636 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
16637 @end lisp
16638
16639 @noindent
16640 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
16641 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
16642
16643 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
16644 @code{service-extension}.
16645
16646 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
16647 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16648
16649 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
16650 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
16651 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
16652 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
16653
16654 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
16655 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
16656 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
16657 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
16658 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
16659
16660 @lisp
16661 (openssh-configuration
16662 (extra-content "\
16663 Match Address 192.168.0.1
16664 PermitRootLogin yes"))
16665 @end lisp
16666
16667 @end table
16668 @end deftp
16669
16670 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
16671 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
16672 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
16673 object.
16674
16675 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
16676 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
16677
16678 @lisp
16679 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
16680 (port-number 1234)))
16681 @end lisp
16682 @end deffn
16683
16684 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
16685 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
16686
16687 @table @asis
16688 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
16689 The Dropbear package to use.
16690
16691 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
16692 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
16693
16694 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
16695 Whether to enable syslog output.
16696
16697 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
16698 File name of the daemon's PID file.
16699
16700 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
16701 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
16702
16703 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16704 Whether to allow empty passwords.
16705
16706 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16707 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
16708 @end table
16709 @end deftp
16710
16711 @cindex AutoSSH
16712 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
16713 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
16714 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
16715 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
16716 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
16717 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
16718 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
16719 here.
16720
16721 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
16722 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
16723 is run as.
16724
16725 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
16726 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
16727 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
16728 system's @code{services} field:
16729
16730 @lisp
16731 (service autossh-service-type
16732 (autossh-configuration
16733 (user "pino")
16734 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
16735 @end lisp
16736 @end deffn
16737
16738 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
16739 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
16740
16741 @table @asis
16742
16743 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
16744 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
16745 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16746
16747 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
16748 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
16749
16750 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
16751 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
16752 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
16753 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
16754 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
16755 @code{poll}.
16756
16757 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
16758 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
16759 considered successful.
16760
16761 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
16762 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
16763 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
16764
16765 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
16766 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
16767 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
16768
16769 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
16770 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
16771
16772 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
16773 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
16774 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
16775 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
16776 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
16777 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
16778 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
16779 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
16780 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
16781 @var{m} is the echo port.
16782
16783 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
16784 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
16785 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
16786 may cause undefined behaviour.
16787
16788 @end table
16789 @end deftp
16790
16791 @cindex WebSSH
16792 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
16793 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
16794 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
16795 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
16796 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
16797 latter use case is documented here.
16798
16799 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
16800 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
16801 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
16802 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
16803 @code{services} field:
16804
16805 @lisp
16806 (service webssh-service-type
16807 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
16808 (port 8888)
16809 (policy 'reject)
16810 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
16811 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
16812
16813 (service nginx-service-type
16814 (nginx-configuration
16815 (server-blocks
16816 (list
16817 (nginx-server-configuration
16818 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
16819 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
16820 (listen '("443 ssl"))
16821 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
16822 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
16823 (locations
16824 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
16825 (uri "/.well-known")
16826 (body '("root /var/www;")))
16827 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
16828 @end lisp
16829 @end deffn
16830
16831 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
16832 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
16833
16834 @table @asis
16835 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
16836 @code{webssh} package to use.
16837
16838 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
16839 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16840 place.
16841
16842 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
16843 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16844
16845 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
16846 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
16847
16848 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
16849 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
16850
16851 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
16852 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
16853
16854 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
16855 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
16856
16857 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
16858 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
16859
16860 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
16861 Logging level.
16862
16863 @end table
16864 @end deftp
16865
16866 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
16867 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
16868 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
16869 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
16870 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
16871 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
16872
16873 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
16874 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
16875 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
16876
16877 @lisp
16878 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
16879
16880 (operating-system
16881 (host-name "mymachine")
16882 ;; ...
16883 (hosts-file
16884 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
16885 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
16886 (plain-file "hosts"
16887 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
16888 %facebook-host-aliases))))
16889 @end lisp
16890
16891 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
16892 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
16893 @end defvr
16894
16895 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
16896
16897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
16898 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
16899 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
16900 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
16901 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
16902
16903 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
16904 resolve @code{.local} host names using
16905 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
16906 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
16907
16908 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
16909 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
16910 @end defvr
16911
16912 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
16913 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
16914
16915 @table @asis
16916
16917 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
16918 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
16919 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
16920
16921 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
16922 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
16923 network.
16924
16925 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
16926 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
16927 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
16928 your local network, you can run:
16929
16930 @example
16931 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
16932 @end example
16933
16934 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
16935 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
16936
16937 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
16938 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
16939 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
16940
16941 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
16942 This is a list of domains to browse.
16943 @end table
16944 @end deftp
16945
16946 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
16947 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
16948 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
16949 object.
16950 @end deffn
16951
16952 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
16953 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
16954 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
16955 through programmatic extension.
16956
16957 @table @asis
16958 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
16959 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
16960
16961 @end table
16962 @end deftp
16963
16964 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
16965 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
16966 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
16967 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
16968 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
16969
16970 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
16971
16972 @lisp
16973 (service pagekite-service-type
16974 (pagekite-configuration
16975 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
16976 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
16977 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
16978 @end lisp
16979 @end defvr
16980
16981 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
16982 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
16983
16984 @table @asis
16985 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
16986 Package object of PageKite.
16987
16988 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
16989 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
16990
16991 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
16992 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
16993 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
16994
16995 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
16996 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
16997 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
16998
16999 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17000 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17001 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17002
17003 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17004 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17005 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17006
17007 @end table
17008 @end deftp
17009
17010 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17011 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17012 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17013 encrypted IPv6 network.
17014
17015 @quotation
17016 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17017 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17018 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17019 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17020 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17021 @end quotation
17022
17023 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17024 peers and/or local peers.
17025
17026 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17027 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17028 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17029
17030 @lisp
17031 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17032 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17033 (yggdrasil-configuration
17034 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17035 (json-config
17036 ;; choose one from
17037 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17038 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17039 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17040 ))
17041 @end lisp
17042 @example
17043 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17044 @{
17045 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17046 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17047 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17048
17049 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17050 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17051
17052 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17053 # this with anyone.
17054 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17055
17056 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17057 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17058 @}
17059 @end example
17060 @end defvr
17061
17062 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17063 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17064
17065 @table @asis
17066 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17067 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17068
17069 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17070 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17071 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17072 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17073 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17074 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17075
17076 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17077 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17078 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17079
17080 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17081 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17082
17083 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17084 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17085 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17086 sends output to the running syslog service.
17087
17088 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17089 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17090 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17091 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17092 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17093 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17094 address, delete everything except these options:
17095
17096 @itemize
17097 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17098 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17099 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17100 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17101 @end itemize
17102 @end table
17103 @end deftp
17104
17105 @node Unattended Upgrades
17106 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17107
17108 @cindex unattended upgrades
17109 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17110 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17111 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17112 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17113 upgrades safe:
17114
17115 @itemize
17116 @item
17117 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17118 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17119 @item
17120 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17121 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17122 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17123 @item
17124 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17125 (@pxref{Channels});
17126 @item
17127 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17128 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17129 @end itemize
17130
17131 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17132 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17133 your operating system services:
17134
17135 @lisp
17136 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17137 @end lisp
17138
17139 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17140 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17141 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17142 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17143 for more information about this file.
17144
17145 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17146 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17147 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17148 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17149 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17150
17151 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17152 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
17153 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
17154
17155 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
17156 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
17157 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
17158 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
17159
17160 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
17161 below).
17162 @end defvr
17163
17164 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
17165 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
17166 service. The following fields are available:
17167
17168 @table @asis
17169 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
17170 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
17171 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
17172 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
17173
17174 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
17175 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
17176 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
17177 channel is used.
17178
17179 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
17180 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
17181 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
17182
17183 There are cases, though, where referring to
17184 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
17185 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
17186 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
17187 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
17188
17189 @lisp
17190 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
17191 (operating-system-file
17192 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
17193 "/config.scm")))
17194 @end lisp
17195
17196 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
17197 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
17198 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
17199 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
17200 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
17201
17202 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
17203 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
17204 completes.
17205
17206 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
17207 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
17208 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
17209 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
17210 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
17211 running.
17212
17213 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
17214 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
17215 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
17216
17217 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
17218 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
17219
17220 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
17221 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
17222 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
17223 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
17224
17225 @quotation Note
17226 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
17227 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
17228 periodically.
17229 @end quotation
17230
17231 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
17232 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
17233 aborts.
17234
17235 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
17236 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
17237
17238 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
17239 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
17240 @end table
17241 @end deftp
17242
17243 @node X Window
17244 @subsection X Window
17245
17246 @cindex X11
17247 @cindex X Window System
17248 @cindex login manager
17249 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
17250 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
17251 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
17252 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
17253
17254 @cindex GDM
17255 @cindex GNOME, login manager
17256 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
17257 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
17258 features such as automatic screen locking.
17259
17260 @cindex window manager
17261 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
17262 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
17263 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
17264 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
17265
17266 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
17267 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
17268 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
17269 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
17270 (see below).
17271
17272 @cindex session types (X11)
17273 @cindex X11 session types
17274 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
17275 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
17276 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
17277 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
17278 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
17279
17280 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
17281 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
17282 and/or other X clients.
17283 @end defvr
17284
17285 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
17286 @table @asis
17287 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17288 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
17289 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
17290
17291 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
17292 @code{default-user}.
17293
17294 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17295 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
17296
17297 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
17298 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
17299
17300 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17301 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17302
17303 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
17304 Script to run before starting a X session.
17305
17306 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
17307 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
17308
17309 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
17310 The GDM package to use.
17311 @end table
17312 @end deftp
17313
17314 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
17315 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
17316
17317 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
17318 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
17319 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
17320
17321 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
17322 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
17323 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
17324 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
17325 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
17326 and tty8.
17327
17328 @lisp
17329 (use-modules (gnu services)
17330 (gnu services desktop)
17331 (gnu services xorg)
17332 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
17333
17334 (operating-system
17335 ;; ...
17336 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17337 (display ":0")
17338 (vt "vt7")))
17339 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17340 (display ":1")
17341 (vt "vt8")))
17342 (remove (lambda (service)
17343 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
17344 %desktop-services))))
17345 @end lisp
17346
17347 @end defvr
17348
17349 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
17350 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
17351
17352 @table @asis
17353 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
17354 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
17355
17356 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17357 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
17358 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
17359
17360 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
17361 @code{default-user}.
17362
17363 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
17364 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
17365 The graphical theme to use and its name.
17366
17367 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
17368 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
17369 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
17370
17371 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
17372 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
17373 will be used.
17374
17375 @quotation Note
17376 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
17377 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
17378 false, you will be unable to log in.
17379 @end quotation
17380
17381 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17382 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17383
17384 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
17385 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17386
17387 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
17388 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17389
17390 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
17391 The XAuth package to use.
17392
17393 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
17394 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
17395 @command{reboot}.
17396
17397 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
17398 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
17399
17400 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
17401 The SLiM package to use.
17402 @end table
17403 @end deftp
17404
17405 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
17406 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
17407 The default SLiM theme and its name.
17408 @end defvr
17409
17410
17411 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17412 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
17413
17414 @table @asis
17415 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
17416 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
17417 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
17418
17419 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
17420 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
17421
17422 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
17423 Command to run when halting.
17424
17425 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
17426 Command to run when rebooting.
17427
17428 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
17429 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
17430 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
17431
17432 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
17433 Directory to look for themes.
17434
17435 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
17436 Directory to look for faces.
17437
17438 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
17439 Default PATH to use.
17440
17441 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
17442 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
17443
17444 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
17445 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
17446
17447 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
17448 Remember last user.
17449
17450 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
17451 Remember last session.
17452
17453 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
17454 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
17455
17456 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
17457 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
17458
17459 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
17460 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
17461
17462 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
17463 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
17464
17465 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17466 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17467
17468 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
17469 Path to xauth.
17470
17471 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
17472 Path to Xephyr.
17473
17474 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
17475 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
17476
17477 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
17478 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
17479
17480 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
17481 Script to run before starting a X session.
17482
17483 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
17484 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
17485
17486 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
17487 Minimum VT to use.
17488
17489 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
17490 User to use for auto-login.
17491
17492 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
17493 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
17494
17495 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
17496 Relogin after logout.
17497
17498 @end table
17499 @end deftp
17500
17501 @cindex login manager
17502 @cindex X11 login
17503 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
17504 This is the type of the service to run the
17505 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
17506 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
17507
17508 Here's an example use:
17509
17510 @lisp
17511 (service sddm-service-type
17512 (sddm-configuration
17513 (auto-login-user "alice")
17514 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
17515 @end lisp
17516 @end defvr
17517
17518 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17519 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
17520 The available fields are:
17521
17522 @table @asis
17523 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
17524 The SDDM package to use.
17525
17526 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
17527 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
17528
17529 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
17530
17531 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
17532 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
17533 automatically.
17534
17535 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
17536 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
17537 auto-login session.
17538 @end table
17539 @end deftp
17540
17541 @cindex Xorg, configuration
17542 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
17543 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
17544 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
17545 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
17546 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
17547
17548 @table @asis
17549 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
17550 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
17551 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
17552
17553 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
17554 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
17555
17556 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
17557 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
17558 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
17559 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
17560
17561 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
17562 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
17563 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
17564 768) (640 480))}.
17565
17566 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
17567 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
17568 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
17569 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
17570 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
17571
17572 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
17573 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
17574 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
17575
17576 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
17577 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
17578 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
17579
17580 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
17581 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
17582
17583 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
17584 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
17585 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
17586 @end table
17587 @end deftp
17588
17589 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
17590 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
17591 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
17592 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
17593
17594 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
17595 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
17596 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
17597 @end deffn
17598
17599 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
17600 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
17601 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
17602 @code{startx}.
17603
17604 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
17605 @end deffn
17606
17607
17608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
17609 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
17610 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
17611 for it. For example:
17612
17613 @lisp
17614 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
17615 @end lisp
17616
17617 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
17618 @end deffn
17619
17620
17621 @node Printing Services
17622 @subsection Printing Services
17623
17624 @cindex printer support with CUPS
17625 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
17626 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
17627 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
17628
17629 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
17630 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
17631 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
17632 write:
17633 @lisp
17634 (service cups-service-type)
17635 @end lisp
17636 @end deffn
17637
17638 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
17639 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
17640 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
17641 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
17642 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
17643 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
17644 secure connections to the print server.
17645
17646 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
17647 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
17648 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
17649 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
17650 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
17651
17652 @lisp
17653 (service cups-service-type
17654 (cups-configuration
17655 (web-interface? #t)
17656 (extensions
17657 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
17658 @end lisp
17659
17660 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
17661 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
17662 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
17663
17664 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17665 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17666 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17667 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
17668 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
17669 from some other system; see the end for more details.
17670
17671 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17672 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
17673 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17674 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17675 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17676 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17677 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
17678
17679
17680 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
17681
17682 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
17683 The CUPS package.
17684 @end deftypevr
17685
17686 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal foomatic-filters splix)})
17687 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
17688 @end deftypevr
17689
17690 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
17691 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
17692 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
17693
17694 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
17695
17696 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
17697 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17698 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17699 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17700 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17701 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17702 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17703 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
17704
17705 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
17706 @end deftypevr
17707
17708 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
17709 Where CUPS should cache data.
17710
17711 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
17712 @end deftypevr
17713
17714 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
17715 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
17716 writes.
17717
17718 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
17719 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
17720 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
17721 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
17722 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
17723
17724 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
17725 @end deftypevr
17726
17727 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
17728 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17729 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17730 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17731 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17732 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17733 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17734 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
17735
17736 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
17737 @end deftypevr
17738
17739 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
17740 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
17741 kind strings are:
17742
17743 @table @code
17744 @item none
17745 No errors are fatal.
17746
17747 @item all
17748 All of the errors below are fatal.
17749
17750 @item browse
17751 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
17752 to the DNS-SD daemon.
17753
17754 @item config
17755 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
17756
17757 @item listen
17758 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
17759 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
17760
17761 @item log
17762 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
17763
17764 @item permissions
17765 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
17766 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
17767 @end table
17768
17769 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
17770 @end deftypevr
17771
17772 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
17773 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
17774 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
17775
17776 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17777 @end deftypevr
17778
17779 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
17780 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
17781 programs.
17782
17783 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
17784 @end deftypevr
17785
17786 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
17787 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
17788
17789 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
17790 @end deftypevr
17791
17792 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
17793 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
17794 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
17795 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
17796 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
17797 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
17798 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
17799 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
17800
17801 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
17802 @end deftypevr
17803
17804 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
17805 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
17806 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
17807
17808 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
17809 @end deftypevr
17810
17811 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
17812 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
17813 data.
17814
17815 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
17816 @end deftypevr
17817
17818 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
17819 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
17820 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
17821 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
17822 used/supported on macOS.
17823
17824 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
17825 @end deftypevr
17826
17827 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
17828 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
17829 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
17830 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
17831 PEM-encoded private keys.
17832
17833 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
17834 @end deftypevr
17835
17836 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
17837 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
17838
17839 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
17840 @end deftypevr
17841
17842 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
17843 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
17844 configuration or state files.
17845
17846 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17847 @end deftypevr
17848
17849 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
17850 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
17851 @end deftypevr
17852
17853 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
17854 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
17855
17856 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
17857 @end deftypevr
17858
17859 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
17860 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
17861 programs.
17862
17863 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
17864 @end deftypevr
17865
17866 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
17867 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
17868
17869 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
17870 @end deftypevr
17871 @end deftypevr
17872
17873 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
17874 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
17875 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
17876 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
17877 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
17878 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
17879 level logs all requests.
17880
17881 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
17882 @end deftypevr
17883
17884 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
17885 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
17886 longer required for quotas.
17887
17888 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17889 @end deftypevr
17890
17891 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
17892 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
17893 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
17894 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
17895
17896 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
17897 @end deftypevr
17898
17899 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
17900 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
17901
17902 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
17903 @end deftypevr
17904
17905 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
17906 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
17907
17908 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17909 @end deftypevr
17910
17911 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
17912 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
17913
17914 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17915 @end deftypevr
17916
17917 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
17918 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
17919 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
17920 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
17921 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
17922
17923 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17924 @end deftypevr
17925
17926 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
17927 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
17928 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
17929
17930 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17931 @end deftypevr
17932
17933 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
17934 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
17935
17936 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
17937 @end deftypevr
17938
17939 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
17940 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
17941
17942 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
17943 @end deftypevr
17944
17945 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
17946 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
17947
17948 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
17949 @end deftypevr
17950
17951 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
17952 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
17953 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
17954 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
17955 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
17956
17957 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
17958 @end deftypevr
17959
17960 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
17961 Specifies the default access policy to use.
17962
17963 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
17964 @end deftypevr
17965
17966 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
17967 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
17968
17969 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17970 @end deftypevr
17971
17972 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
17973 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
17974 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
17975 typically within a few milliseconds.
17976
17977 Defaults to @samp{30}.
17978 @end deftypevr
17979
17980 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
17981 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
17982 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
17983 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
17984 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
17985 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
17986
17987 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
17988 @end deftypevr
17989
17990 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
17991 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
17992 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
17993 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
17994 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
17995 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
17996 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
17997 at any time.
17998
17999 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18000 @end deftypevr
18001
18002 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18003 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18004 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18005 lowest priority.
18006
18007 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18008 @end deftypevr
18009
18010 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18011 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18012 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18013 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18014 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18015 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18016 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18017
18018 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18019 @end deftypevr
18020
18021 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18022 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18023 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18024
18025 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18026 @end deftypevr
18027
18028 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18029 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18030 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18031 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18032 @code{retry-current-job}.
18033
18034 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18035 @end deftypevr
18036
18037 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18038 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18039 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18040 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18041 @code{retry-current-job}.
18042
18043 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18044 @end deftypevr
18045
18046 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18047 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18048
18049 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18050 @end deftypevr
18051
18052 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
18053 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
18054
18055 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18056 @end deftypevr
18057
18058 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18059 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18060 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18061
18062 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18063 @end deftypevr
18064
18065 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18066 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18067 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18068 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18069 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18070 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18071 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18072 @end deftypevr
18073
18074 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18075 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18076 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18077 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18078 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18079 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18080 ones.
18081
18082 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18083 @end deftypevr
18084
18085 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18086 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18087
18088 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18089
18090 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18091 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18092 @end deftypevr
18093
18094 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18095 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18096 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18097
18098 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18099 @end deftypevr
18100
18101 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18102 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18103
18104 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18105
18106 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18107
18108 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18109 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18110 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18111
18112 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18113 @end deftypevr
18114
18115 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18116 Methods to which this access control applies.
18117
18118 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18122 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18123 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18124
18125 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18126 @end deftypevr
18127 @end deftypevr
18128 @end deftypevr
18129
18130 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18131 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18132 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18133 of the LogLevel setting.
18134
18135 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18136 @end deftypevr
18137
18138 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18139 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18140 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18141
18142 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18143 @end deftypevr
18144
18145 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18146 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18147 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18148
18149 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18150 @end deftypevr
18151
18152 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
18153 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
18154 the scheduler.
18155
18156 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18157 @end deftypevr
18158
18159 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
18160 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
18161 from a single address.
18162
18163 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18164 @end deftypevr
18165
18166 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
18167 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
18168 job.
18169
18170 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
18171 @end deftypevr
18172
18173 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
18174 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
18175 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
18176 held jobs.
18177
18178 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18179 @end deftypevr
18180
18181 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
18182 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
18183 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
18184
18185 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18186 @end deftypevr
18187
18188 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
18189 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18190 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
18191
18192 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18193 @end deftypevr
18194
18195 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
18196 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18197 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
18198
18199 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18200 @end deftypevr
18201
18202 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
18203 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
18204 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
18205
18206 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
18207 @end deftypevr
18208
18209 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
18210 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
18211 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
18212
18213 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
18214 @end deftypevr
18215
18216 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
18217 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
18218 multiple file print job, in seconds.
18219
18220 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18221 @end deftypevr
18222
18223 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
18224 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
18225 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
18226 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
18227 sequences are recognized:
18228
18229 @table @samp
18230 @item %%
18231 insert a single percent character
18232
18233 @item %@{name@}
18234 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
18235
18236 @item %C
18237 insert the number of copies for the current page
18238
18239 @item %P
18240 insert the current page number
18241
18242 @item %T
18243 insert the current date and time in common log format
18244
18245 @item %j
18246 insert the job ID
18247
18248 @item %p
18249 insert the printer name
18250
18251 @item %u
18252 insert the username
18253 @end table
18254
18255 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
18256 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
18257 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
18258 standard items.
18259
18260 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18261 @end deftypevr
18262
18263 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
18264 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
18265 of strings.
18266
18267 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18268 @end deftypevr
18269
18270 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
18271 Specifies named access control policies.
18272
18273 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
18274
18275 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
18276 Name of the policy.
18277 @end deftypevr
18278
18279 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
18280 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
18281 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18282 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18283 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18284 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18285 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18286 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18287 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18288 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18289
18290 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18291 @end deftypevr
18292
18293 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
18294 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18295 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18296
18297 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
18298 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
18299 @end deftypevr
18300
18301 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
18302 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
18303 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18304 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18305 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18306 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18307 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18308 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18309 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18310 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18311
18312 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18313 @end deftypevr
18314
18315 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
18316 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18317 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18318
18319 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
18320 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
18321 @end deftypevr
18322
18323 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
18324 Access control by IPP operation.
18325
18326 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18327 @end deftypevr
18328 @end deftypevr
18329
18330 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
18331 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
18332 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
18333 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
18334 value applies indefinitely.
18335
18336 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
18337 @end deftypevr
18338
18339 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
18340 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
18341 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
18342 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
18343 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
18344
18345 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18346 @end deftypevr
18347
18348 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
18349 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
18350 restarting the scheduler.
18351
18352 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18353 @end deftypevr
18354
18355 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
18356 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
18357 into bitmaps for a printer.
18358
18359 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
18360 @end deftypevr
18361
18362 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
18363 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
18364
18365 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
18366 @end deftypevr
18367
18368 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
18369 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
18370 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
18371 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
18372 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
18373 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
18374 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
18375 @code{*}.
18376
18377 Defaults to @samp{*}.
18378 @end deftypevr
18379
18380 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
18381 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
18382
18383 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18384 @end deftypevr
18385
18386 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
18387 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
18388 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
18389 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
18390 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
18391 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
18392 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
18393 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
18394
18395 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
18396 @end deftypevr
18397
18398 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
18399 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
18400 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
18401 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
18402 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
18403
18404 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18405 @end deftypevr
18406
18407 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
18408 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
18409 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
18410 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
18411 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
18412 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
18413 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
18414 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
18415 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
18416 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
18417
18418 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18419 @end deftypevr
18420
18421 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
18422 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
18423 the IPP specifications.
18424
18425 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18426 @end deftypevr
18427
18428 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
18429 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
18430
18431 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18432
18433 @end deftypevr
18434
18435 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
18436 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
18437
18438 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18439 @end deftypevr
18440
18441 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
18442 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
18443 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
18444 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
18445 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
18446 @code{cups-service-type}.
18447
18448 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
18449
18450 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18451 The CUPS package.
18452 @end deftypevr
18453
18454 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
18455 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
18456 @end deftypevr
18457
18458 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
18459 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
18460 @end deftypevr
18461
18462 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
18463 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
18464 this:
18465
18466 @lisp
18467 (service cups-service-type
18468 (opaque-cups-configuration
18469 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
18470 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
18471 @end lisp
18472
18473
18474 @node Desktop Services
18475 @subsection Desktop Services
18476
18477 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
18478 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
18479 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
18480 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
18481 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
18482
18483 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
18484 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
18485 environment and networking:
18486
18487 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
18488 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
18489 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
18490
18491 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
18492 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
18493 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
18494 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
18495 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
18496 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
18497 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
18498 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
18499 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
18500 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
18501 @end defvr
18502
18503 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
18504 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
18505 Reference, @code{services}}).
18506
18507 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
18508 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
18509 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
18510 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
18511 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
18512 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
18513 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
18514 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
18515 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
18516 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
18517 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
18518 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
18519 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
18520 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
18521 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
18522 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
18523 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
18524 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
18525 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
18526 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
18527 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
18528 expected.
18529
18530 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
18531 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
18532 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
18533 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
18534 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
18535 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
18536 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
18537 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
18538
18539 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
18540 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
18541 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
18542 object (see below).
18543
18544 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
18545 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
18546 @end defvr
18547
18548 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
18549 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
18550
18551 @table @asis
18552 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
18553 The GNOME package to use.
18554 @end table
18555 @end deftp
18556
18557 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
18558 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
18559 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
18560 (see below).
18561
18562 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
18563 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
18564 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
18565 with the administrator's password.
18566 @end defvr
18567
18568 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
18569 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
18570
18571 @table @asis
18572 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
18573 The Xfce package to use.
18574 @end table
18575 @end deftp
18576
18577 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
18578 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
18579 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
18580 object (see below).
18581
18582 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
18583 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
18584 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
18585 @end deffn
18586
18587 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
18588 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
18589
18590 @table @asis
18591 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
18592 The MATE package to use.
18593 @end table
18594 @end deftp
18595
18596 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
18597 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt.github.io,
18598 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
18599 object (see below).
18600
18601 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
18602 profile.
18603 @end deffn
18604
18605 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
18606 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
18607
18608 @table @asis
18609 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
18610 The LXQT package to use.
18611 @end table
18612 @end deftp
18613
18614 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
18615 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
18616 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
18617 @end deffn
18618
18619 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
18620 @table @asis
18621 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
18622 The enlightenment package to use.
18623 @end table
18624 @end deftp
18625
18626 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
18627 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
18628 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
18629 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
18630 @code{operating-system}:
18631
18632 @lisp
18633 (use-modules (gnu))
18634 (use-service-modules desktop)
18635 (operating-system
18636 ...
18637 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
18638 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
18639 (service xfce-desktop-service)
18640 %desktop-services))
18641 ...)
18642 @end lisp
18643
18644 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
18645 graphical login window.
18646
18647 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
18648 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
18649 are described below.
18650
18651 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
18652 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
18653 support for @var{services}.
18654
18655 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
18656 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
18657 and to be notified of system-wide events.
18658
18659 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
18660 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
18661 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
18662 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
18663 @end deffn
18664
18665 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
18666 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
18667 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
18668 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
18669 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
18670 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
18671
18672 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
18673 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
18674 when the power button is pressed.
18675
18676 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
18677 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
18678 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
18679 their default values are:
18680
18681 @table @code
18682 @item kill-user-processes?
18683 @code{#f}
18684 @item kill-only-users
18685 @code{()}
18686 @item kill-exclude-users
18687 @code{("root")}
18688 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
18689 @code{5}
18690 @item handle-power-key
18691 @code{poweroff}
18692 @item handle-suspend-key
18693 @code{suspend}
18694 @item handle-hibernate-key
18695 @code{hibernate}
18696 @item handle-lid-switch
18697 @code{suspend}
18698 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
18699 @code{ignore}
18700 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
18701 @code{ignore}
18702 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
18703 @code{#f}
18704 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
18705 @code{#f}
18706 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
18707 @code{#f}
18708 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
18709 @code{#t}
18710 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
18711 @code{30}
18712 @item idle-action
18713 @code{ignore}
18714 @item idle-action-seconds
18715 @code{(* 30 60)}
18716 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
18717 @code{10}
18718 @item runtime-directory-size
18719 @code{#f}
18720 @item remove-ipc?
18721 @code{#t}
18722 @item suspend-state
18723 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
18724 @item suspend-mode
18725 @code{()}
18726 @item hibernate-state
18727 @code{("disk")}
18728 @item hibernate-mode
18729 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
18730 @item hybrid-sleep-state
18731 @code{("disk")}
18732 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
18733 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
18734 @end table
18735 @end deffn
18736
18737 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
18738 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
18739 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
18740 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
18741 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
18742 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
18743 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
18744 accountsservice web site} for more information.
18745
18746 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
18747 package to expose as a service.
18748 @end deffn
18749
18750 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
18751 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
18752 Return a service that runs the
18753 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
18754 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
18755 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
18756 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
18757 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
18758 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
18759 @end deffn
18760
18761 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
18762 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
18763 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
18764 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
18765 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
18766 @end defvr
18767
18768 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
18769 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
18770 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
18771 configuration settings.
18772
18773 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
18774 notably used by GNOME.
18775 @end defvr
18776
18777 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
18778 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
18779
18780 @table @asis
18781
18782 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
18783 Package to use for @code{upower}.
18784
18785 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
18786 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
18787
18788 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
18789 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
18790
18791 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
18792 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
18793
18794 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
18795 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
18796 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
18797
18798 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
18799 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
18800 at which the battery is considered low.
18801
18802 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
18803 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
18804 at which the battery is considered critical.
18805
18806 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
18807 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
18808 at which action will be taken.
18809
18810 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
18811 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
18812 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
18813
18814 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
18815 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
18816 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
18817
18818 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
18819 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
18820 seconds at which action will be taken.
18821
18822 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
18823 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
18824 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
18825
18826 Possible values are:
18827
18828 @itemize @bullet
18829 @item
18830 @code{'power-off}
18831
18832 @item
18833 @code{'hibernate}
18834
18835 @item
18836 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
18837 @end itemize
18838
18839 @end table
18840 @end deftp
18841
18842 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
18843 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
18844 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
18845 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
18846 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
18847 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
18848 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
18849 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
18850 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
18851 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
18852 @end deffn
18853
18854 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
18855 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
18856 service with a D-Bus
18857 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
18858 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
18859 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
18860 site} for more information.
18861 @end deffn
18862
18863 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
18864 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
18865 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
18866 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
18867 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
18868 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
18869 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
18870 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
18871 means that all users are allowed.
18872 @end deffn
18873
18874 @cindex scanner access
18875 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sane-service-type
18876 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
18877 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary udev
18878 rules.
18879 @end deffn
18880
18881 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
18882 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
18883 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
18884 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
18885 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
18886 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
18887 know the user's location.
18888 @end defvr
18889
18890 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
18891 [#:whitelist '()] @
18892 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
18893 [#:submit-data? #f]
18894 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
18895 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
18896 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
18897 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
18898 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
18899 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
18900 location databases. See
18901 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
18902 web site} for more information.
18903 @end deffn
18904
18905 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
18906 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
18907 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
18908 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
18909 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
18910 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
18911 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
18912
18913 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
18914 @end deffn
18915
18916 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
18917 This is the type of the service that adds the
18918 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
18919 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
18920
18921 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
18922 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
18923 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
18924 @end defvr
18925
18926 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
18927 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
18928
18929 @table @asis
18930 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
18931 The GNOME keyring package to use.
18932
18933 @item @code{pam-services}
18934 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
18935 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
18936 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
18937 @code{passwd}.
18938
18939 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
18940 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
18941 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
18942 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
18943 without arguments.
18944
18945 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
18946 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
18947 @end table
18948 @end deftp
18949
18950
18951 @node Sound Services
18952 @subsection Sound Services
18953
18954 @cindex sound support
18955 @cindex ALSA
18956 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
18957
18958 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
18959 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
18960 preferred ALSA output driver.
18961
18962 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
18963 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
18964 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
18965 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
18966 record as in this example:
18967
18968 @lisp
18969 (service alsa-service-type)
18970 @end lisp
18971
18972 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
18973 @end deffn
18974
18975 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
18976 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
18977
18978 @table @asis
18979 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
18980 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
18981
18982 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
18983 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
18984 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
18985
18986 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
18987 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
18988 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
18989
18990 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
18991 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
18992
18993 @end table
18994 @end deftp
18995
18996 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
18997 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
18998
18999 @example
19000 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19001 pcm_type.jack @{
19002 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19003 @}
19004
19005 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19006 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19007 pcm.rawjack @{
19008 type jack
19009 playback_ports @{
19010 0 system:playback_1
19011 1 system:playback_2
19012 @}
19013
19014 capture_ports @{
19015 0 system:capture_1
19016 1 system:capture_2
19017 @}
19018 @}
19019
19020 pcm.!default @{
19021 type plug
19022 slave @{
19023 pcm "rawjack"
19024 @}
19025 @}
19026 @end example
19027
19028 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19029 details.
19030
19031 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19032 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19033 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19034 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19035
19036 @quotation Warning
19037 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19038 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19039 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19040 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19041 @end quotation
19042
19043 @quotation Warning
19044 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19045 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19046 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19047 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19048 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19049 @end quotation
19050 @end deffn
19051
19052 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19053 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19054
19055 @table @asis
19056 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19057 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19058 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19059 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19060 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19061
19062 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19063 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19064 @var{client-conf}.
19065
19066 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19067 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19068
19069 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19070 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19071 @end table
19072 @end deftp
19073
19074 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19075 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19076 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19077
19078 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19079 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19080
19081 @lisp
19082 (service ladspa-service-type
19083 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19084 @end lisp
19085
19086 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19087 details.
19088
19089 @end deffn
19090
19091 @node Database Services
19092 @subsection Database Services
19093
19094 @cindex database
19095 @cindex SQL
19096 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19097
19098 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19099
19100 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19101 configuration.
19102
19103 @lisp
19104 (service postgresql-service-type
19105 (postgresql-configuration
19106 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19107 @end lisp
19108
19109 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19110 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
19111 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
19112 restart the service.
19113
19114 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
19115 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
19116 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
19117 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
19118 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
19119 database.
19120
19121 @example
19122 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
19123 createuser --interactive
19124 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
19125 @end example
19126
19127 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
19128 Data type representing the configuration for the
19129 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
19130
19131 @table @asis
19132 @item @code{postgresql}
19133 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
19134
19135 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
19136 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
19137
19138 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
19139 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
19140
19141 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
19142 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL. The default
19143 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
19144 for the fields.
19145
19146 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
19147 Directory in which to store the data.
19148
19149 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
19150 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
19151 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
19152 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
19153 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
19154 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
19155
19156 @cindex postgis
19157 @lisp
19158 (use-package-modules databases geo)
19159
19160 (operating-system
19161 ...
19162 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
19163 ;; proper operation.
19164 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
19165 (services
19166 (cons*
19167 (service postgresql-service-type
19168 (postgresql-configuration
19169 (postgresql postgresql-10)
19170 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
19171 %base-services)))
19172 @end lisp
19173
19174 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
19175 database in this way:
19176
19177 @example
19178 psql -U postgres
19179 > create database postgistest;
19180 > \connect postgistest;
19181 > create extension postgis;
19182 > create extension postgis_topology;
19183 @end example
19184
19185 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
19186 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
19187 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
19188
19189 @end table
19190 @end deftp
19191
19192 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
19193 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
19194 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
19195 of PostgreSQL. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
19196 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
19197 like to use for example.
19198
19199 @lisp
19200 (service postgresql-service-type
19201 (postgresql-configuration
19202 (config-file
19203 (postgresql-config-file
19204 (log-destination "stderr")
19205 (hba-file
19206 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
19207 "
19208 local all all trust
19209 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
19210 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
19211 (extra-config
19212 '(("session_preload_libraries" "'auto_explain'")
19213 ("random_page_cost" "2")
19214 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "'100ms'")
19215 ("work_mem" "'500MB'")
19216 ("logging_collector" "on")
19217 ("log_directory" "'/var/log/postgresql'")))))))
19218 @end lisp
19219
19220 @table @asis
19221 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
19222 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL. Multiple values are accepted,
19223 separated by commas.
19224
19225 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
19226 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
19227 configuration.
19228
19229 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
19230 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
19231
19232 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
19233 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
19234 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
19235 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
19236
19237 @end table
19238 @end deftp
19239
19240 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
19241
19242 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
19243 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
19244 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
19245 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
19246 @end defvr
19247
19248 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
19249 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
19250
19251 @table @asis
19252 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
19253 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
19254 or @var{mysql}.
19255
19256 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
19257 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
19258
19259 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19260 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
19261 to bind to all available network interfaces.
19262
19263 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
19264 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
19265
19266 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
19267 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
19268
19269 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19270 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
19271
19272 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
19273 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
19274 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
19275 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
19276 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
19277
19278 @end table
19279 @end deftp
19280
19281 @subsubheading Memcached
19282
19283 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
19284 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
19285 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
19286 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
19287 @end defvr
19288
19289 @lisp
19290 (service memcached-service-type)
19291 @end lisp
19292
19293 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
19294 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
19295
19296 @table @asis
19297 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
19298 The Memcached package to use.
19299
19300 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
19301 Network interfaces on which to listen.
19302
19303 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19304 Port on which to accept connections.
19305
19306 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19307 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19308 listening on a UDP socket.
19309
19310 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
19311 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
19312 @end table
19313 @end deftp
19314
19315 @subsubheading MongoDB
19316
19317 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
19318 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
19319 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
19320 @end defvr
19321
19322 @lisp
19323 (service mongodb-service-type)
19324 @end lisp
19325
19326 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
19327 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
19328
19329 @table @asis
19330 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
19331 The MongoDB package to use.
19332
19333 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
19334 The configuration file for MongoDB.
19335
19336 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
19337 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
19338 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
19339 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
19340 @end table
19341 @end deftp
19342
19343 @subsubheading Redis
19344
19345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
19346 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
19347 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
19348 @end defvr
19349
19350 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
19351 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
19352
19353 @table @asis
19354 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
19355 The Redis package to use.
19356
19357 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19358 Network interface on which to listen.
19359
19360 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
19361 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19362 listening on a TCP socket.
19363
19364 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
19365 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
19366 @end table
19367 @end deftp
19368
19369 @node Mail Services
19370 @subsection Mail Services
19371
19372 @cindex mail
19373 @cindex email
19374 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
19375 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
19376 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
19377 in the subsections below.
19378
19379 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
19380
19381 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
19382 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
19383 @end deffn
19384
19385 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
19386 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
19387 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
19388 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
19389 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
19390 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
19391 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
19392 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
19393
19394 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
19395 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
19396
19397 @lisp
19398 (dovecot-service #:config
19399 (dovecot-configuration
19400 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
19401 @end lisp
19402
19403 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19404 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19405 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19406 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
19407 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
19408 from some other system; see the end for more details.
19409
19410 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19411 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
19412 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19413 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19414 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19415 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19416 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
19417
19418 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
19419
19420 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
19421 The dovecot package.
19422 @end deftypevr
19423
19424 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
19425 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
19426 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
19427 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
19428 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
19429 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
19430 @end deftypevr
19431
19432 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
19433 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
19434 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
19435
19436 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
19437
19438 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
19439 The name of the protocol.
19440 @end deftypevr
19441
19442 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
19443 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
19444 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
19445 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
19446 @end deftypevr
19447
19448 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
19449 Space separated list of plugins to load.
19450 @end deftypevr
19451
19452 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
19453 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
19454 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
19455 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19456 @end deftypevr
19457
19458 @end deftypevr
19459
19460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
19461 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
19462 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
19463 @samp{lmtp}.
19464
19465 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
19466
19467 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
19468 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
19469 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
19470 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
19471 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
19472 @end deftypevr
19473
19474 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
19475 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
19476 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
19477 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
19478 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19479
19480 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
19481
19482 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19483 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19484 the section name.
19485 @end deftypevr
19486
19487 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19488 The access mode for the socket.
19489 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19490 @end deftypevr
19491
19492 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19493 The user to own the socket.
19494 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19495 @end deftypevr
19496
19497 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19498 The group to own the socket.
19499 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19500 @end deftypevr
19501
19502
19503 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
19504
19505 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19506 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19507 the section name.
19508 @end deftypevr
19509
19510 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19511 The access mode for the socket.
19512 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19513 @end deftypevr
19514
19515 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19516 The user to own the socket.
19517 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19518 @end deftypevr
19519
19520 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19521 The group to own the socket.
19522 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19523 @end deftypevr
19524
19525
19526 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
19527
19528 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
19529 The protocol to listen for.
19530 @end deftypevr
19531
19532 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
19533 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
19534 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19535 @end deftypevr
19536
19537 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
19538 The port on which to listen.
19539 @end deftypevr
19540
19541 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
19542 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
19543 @samp{required}.
19544 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19545 @end deftypevr
19546
19547 @end deftypevr
19548
19549 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
19550 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
19551 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
19552 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
19553 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
19554
19555 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19556
19557 @end deftypevr
19558
19559 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
19560 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
19561 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
19562 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
19563 Defaults to @samp{1}.
19564
19565 @end deftypevr
19566
19567 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
19568 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
19569 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
19570
19571 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19572
19573 @end deftypevr
19574
19575 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
19576 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
19577 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19578 @end deftypevr
19579
19580 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
19581 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
19582 this.
19583 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
19584 @end deftypevr
19585
19586 @end deftypevr
19587
19588 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
19589 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
19590 constructor.
19591
19592 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
19593
19594 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
19595 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
19596 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19597 @end deftypevr
19598
19599 @end deftypevr
19600
19601 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
19602 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
19603 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
19604
19605 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
19606
19607 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
19608 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
19609 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
19610 @samp{static}.
19611 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
19612 @end deftypevr
19613
19614 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
19615 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
19616 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19617 @end deftypevr
19618
19619 @end deftypevr
19620
19621 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
19622 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
19623 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
19624
19625 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
19626
19627 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
19628 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
19629 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
19630 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
19631 @end deftypevr
19632
19633 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
19634 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
19635 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19636 @end deftypevr
19637
19638 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
19639 Override fields from passwd.
19640 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19641 @end deftypevr
19642
19643 @end deftypevr
19644
19645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
19646 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
19647 constructor.
19648 @end deftypevr
19649
19650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
19651 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
19652 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
19653
19654 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
19655
19656 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
19657 Name for this namespace.
19658 @end deftypevr
19659
19660 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
19661 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
19662 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
19663 @end deftypevr
19664
19665 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
19666 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
19667 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
19668 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
19669 format.
19670 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19671 @end deftypevr
19672
19673 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
19674 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
19675 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
19676 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19677 @end deftypevr
19678
19679 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
19680 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
19681 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
19682 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19683 @end deftypevr
19684
19685 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
19686 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
19687 namespace has it.
19688 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19689 @end deftypevr
19690
19691 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
19692 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
19693 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
19694 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
19695 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
19696 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
19697 and @samp{mail/}.
19698 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19699 @end deftypevr
19700
19701 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
19702 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
19703 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
19704 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
19705 hides the namespace prefix.
19706 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19707 @end deftypevr
19708
19709 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
19710 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
19711 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
19712 as @code{#t}).
19713 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19714 @end deftypevr
19715
19716 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
19717 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
19718 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19719
19720 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
19721
19722 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
19723 Name for this mailbox.
19724 @end deftypevr
19725
19726 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
19727 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
19728 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
19729 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
19730 @end deftypevr
19731
19732 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
19733 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
19734 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
19735 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
19736 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19737 @end deftypevr
19738
19739 @end deftypevr
19740
19741 @end deftypevr
19742
19743 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
19744 Base directory where to store runtime data.
19745 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
19746 @end deftypevr
19747
19748 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
19749 Greeting message for clients.
19750 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
19751 @end deftypevr
19752
19753 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
19754 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
19755 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
19756 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
19757 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
19758 here.
19759 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19760 @end deftypevr
19761
19762 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
19763 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
19764 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19765 @end deftypevr
19766
19767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
19768 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
19769 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
19770 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
19771 accounts).
19772 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19773 @end deftypevr
19774
19775 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
19776 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
19777 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
19778 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
19779 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
19780 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19781 @end deftypevr
19782
19783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
19784 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
19785 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
19786 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19787 @end deftypevr
19788
19789 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
19790 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
19791 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
19792 @end deftypevr
19793
19794 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
19795 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
19796 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
19797 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
19798 @end deftypevr
19799
19800 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
19801 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
19802 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
19803 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
19804 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
19805 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
19806 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
19807 @end deftypevr
19808
19809 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
19810 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
19811 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
19812 for caching to be used.
19813 Defaults to @samp{0}.
19814 @end deftypevr
19815
19816 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
19817 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
19818 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
19819 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
19820 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
19821 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
19822 authentication.
19823 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
19824 @end deftypevr
19825
19826 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
19827 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
19828 0 disables caching them completely.
19829 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
19830 @end deftypevr
19831
19832 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
19833 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
19834 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
19835 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
19836 realm first.
19837 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19838 @end deftypevr
19839
19840 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
19841 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
19842 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
19843 logins.
19844 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19845 @end deftypevr
19846
19847 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
19848 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
19849 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
19850 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
19851 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
19852 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
19853 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
19854 @end deftypevr
19855
19856 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
19857 Username character translations before it's looked up from
19858 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
19859 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
19860 translated to @samp{@@}.
19861 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19862 @end deftypevr
19863
19864 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
19865 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
19866 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
19867 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
19868 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
19869 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
19870 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
19871 @end deftypevr
19872
19873 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
19874 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
19875 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
19876 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
19877 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
19878 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
19879 choice.
19880 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19881 @end deftypevr
19882
19883 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
19884 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
19885 mechanism.
19886 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
19887 @end deftypevr
19888
19889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
19890 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
19891 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
19892 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
19893 Defaults to @samp{30}.
19894 @end deftypevr
19895
19896 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
19897 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
19898 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
19899 allow all keytab entries.
19900 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19901 @end deftypevr
19902
19903 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
19904 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
19905 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
19906 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
19907 file.
19908 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19909 @end deftypevr
19910
19911 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
19912 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
19913 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
19914 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
19915 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19916 @end deftypevr
19917
19918 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
19919 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
19920 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
19921 @end deftypevr
19922
19923 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
19924 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
19925 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
19926 @end deftypevr
19927
19928 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
19929 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
19930 fails.
19931 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19932 @end deftypevr
19933
19934 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
19935 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
19936 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
19937 CommonName.
19938 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
19939 @end deftypevr
19940
19941 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
19942 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
19943 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
19944 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
19945 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
19946 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
19947 @end deftypevr
19948
19949 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
19950 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
19951 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
19952 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
19953 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19954 @end deftypevr
19955
19956 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
19957 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
19958 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
19959 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19960 @end deftypevr
19961
19962 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
19963 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
19964 has any connections.
19965 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
19966 @end deftypevr
19967
19968 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
19969 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
19970 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
19971 are shared within domain.
19972 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
19973 @end deftypevr
19974
19975 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
19976 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
19977 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
19978 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
19979 @end deftypevr
19980
19981 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
19982 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
19983 @samp{log-path}.
19984 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19985 @end deftypevr
19986
19987 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
19988 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
19989 @samp{info-log-path}.
19990 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19991 @end deftypevr
19992
19993 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
19994 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
19995 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
19996 standard facilities are supported.
19997 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
19998 @end deftypevr
19999
20000 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20001 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20002 failed.
20003 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20004 @end deftypevr
20005
20006 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20007 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20008 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20009 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20010 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20011 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20012 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20013 @end deftypevr
20014
20015 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20016 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20017 SQL queries.
20018 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20019 @end deftypevr
20020
20021 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
20022 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
20023 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
20024 @samp{auth-debug}.
20025 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20026 @end deftypevr
20027
20028 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
20029 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
20030 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
20031 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20032 @end deftypevr
20033
20034 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
20035 Show protocol level SSL errors.
20036 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20037 @end deftypevr
20038
20039 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
20040 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
20041 strftime(3) format.
20042 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
20043 @end deftypevr
20044
20045 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
20046 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
20047 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
20048 string.
20049 @end deftypevr
20050
20051 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
20052 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
20053 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
20054 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
20055 @end deftypevr
20056
20057 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
20058 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
20059 of possible variables you can use.
20060 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
20061 @end deftypevr
20062
20063 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
20064 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
20065 @table @code
20066 @item %$
20067 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
20068 @item %m
20069 Message-ID
20070 @item %s
20071 Subject
20072 @item %f
20073 From address
20074 @item %p
20075 Physical size
20076 @item %w
20077 Virtual size.
20078 @end table
20079 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
20080 @end deftypevr
20081
20082 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
20083 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
20084 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
20085 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
20086 Dovecot the full location.
20087
20088 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
20089 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
20090 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
20091 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
20092 @samp{mail-location} setting.
20093
20094 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
20095
20096 @table @samp
20097 @item %u
20098 username
20099 @item %n
20100 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
20101 @item %d
20102 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
20103 @item %h
20104 home director
20105 @end table
20106
20107 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
20108 @table @samp
20109 @item maildir:~/Maildir
20110 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
20111 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
20112 @end table
20113 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20114 @end deftypevr
20115
20116 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
20117 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
20118 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
20119 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
20120 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20121 @end deftypevr
20122
20123 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
20124
20125 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20126 @end deftypevr
20127
20128 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
20129 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
20130 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
20131 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
20132 @file{/var/mail}.
20133 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20134 @end deftypevr
20135
20136 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
20137 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
20138 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
20139 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
20140 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
20141 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
20142 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
20143 @samp{""}.
20144 @end deftypevr
20145
20146 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
20147 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
20148 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
20149 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
20150 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
20151 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20152 @end deftypevr
20153
20154 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
20155 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
20156 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
20157 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20158 @end deftypevr
20159
20160 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
20161 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
20162 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
20163 nowadays by default.
20164 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20165 @end deftypevr
20166
20167 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
20168 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
20169 @table @code
20170 @item optimized
20171 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
20172 @item always
20173 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
20174 @item never
20175 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
20176 @end table
20177 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
20178 @end deftypevr
20179
20180 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
20181 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
20182 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
20183 this isn't needed.
20184 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20185 @end deftypevr
20186
20187 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
20188 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
20189 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
20190 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20191 @end deftypevr
20192
20193 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
20194 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
20195 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
20196 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
20197 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
20198 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
20199 @end deftypevr
20200
20201 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
20202 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
20203 kB.
20204 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
20205 @end deftypevr
20206
20207 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
20208 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
20209 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
20210 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
20211 is set to 0.
20212 Defaults to @samp{500}.
20213 @end deftypevr
20214
20215 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
20216
20217 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20218 @end deftypevr
20219
20220 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
20221 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
20222 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
20223 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
20224 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20225 @end deftypevr
20226
20227 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
20228
20229 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20230 @end deftypevr
20231
20232 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
20233 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
20234 trying to create new keywords.
20235 Defaults to @samp{50}.
20236 @end deftypevr
20237
20238 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
20239 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
20240 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
20241 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
20242 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
20243 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
20244 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
20245 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
20246 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20247 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20248 @end deftypevr
20249
20250 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
20251 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
20252 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
20253 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
20254 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
20255 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
20256 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
20257 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20258 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20259 @end deftypevr
20260
20261 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
20262 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
20263 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20264 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20265 @end deftypevr
20266
20267 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
20268 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
20269 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
20270 @end deftypevr
20271
20272 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20273 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
20274 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
20275 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20276 @end deftypevr
20277
20278 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
20279 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
20280 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
20281 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
20282 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20283 @end deftypevr
20284
20285 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
20286 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
20287 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
20288 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
20289 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
20290 occur.
20291 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
20292 @end deftypevr
20293
20294 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
20295 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
20296 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
20297 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
20298 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
20299 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
20300 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20301 @end deftypevr
20302
20303 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
20304 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
20305 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
20306 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
20307 causes more disk I/O.
20308 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
20309 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
20310 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20311 @end deftypevr
20312
20313 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
20314 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
20315 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
20316 side effects.
20317 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20318 @end deftypevr
20319
20320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
20321 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
20322 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
20323 the mail otherwise.
20324 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20325 @end deftypevr
20326
20327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
20328 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
20329 available:
20330
20331 @table @code
20332 @item dotlock
20333 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
20334 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
20335 need write access to that directory.
20336 @item dotlock-try
20337 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
20338 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
20339 @item fcntl
20340 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
20341 @item flock
20342 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20343 @item lockf
20344 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20345 @end table
20346
20347 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
20348 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
20349 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
20350 them simultaneously.
20351 @end deftypevr
20352
20353 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
20354
20355 @end deftypevr
20356
20357 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
20358 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
20359 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
20360 @end deftypevr
20361
20362 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
20363 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
20364 override the lock file after this much time.
20365 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20366 @end deftypevr
20367
20368 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
20369 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
20370 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
20371 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
20372 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
20373 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
20374 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
20375 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
20376 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
20377 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
20378 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20379 @end deftypevr
20380
20381 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
20382 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
20383 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
20384 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
20385 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20386 @end deftypevr
20387
20388 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
20389 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
20390 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
20391 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
20392 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
20393 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20394 @end deftypevr
20395
20396 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
20397 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
20398 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
20399 updated.
20400 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20401 @end deftypevr
20402
20403 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
20404 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
20405 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
20406 @end deftypevr
20407
20408 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
20409 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
20410 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
20411 disabled.
20412 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
20413 @end deftypevr
20414
20415 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
20416 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
20417 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
20418 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
20419 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20420 @end deftypevr
20421
20422 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
20423 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
20424 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
20425 don't support this for now.
20426
20427 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
20428
20429 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
20430 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20431 @end deftypevr
20432
20433 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
20434 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
20435 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
20436 externally.
20437 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
20438 @end deftypevr
20439
20440 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
20441 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
20442 @table @code
20443 @item posix
20444 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
20445 @item sis posix
20446 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
20447 @item sis-queue posix
20448 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
20449 @end table
20450 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
20451 @end deftypevr
20452
20453 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
20454 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
20455 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
20456 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
20457 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
20458 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
20459 @end deftypevr
20460
20461 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
20462
20463 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20464 @end deftypevr
20465
20466 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
20467
20468 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
20469 @end deftypevr
20470
20471 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
20472 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
20473 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
20474 before they eat up everything.
20475 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20476 @end deftypevr
20477
20478 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
20479 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
20480 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
20481 at all.
20482 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
20483 @end deftypevr
20484
20485 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
20486 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
20487 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
20488 processes.
20489 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
20490 @end deftypevr
20491
20492 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
20493 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
20494 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
20495 @end deftypevr
20496
20497 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
20498 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
20499 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
20500 @end deftypevr
20501
20502 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
20503 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
20504 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
20505 root.
20506 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
20507 @end deftypevr
20508
20509 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
20510 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
20511 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
20512 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
20513 instead to a different.
20514 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20515 @end deftypevr
20516
20517 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
20518 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
20519 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
20520 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
20521 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
20522 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20523 @end deftypevr
20524
20525 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
20526 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
20527 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20528 @end deftypevr
20529
20530 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
20531 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
20532 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
20533 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20534 @end deftypevr
20535
20536 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
20537 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
20538 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
20539 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
20540 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
20541 @end deftypevr
20542
20543 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
20544 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
20545 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
20546 @end deftypevr
20547
20548 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
20549 SSL ciphers to use.
20550 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
20551 @end deftypevr
20552
20553 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
20554 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
20555 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20556 @end deftypevr
20557
20558 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
20559 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
20560 %d expands to recipient domain.
20561 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
20562 @end deftypevr
20563
20564 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
20565 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
20566 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
20567 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20568 @end deftypevr
20569
20570 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
20571 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
20572 bouncing the mail.
20573 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20574 @end deftypevr
20575
20576 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
20577 Binary to use for sending mails.
20578 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
20579 @end deftypevr
20580
20581 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
20582 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
20583 sendmail.
20584 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20585 @end deftypevr
20586
20587 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
20588 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
20589 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
20590 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
20591 @end deftypevr
20592
20593 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
20594 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
20595 variables:
20596
20597 @table @code
20598 @item %n
20599 CRLF
20600 @item %r
20601 reason
20602 @item %s
20603 original subject
20604 @item %t
20605 recipient
20606 @end table
20607 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
20608 @end deftypevr
20609
20610 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
20611 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
20612 address.
20613 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
20614 @end deftypevr
20615
20616 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
20617 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
20618 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
20619 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
20620 X-Original-To.
20621 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20622 @end deftypevr
20623
20624 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
20625 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
20626 it?.
20627 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20628 @end deftypevr
20629
20630 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
20631 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
20632 subscribed?.
20633 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20634 @end deftypevr
20635
20636 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
20637 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
20638 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
20639 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
20640 often.
20641 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
20642 @end deftypevr
20643
20644 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
20645 IMAP logout format string:
20646 @table @code
20647 @item %i
20648 total number of bytes read from client
20649 @item %o
20650 total number of bytes sent to client.
20651 @end table
20652 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
20653 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
20654 @end deftypevr
20655
20656 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
20657 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
20658 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
20659 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20660 @end deftypevr
20661
20662 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
20663 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
20664 is IDLEing.
20665 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20666 @end deftypevr
20667
20668 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
20669 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
20670 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
20671 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
20672 support-email.
20673 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20674 @end deftypevr
20675
20676 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
20677 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
20678 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20679 @end deftypevr
20680
20681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
20682 Workarounds for various client bugs:
20683
20684 @table @code
20685 @item delay-newmail
20686 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
20687 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
20688 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
20689 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
20690 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
20691 "Headers Only".
20692
20693 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
20694 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
20695 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
20696 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
20697
20698 @item tb-lsub-flags
20699 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
20700 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
20701 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
20702 @end table
20703 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20704 @end deftypevr
20705
20706 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
20707 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
20708 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20709 @end deftypevr
20710
20711
20712 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
20713 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
20714 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
20715 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
20716 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
20717
20718 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
20719 and running. In that case, you can pass an
20720 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
20721 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
20722 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
20723
20724 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
20725
20726 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
20727 The dovecot package.
20728 @end deftypevr
20729
20730 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
20731 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
20732 @end deftypevr
20733
20734 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
20735 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
20736
20737 @lisp
20738 (dovecot-service #:config
20739 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
20740 (string "")))
20741 @end lisp
20742
20743 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
20744
20745 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
20746 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
20747 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
20748 as in this example:
20749
20750 @lisp
20751 (service opensmtpd-service-type
20752 (opensmtpd-configuration
20753 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
20754 @end lisp
20755 @end deffn
20756
20757 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
20758 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
20759
20760 @table @asis
20761 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
20762 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
20763
20764 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
20765 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
20766 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
20767 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
20768 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
20769
20770 @end table
20771 @end deftp
20772
20773 @subsubheading Exim Service
20774
20775 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
20776 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
20777 @cindex SMTP
20778
20779 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
20780 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
20781 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
20782 as in this example:
20783
20784 @lisp
20785 (service exim-service-type
20786 (exim-configuration
20787 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
20788 @end lisp
20789 @end deffn
20790
20791 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
20792 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
20793 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
20794
20795 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
20796 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
20797
20798 @table @asis
20799 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
20800 Package object of the Exim server.
20801
20802 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
20803 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
20804 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
20805 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
20806 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
20807 variables.
20808
20809 @end table
20810 @end deftp
20811
20812 @subsubheading Getmail service
20813
20814 @cindex IMAP
20815 @cindex POP
20816
20817 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
20818 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
20819 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
20820 @end deffn
20821
20822 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
20823
20824 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
20825 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
20826
20827 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
20828
20829 @end deftypevr
20830
20831 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
20832 The getmail package to use.
20833
20834 @end deftypevr
20835
20836 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
20837 The user to run getmail as.
20838
20839 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
20840
20841 @end deftypevr
20842
20843 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
20844 The group to run getmail as.
20845
20846 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
20847
20848 @end deftypevr
20849
20850 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
20851 The getmail directory to use.
20852
20853 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
20854
20855 @end deftypevr
20856
20857 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
20858 The getmail configuration file to use.
20859
20860 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
20861
20862 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
20863 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
20864
20865 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
20866
20867 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
20868 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
20869 and @samp{static}.
20870
20871 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
20872
20873 @end deftypevr
20874
20875 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
20876 Username to login to the mail server with.
20877
20878 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
20879
20880 @end deftypevr
20881
20882 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
20883 Username to login to the mail server with.
20884
20885 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
20886
20887 @end deftypevr
20888
20889 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
20890 Port number to connect to.
20891
20892 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20893
20894 @end deftypevr
20895
20896 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
20897 Override fields from passwd.
20898
20899 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20900
20901 @end deftypevr
20902
20903 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
20904 Override fields from passwd.
20905
20906 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20907
20908 @end deftypevr
20909
20910 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
20911 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
20912
20913 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20914
20915 @end deftypevr
20916
20917 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
20918 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
20919
20920 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20921
20922 @end deftypevr
20923
20924 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
20925 CA certificates to use.
20926
20927 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20928
20929 @end deftypevr
20930
20931 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
20932 Extra retriever parameters.
20933
20934 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20935
20936 @end deftypevr
20937
20938 @end deftypevr
20939
20940 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
20941 What to do with retrieved messages.
20942
20943 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
20944
20945 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
20946 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
20947 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
20948
20949 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
20950
20951 @end deftypevr
20952
20953 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
20954 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
20955 chosen type.
20956
20957 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20958
20959 @end deftypevr
20960
20961 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
20962 Extra destination parameters
20963
20964 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20965
20966 @end deftypevr
20967
20968 @end deftypevr
20969
20970 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
20971 Configure getmail.
20972
20973 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
20974
20975 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
20976 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
20977 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
20978 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
20979 about each of it's actions.
20980
20981 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20982
20983 @end deftypevr
20984
20985 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
20986 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
20987 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
20988
20989 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20990
20991 @end deftypevr
20992
20993 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
20994 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
20995 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
20996 be left on the server.
20997
20998 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20999
21000 @end deftypevr
21001
21002 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21003 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21004 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21005 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21006 disabled this feature.
21007
21008 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21009
21010 @end deftypevr
21011
21012 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
21013 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
21014 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
21015 disables this feature.
21016
21017 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21018
21019 @end deftypevr
21020
21021 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
21022 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
21023 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
21024
21025 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21026
21027 @end deftypevr
21028
21029 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
21030 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
21031 @samp{0} disables this feature.
21032
21033 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21034
21035 @end deftypevr
21036
21037 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
21038 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
21039
21040 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21041
21042 @end deftypevr
21043
21044 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
21045 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
21046
21047 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21048
21049 @end deftypevr
21050
21051 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
21052 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
21053 @samp{""} disables this feature.
21054
21055 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21056
21057 @end deftypevr
21058
21059 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
21060 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
21061 logger.
21062
21063 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21064
21065 @end deftypevr
21066
21067 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
21068 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
21069 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
21070 information lines.
21071
21072 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21073
21074 @end deftypevr
21075
21076 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21077 Extra options to include.
21078
21079 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21080
21081 @end deftypevr
21082
21083 @end deftypevr
21084
21085 @end deftypevr
21086
21087 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
21088 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
21089 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
21090 extension.
21091
21092 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21093
21094 @end deftypevr
21095
21096 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
21097 Environment variables to set for getmail.
21098
21099 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21100
21101 @end deftypevr
21102
21103 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
21104
21105 @cindex email aliases
21106 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
21107
21108 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
21109 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
21110 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
21111
21112 @lisp
21113 (service mail-aliases-service-type
21114 '(("postmaster" "bob")
21115 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
21116 @end lisp
21117 @end deffn
21118
21119 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
21120 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
21121 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
21122 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
21123 where to deliver this user's mail.
21124
21125 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
21126 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
21127 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
21128 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
21129 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
21130
21131 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21132 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21133
21134 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
21135 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
21136 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
21137 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
21138
21139 @lisp
21140 (service imap4d-service-type
21141 (imap4d-configuration
21142 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
21143 @end lisp
21144 @end deffn
21145
21146 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
21147 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
21148
21149 @table @asis
21150 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
21151 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
21152
21153 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
21154 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21155 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
21156 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
21157
21158 @end table
21159 @end deftp
21160
21161 @node Messaging Services
21162 @subsection Messaging Services
21163
21164 @cindex messaging
21165 @cindex jabber
21166 @cindex XMPP
21167 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
21168 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
21169 services:
21170
21171 @subsubheading Prosody Service
21172
21173 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
21174 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
21175 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
21176 record as in this example:
21177
21178 @lisp
21179 (service prosody-service-type
21180 (prosody-configuration
21181 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
21182 (int-components
21183 (list
21184 (int-component-configuration
21185 (hostname "conference.example.net")
21186 (plugin "muc")
21187 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
21188 (virtualhosts
21189 (list
21190 (virtualhost-configuration
21191 (domain "example.net"))))))
21192 @end lisp
21193
21194 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
21195
21196 @end deffn
21197
21198 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
21199 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
21200 Prosody to serve.
21201
21202 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
21203 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
21204
21205 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
21206 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
21207 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
21208
21209 @example
21210 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
21211 @end example
21212
21213 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
21214 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
21215 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
21216 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
21217 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21218
21219 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
21220 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
21221 some other system; see the end for more details.
21222
21223 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
21224 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
21225
21226 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21227 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
21228 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21229 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21230 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21231 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21232 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
21233
21234 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
21235
21236 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21237 The Prosody package.
21238 @end deftypevr
21239
21240 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
21241 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
21242 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
21243 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
21244 @end deftypevr
21245
21246 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
21247 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
21248 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
21249 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21250 @end deftypevr
21251
21252 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
21253 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
21254 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
21255 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
21256 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
21257 @end deftypevr
21258
21259 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
21260 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
21261 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
21262 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21263 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
21264 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21265 @end deftypevr
21266
21267 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
21268 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
21269 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
21270 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21271 @end deftypevr
21272
21273 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
21274 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
21275 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
21276 Documentation on modules can be found at:
21277 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
21278 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
21279 @end deftypevr
21280
21281 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
21282 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
21283 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
21284 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21285 @end deftypevr
21286
21287 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
21288 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
21289 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
21290 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
21291 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
21292 @end deftypevr
21293
21294 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
21295 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
21296 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21297 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21298 @end deftypevr
21299
21300 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
21301 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
21302 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
21303 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
21304 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
21305
21306 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
21307
21308 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
21309 This determines what handshake to use.
21310 @end deftypevr
21311
21312 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
21313 Path to your private key file.
21314 @end deftypevr
21315
21316 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
21317 Path to your certificate file.
21318 @end deftypevr
21319
21320 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
21321 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
21322 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
21323 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
21324 @end deftypevr
21325
21326 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
21327 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
21328 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
21329 @end deftypevr
21330
21331 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
21332 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
21333 @code{set_verify()} flags).
21334 @end deftypevr
21335
21336 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
21337 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
21338 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
21339 LuaSec source.
21340 @end deftypevr
21341
21342 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
21343 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
21344 trusted root certificate.
21345 @end deftypevr
21346
21347 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
21348 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
21349 clients, and in what order.
21350 @end deftypevr
21351
21352 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
21353 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
21354 can create such a file with:
21355 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
21356 @end deftypevr
21357
21358 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
21359 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
21360 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
21361 @end deftypevr
21362
21363 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
21364 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
21365 @end deftypevr
21366
21367 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
21368 Password for encrypted private keys.
21369 @end deftypevr
21370
21371 @end deftypevr
21372
21373 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
21374 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21375 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21376 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21377 @end deftypevr
21378
21379 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
21380 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
21381 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
21382 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
21383 @end deftypevr
21384
21385 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
21386 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21387 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21388 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21389 @end deftypevr
21390
21391 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
21392 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
21393 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
21394 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
21395 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21396 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21397 @end deftypevr
21398
21399 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
21400 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
21401 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
21402 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
21403 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21404 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21405 @end deftypevr
21406
21407 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
21408 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
21409 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
21410 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21411 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21412 @end deftypevr
21413
21414 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
21415 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
21416 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
21417 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
21418 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
21419 about using the hashed backend. See also
21420 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
21421 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
21422 @end deftypevr
21423
21424 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
21425 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
21426 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
21427 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
21428 @end deftypevr
21429
21430 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
21431 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
21432 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
21433 @end deftypevr
21434
21435 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
21436 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
21437 @end deftypevr
21438
21439 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
21440 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
21441 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
21442 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
21443 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
21444 @end deftypevr
21445
21446 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
21447 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
21448 example if you want your users to have addresses like
21449 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
21450 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
21451
21452 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
21453 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
21454 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
21455 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
21456 have just one VirtualHost entry.
21457
21458 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
21459
21460 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
21461
21462 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21463 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
21464 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
21465 @end deftypevr
21466
21467 @end deftypevr
21468
21469 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
21470 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
21471 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
21472 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
21473 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
21474
21475 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
21476 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
21477 to use for the component.
21478
21479 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21480 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21481
21482 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
21483
21484 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21485 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21486 Hostname of the component.
21487 @end deftypevr
21488
21489 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
21490 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
21491 @end deftypevr
21492
21493 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
21494 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
21495 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
21496
21497 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
21498 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
21499 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
21500
21501 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
21502
21503 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
21504
21505 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
21506 The name to return in service discovery responses.
21507 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
21508 @end deftypevr
21509
21510 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
21511 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
21512 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
21513 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
21514 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
21515 restricts to service administrators only.
21516 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21517 @end deftypevr
21518
21519 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
21520 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
21521 just joined the room.
21522 Defaults to @samp{20}.
21523 @end deftypevr
21524
21525 @end deftypevr
21526
21527 @end deftypevr
21528
21529 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
21530 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
21531 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
21532 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21533 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21534
21535 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
21536
21537 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21538 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
21539 Password which the component will use to log in.
21540 @end deftypevr
21541
21542 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21543 Hostname of the component.
21544 @end deftypevr
21545
21546 @end deftypevr
21547
21548 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
21549 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
21550 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
21551 @end deftypevr
21552
21553 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
21554 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
21555 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
21556 @end deftypevr
21557
21558 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
21559 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
21560 @end deftypevr
21561
21562 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
21563 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
21564 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
21565 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21566 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21567 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
21568
21569 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21570 The prosody package.
21571 @end deftypevr
21572
21573 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
21574 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
21575 @end deftypevr
21576
21577 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
21578 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
21579
21580 @lisp
21581 (service prosody-service-type
21582 (opaque-prosody-configuration
21583 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
21584 @end lisp
21585
21586 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
21587
21588 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
21589
21590 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
21591 @cindex IRC gateway
21592 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
21593 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
21594
21595 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
21596 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
21597 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
21598 below).
21599
21600 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
21601 services:
21602
21603 @lisp
21604 (service bitlbee-service-type)
21605 @end lisp
21606 @end defvr
21607
21608 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
21609 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
21610
21611 @table @asis
21612 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
21613 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
21614 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
21615 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
21616
21617 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
21618 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
21619 networking interface.
21620
21621 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
21622 The BitlBee package to use.
21623
21624 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
21625 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
21626
21627 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
21628 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
21629 @end table
21630 @end deftp
21631
21632 @subsubheading Quassel Service
21633
21634 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
21635 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
21636 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
21637 central core.
21638
21639 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
21640 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
21641 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
21642 (see below).
21643 @end defvr
21644
21645 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
21646 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
21647
21648 @table @asis
21649 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
21650 The Quassel package to use.
21651
21652 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
21653 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
21654 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
21655 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
21656 @var{port}.
21657
21658 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
21659 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
21660 and Error.
21661 @end table
21662 @end deftp
21663
21664 @node Telephony Services
21665 @subsection Telephony Services
21666
21667 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
21668 @cindex VoIP server
21669 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
21670 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
21671 (VoIP) suite.
21672
21673 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
21674 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
21675 look like this:
21676
21677 @lisp
21678 (service murmur-service-type
21679 (murmur-configuration
21680 (welcome-text
21681 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
21682 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
21683 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
21684 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
21685 @end lisp
21686
21687 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
21688 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
21689
21690 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
21691 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
21692 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
21693 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
21694 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
21695 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
21696 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
21697 rights and create some channels.
21698
21699 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
21700
21701 @table @asis
21702 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
21703 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
21704
21705 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
21706 User who will run the Murmur server.
21707
21708 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
21709 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
21710
21711 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
21712 Port on which the server will listen.
21713
21714 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
21715 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
21716
21717 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
21718 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
21719
21720 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
21721 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
21722
21723 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
21724 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
21725
21726 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
21727 File name of the sqlite database.
21728 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
21729
21730 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
21731 File name of the log file.
21732 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
21733
21734 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
21735 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
21736 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
21737
21738 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
21739 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
21740
21741 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
21742 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
21743 when violating the autoban limits.
21744
21745 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
21746 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
21747 before switching over to opus audio codec.
21748
21749 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
21750 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
21751
21752 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
21753 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
21754
21755 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
21756 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
21757
21758 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
21759 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
21760
21761 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
21762 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
21763
21764 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
21765 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
21766 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
21767
21768 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
21769 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
21770 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
21771
21772 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
21773 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
21774
21775 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
21776 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
21777 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
21778 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
21779
21780 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
21781
21782 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
21783 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
21784
21785 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
21786 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
21787
21788 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
21789 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
21790 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
21791 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
21792
21793 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
21794 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
21795
21796 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
21797 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
21798
21799 @lisp
21800 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
21801 @end lisp
21802 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
21803 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
21804 @lisp
21805 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
21806 @end lisp
21807
21808 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
21809 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
21810 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
21811 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
21812 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
21813
21814 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
21815 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
21816 in SSL/TLS.
21817
21818 This option is specified using
21819 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
21820 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
21821
21822 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
21823 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
21824 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
21825 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
21826
21827 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
21828 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
21829 to connect to it.
21830
21831 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
21832 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
21833
21834 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
21835 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
21836 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
21837 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
21838
21839 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
21840
21841 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
21842 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
21843 @end table
21844 @end deftp
21845
21846 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
21847 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
21848
21849 @table @asis
21850 @item @code{name}
21851 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
21852
21853 @item @code{password}
21854 A password to identify your registration.
21855 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
21856
21857 @item @code{url}
21858 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
21859 site.
21860
21861 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
21862 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
21863 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
21864 @end table
21865 @end deftp
21866
21867
21868
21869 @node Monitoring Services
21870 @subsection Monitoring Services
21871
21872 @subsubheading Tailon Service
21873
21874 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
21875 viewing and searching log files.
21876
21877 The following example will configure the service with default values.
21878 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
21879
21880 @lisp
21881 (service tailon-service-type)
21882 @end lisp
21883
21884 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
21885 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
21886
21887 @lisp
21888 (service tailon-service-type
21889 (tailon-configuration
21890 (config-file
21891 (tailon-configuration-file
21892 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
21893 @end lisp
21894
21895
21896 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
21897 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
21898 This type has the following parameters:
21899
21900 @table @asis
21901 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
21902 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
21903 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
21904 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
21905
21906 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
21907 can be used:
21908
21909 @lisp
21910 (service tailon-service-type
21911 (tailon-configuration
21912 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
21913 @end lisp
21914
21915 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
21916 The tailon package to use.
21917
21918 @end table
21919 @end deftp
21920
21921 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
21922 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
21923 This type has the following parameters:
21924
21925 @table @asis
21926 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
21927 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
21928 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
21929 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
21930 subsection.
21931
21932 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
21933 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
21934
21935 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
21936 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
21937
21938 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
21939 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
21940
21941 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
21942 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
21943
21944 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
21945 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
21946
21947 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
21948 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
21949
21950 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
21951 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
21952
21953 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
21954 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
21955 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
21956 wrap lines.
21957
21958 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
21959 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
21960 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
21961 @code{"basic"}.
21962
21963 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
21964 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
21965 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
21966 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
21967 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
21968
21969 @lisp
21970 (tailon-configuration-file
21971 (http-auth "basic")
21972 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
21973 ("user2" . "password2"))))
21974 @end lisp
21975
21976 @end table
21977 @end deftp
21978
21979
21980 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
21981 @cindex darkstat
21982 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
21983 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
21984
21985 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
21986 This is the service type for the
21987 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
21988 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
21989 this example:
21990
21991 @lisp
21992 (service darkstat-service-type
21993 (darkstat-configuration
21994 (interface "eno1")))
21995 @end lisp
21996 @end defvar
21997
21998 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
21999 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
22000
22001 @table @asis
22002 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
22003 The darkstat package to use.
22004
22005 @item @code{interface}
22006 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
22007
22008 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
22009 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
22010
22011 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22012 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
22013
22014 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
22015 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
22016 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
22017
22018 @end table
22019 @end deftp
22020
22021 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
22022
22023 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
22024 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
22025 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
22026 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
22027 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
22028
22029 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
22030 This is the service type for the
22031 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
22032 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
22033
22034 @lisp
22035 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
22036 @end lisp
22037 @end defvar
22038
22039 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
22040 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
22041
22042 @table @asis
22043 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
22044 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
22045
22046 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
22047 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
22048
22049 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
22050 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
22051 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
22052 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
22053
22054 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
22055 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
22056
22057 @end table
22058 @end deftp
22059
22060 @subsubheading Zabbix server
22061 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
22062 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
22063 and disk space consumption:
22064
22065 @itemize
22066 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
22067 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
22068 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
22069 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
22070 @item Native high performance agents.
22071 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
22072 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
22073 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
22074 @end itemize
22075
22076 @c %start of fragment
22077
22078 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
22079
22080 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
22081 The zabbix-server package.
22082
22083 @end deftypevr
22084
22085 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
22086 User who will run the Zabbix server.
22087
22088 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22089
22090 @end deftypevr
22091
22092 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
22093 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
22094
22095 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22096
22097 @end deftypevr
22098
22099 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
22100 Database host name.
22101
22102 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22103
22104 @end deftypevr
22105
22106 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
22107 Database name.
22108
22109 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22110
22111 @end deftypevr
22112
22113 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
22114 Database user.
22115
22116 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22117
22118 @end deftypevr
22119
22120 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
22121 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
22122 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
22123
22124 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22125
22126 @end deftypevr
22127
22128 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
22129 Database port.
22130
22131 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
22132
22133 @end deftypevr
22134
22135 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
22136 Specifies where log messages are written to:
22137
22138 @itemize @bullet
22139 @item
22140 @code{system} - syslog.
22141
22142 @item
22143 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
22144
22145 @item
22146 @code{console} - standard output.
22147
22148 @end itemize
22149
22150 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22151
22152 @end deftypevr
22153
22154 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
22155 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
22156
22157 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
22158
22159 @end deftypevr
22160
22161 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22162 Name of PID file.
22163
22164 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
22165
22166 @end deftypevr
22167
22168 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
22169 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
22170 certificate verification.
22171
22172 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
22173
22174 @end deftypevr
22175
22176 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
22177 Location of SSL client certificates.
22178
22179 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
22180
22181 @end deftypevr
22182
22183 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
22184 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
22185
22186 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22187
22188 @end deftypevr
22189
22190 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
22191 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
22192 configuration file.
22193
22194 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22195
22196 @end deftypevr
22197
22198 @c %end of fragment
22199
22200 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
22201 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
22202
22203 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
22204
22205 @c %start of fragment
22206
22207 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
22208
22209 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
22210 The zabbix-agent package.
22211
22212 @end deftypevr
22213
22214 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
22215 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
22216
22217 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22218
22219 @end deftypevr
22220
22221 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
22222 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
22223
22224 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22225
22226 @end deftypevr
22227
22228 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22229 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
22230 must match hostname as configured on the server.
22231
22232 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22233
22234 @end deftypevr
22235
22236 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
22237 Specifies where log messages are written to:
22238
22239 @itemize @bullet
22240 @item
22241 @code{system} - syslog.
22242
22243 @item
22244 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
22245
22246 @item
22247 @code{console} - standard output.
22248
22249 @end itemize
22250
22251 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22252
22253 @end deftypevr
22254
22255 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
22256 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
22257
22258 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
22259
22260 @end deftypevr
22261
22262 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
22263 Name of PID file.
22264
22265 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
22266
22267 @end deftypevr
22268
22269 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
22270 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
22271 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
22272 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
22273
22274 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
22275
22276 @end deftypevr
22277
22278 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
22279 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
22280 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
22281 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
22282
22283 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
22284
22285 @end deftypevr
22286
22287 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
22288 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
22289
22290 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22291
22292 @end deftypevr
22293
22294 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
22295 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
22296 configuration file.
22297
22298 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22299
22300 @end deftypevr
22301
22302 @c %end of fragment
22303
22304 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
22305 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
22306
22307 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
22308
22309 @c %start of fragment
22310
22311 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
22312
22313 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
22314 NGINX configuration.
22315
22316 @end deftypevr
22317
22318 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
22319 Database host name.
22320
22321 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
22322
22323 @end deftypevr
22324
22325 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
22326 Database port.
22327
22328 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
22329
22330 @end deftypevr
22331
22332 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
22333 Database name.
22334
22335 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22336
22337 @end deftypevr
22338
22339 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
22340 Database user.
22341
22342 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
22343
22344 @end deftypevr
22345
22346 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
22347 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
22348
22349 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22350
22351 @end deftypevr
22352
22353 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
22354 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
22355 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
22356 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
22357 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
22358
22359 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22360
22361 @end deftypevr
22362
22363 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
22364 Zabbix server hostname.
22365
22366 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
22367
22368 @end deftypevr
22369
22370 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
22371 Zabbix server port.
22372
22373 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
22374
22375 @end deftypevr
22376
22377
22378 @c %end of fragment
22379
22380 @node Kerberos Services
22381 @subsection Kerberos Services
22382 @cindex Kerberos
22383
22384 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
22385 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
22386
22387 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
22388
22389 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
22390 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
22391 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
22392 operating system declaration.
22393 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
22394
22395 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
22396 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
22397 Other implementations have not been tested.
22398
22399 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
22400 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
22401 @end defvr
22402
22403 @noindent
22404 Here is an example of its use:
22405 @lisp
22406 (service krb5-service-type
22407 (krb5-configuration
22408 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
22409 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
22410 (realms (list
22411 (krb5-realm
22412 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
22413 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
22414 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
22415 (krb5-realm
22416 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
22417 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
22418 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
22419 @end lisp
22420
22421 @noindent
22422 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
22423 @itemize
22424 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
22425 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
22426 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
22427 specified by clients;
22428 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
22429 @end itemize
22430
22431 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
22432 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
22433 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
22434 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
22435 documentation.
22436
22437
22438 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
22439 @cindex realm, kerberos
22440 @table @asis
22441 @item @code{name}
22442 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
22443 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
22444 converted to upper case.
22445
22446 @item @code{admin-server}
22447 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
22448 running.
22449
22450 @item @code{kdc}
22451 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
22452 for the realm.
22453 @end table
22454 @end deftp
22455
22456 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
22457
22458 @table @asis
22459 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
22460 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
22461 known to be weak will be accepted.
22462
22463 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
22464 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
22465 realm for the client.
22466 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
22467 If this value is @code{#f}
22468 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
22469 such as @command{kinit}.
22470
22471 @item @code{realms}
22472 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
22473 access.
22474 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
22475 field.
22476 @end table
22477 @end deftp
22478
22479
22480 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
22481 @cindex pam-krb5
22482
22483 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
22484 management via Kerberos.
22485 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
22486 users using Kerberos.
22487
22488 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
22489 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
22490 @end defvr
22491
22492 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
22493 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
22494 This type has the following parameters:
22495 @table @asis
22496 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
22497 The pam-krb5 package to use.
22498
22499 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
22500 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
22501 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
22502 @end table
22503 @end deftp
22504
22505
22506 @node LDAP Services
22507 @subsection LDAP Services
22508 @cindex LDAP
22509 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
22510
22511 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
22512 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
22513 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
22514 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
22515 Switch} for detailed information.
22516
22517 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
22518 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
22519 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
22520
22521 @lisp
22522 (use-service-modules authentication)
22523 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
22524 ...
22525 (operating-system
22526 ...
22527 (services
22528 (cons*
22529 (service nslcd-service-type)
22530 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
22531 %base-services))
22532 (name-service-switch
22533 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
22534 (name-service (name "files"))
22535 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
22536 (name-service-switch
22537 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
22538 (password services)
22539 (shadow services)
22540 (group services)
22541 (netgroup services)
22542 (gshadow services)))))
22543 @end lisp
22544
22545 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
22546
22547 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
22548
22549 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
22550 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
22551
22552 @end deftypevr
22553
22554 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
22555 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
22556 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
22557 The default is to start 5 threads.
22558
22559 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22560
22561 @end deftypevr
22562
22563 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
22564 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
22565
22566 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
22567
22568 @end deftypevr
22569
22570 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
22571 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
22572
22573 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
22574
22575 @end deftypevr
22576
22577 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
22578 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
22579 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
22580 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
22581 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
22582 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
22583 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
22584 specified log level or higher are logged.
22585
22586 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
22587
22588 @end deftypevr
22589
22590 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
22591 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
22592 used with the following servers as fall-back.
22593
22594 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
22595
22596 @end deftypevr
22597
22598 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
22599 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
22600 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
22601
22602 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22603
22604 @end deftypevr
22605
22606 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
22607 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
22608 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
22609
22610 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22611
22612 @end deftypevr
22613
22614 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
22615 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
22616 applicable when used with binddn.
22617
22618 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
22623 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
22624 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
22625
22626 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22627
22628 @end deftypevr
22629
22630 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
22631 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
22632 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
22633 rootpwmoddn
22634
22635 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22636
22637 @end deftypevr
22638
22639 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
22640 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
22641 authentication.
22642
22643 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22644
22645 @end deftypevr
22646
22647 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
22648 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
22649
22650 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22651
22652 @end deftypevr
22653
22654 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
22655 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
22656 authentication.
22657
22658 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22659
22660 @end deftypevr
22661
22662 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
22663 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
22664 authentication.
22665
22666 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22667
22668 @end deftypevr
22669
22670 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
22671 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
22672 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
22673 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
22674 performed or not.
22675
22676 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22677
22678 @end deftypevr
22679
22680 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
22681 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
22682
22683 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22684
22685 @end deftypevr
22686
22687 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
22688 The directory search base.
22689
22690 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
22691
22692 @end deftypevr
22693
22694 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
22695 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
22696 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
22697 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
22698
22699 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
22700
22701 @end deftypevr
22702
22703 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
22704 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
22705 to never dereference aliases.
22706
22707 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22708
22709 @end deftypevr
22710
22711 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
22712 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
22713 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
22714
22715 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22716
22717 @end deftypevr
22718
22719 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
22720 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
22721 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
22722 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
22723 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
22724
22725 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22726
22727 @end deftypevr
22728
22729 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
22730 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
22731 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
22732
22733 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22734
22735 @end deftypevr
22736
22737 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
22738 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
22739 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
22740
22741 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22742
22743 @end deftypevr
22744
22745 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
22746 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
22747 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
22748 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
22749
22750 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22751
22752 @end deftypevr
22753
22754 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
22755 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
22756 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
22757 out connections.
22758
22759 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22760
22761 @end deftypevr
22762
22763 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
22764 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
22765 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
22766 failure and the first retry.
22767
22768 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22769
22770 @end deftypevr
22771
22772 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
22773 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
22774 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
22775 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
22776
22777 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22778
22779 @end deftypevr
22780
22781 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
22782 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
22783 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
22784 SSL.
22785
22786 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22787
22788 @end deftypevr
22789
22790 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
22791 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
22792 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
22793
22794 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22795
22796 @end deftypevr
22797
22798 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
22799 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
22800 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
22801
22802 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22803
22804 @end deftypevr
22805
22806 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
22807 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
22808
22809 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22810
22811 @end deftypevr
22812
22813 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
22814 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
22815 using GnuTLS.
22816
22817 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22818
22819 @end deftypevr
22820
22821 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
22822 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
22823
22824 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22825
22826 @end deftypevr
22827
22828 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
22829 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
22830 client TLS authentication.
22831
22832 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22833
22834 @end deftypevr
22835
22836 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
22837 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
22838 authentication.
22839
22840 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22841
22842 @end deftypevr
22843
22844 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
22845 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
22846 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
22847 request paged results.
22848
22849 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22850
22851 @end deftypevr
22852
22853 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
22854 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
22855 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
22856 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
22857
22858 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22859
22860 @end deftypevr
22861
22862 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
22863 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
22864 the specified value are ignored.
22865
22866 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22867
22868 @end deftypevr
22869
22870 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
22871 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
22872 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
22873
22874 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22875
22876 @end deftypevr
22877
22878 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
22879 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
22880 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
22881
22882 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22883
22884 @end deftypevr
22885
22886 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
22887 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
22888 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
22889 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
22890 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
22891 groups.
22892
22893 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22894
22895 @end deftypevr
22896
22897 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
22898 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
22899 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
22900 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
22901 groups assigned on login.
22902
22903 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22904
22905 @end deftypevr
22906
22907 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
22908 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
22909 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
22910 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
22911 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
22912 most configurations.
22913
22914 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22915
22916 @end deftypevr
22917
22918 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
22919 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
22920 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
22921 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
22922
22923 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22924
22925 @end deftypevr
22926
22927 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
22928 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
22929 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
22930 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
22931 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
22932
22933 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22934
22935 @end deftypevr
22936
22937 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
22938 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
22939 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
22940
22941 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22942
22943 @end deftypevr
22944
22945 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
22946 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
22947 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
22948 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
22949 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
22950 It should return at least one entry.
22951
22952 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22953
22954 @end deftypevr
22955
22956 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
22957 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
22958 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
22959 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
22960
22961 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22962
22963 @end deftypevr
22964
22965 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
22966 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
22967 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
22968 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
22969 changing their password.
22970
22971 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22972
22973 @end deftypevr
22974
22975 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
22976 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
22977
22978 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22979
22980 @end deftypevr
22981
22982 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
22983
22984
22985 @node Web Services
22986 @subsection Web Services
22987
22988 @cindex web
22989 @cindex www
22990 @cindex HTTP
22991 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
22992 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
22993
22994 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
22995
22996 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
22997 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
22998 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
22999 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
23000
23001 A simple example configuration is given below.
23002
23003 @lisp
23004 (service httpd-service-type
23005 (httpd-configuration
23006 (config
23007 (httpd-config-file
23008 (server-name "www.example.com")
23009 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
23010 @end lisp
23011
23012 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
23013 the configuration.
23014
23015 @lisp
23016 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
23017 (list
23018 (httpd-virtualhost
23019 "*:80"
23020 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
23021 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
23022 "\n")))))
23023 @end lisp
23024 @end deffn
23025
23026 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
23027 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
23028 given below.
23029
23030 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
23031 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
23032
23033 @table @asis
23034 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
23035 The httpd package to use.
23036
23037 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
23038 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
23039
23040 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
23041 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
23042 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
23043 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
23044 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
23045
23046 @end table
23047 @end deffn
23048
23049 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
23050 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
23051
23052 @table @asis
23053 @item @code{name}
23054 The name of the module.
23055
23056 @item @code{file}
23057 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
23058 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
23059 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
23060 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
23061
23062 @end table
23063 @end deffn
23064
23065 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
23066 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
23067 @end defvr
23068
23069 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
23070 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
23071
23072 @table @asis
23073 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
23074 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
23075 additional configuration.
23076
23077 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
23078 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
23079
23080 @lisp
23081 (service httpd-service-type
23082 (httpd-configuration
23083 (config
23084 (httpd-config-file
23085 (modules (cons*
23086 (httpd-module
23087 (name "proxy_module")
23088 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
23089 (httpd-module
23090 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
23091 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
23092 %default-httpd-modules))
23093 (extra-config (list "\
23094 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
23095 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
23096 </FilesMatch>"))))))
23097 (service php-fpm-service-type
23098 (php-fpm-configuration
23099 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
23100 (socket-group "httpd")))
23101 @end lisp
23102
23103 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
23104 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
23105 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
23106 taken as relative to the server root.
23107
23108 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
23109 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
23110 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
23111 itself.
23112
23113 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
23114 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
23115 @code{ServerName}.
23116
23117 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
23118 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
23119
23120 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
23121 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
23122 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
23123 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
23124 protocol to use.
23125
23126 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
23127 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
23128 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
23129 configured correctly.
23130
23131 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
23132 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
23133
23134 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
23135 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
23136
23137 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
23138 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
23139
23140 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
23141 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
23142 of the configuration file.
23143
23144 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
23145 list.
23146
23147 @end table
23148 @end deffn
23149
23150 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
23151 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
23152
23153 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
23154
23155 @lisp
23156 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
23157 (list
23158 (httpd-virtualhost
23159 "*:80"
23160 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
23161 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
23162 "\n")))))
23163 @end lisp
23164
23165 @table @asis
23166 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
23167 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
23168
23169 @item @code{contents}
23170 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
23171 of strings and G-expressions.
23172
23173 @end table
23174 @end deffn
23175
23176 @subsubheading NGINX
23177
23178 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
23179 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
23180 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
23181
23182 A simple example configuration is given below.
23183
23184 @lisp
23185 (service nginx-service-type
23186 (nginx-configuration
23187 (server-blocks
23188 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23189 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23190 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
23191 @end lisp
23192
23193 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
23194 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
23195 blocks, as in this example:
23196
23197 @lisp
23198 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
23199 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23200 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
23201 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
23202 @end lisp
23203 @end deffn
23204
23205 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
23206 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
23207 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
23208 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
23209 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
23210 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
23211 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
23212 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
23213
23214 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
23215 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
23216 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
23217 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
23218
23219 @table @asis
23220 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
23221 The nginx package to use.
23222
23223 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
23224 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
23225
23226 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
23227 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
23228 files.
23229
23230 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
23231 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
23232 file, the elements should be of type
23233 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
23234
23235 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
23236 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
23237 HTTPS.
23238 @lisp
23239 (service nginx-service-type
23240 (nginx-configuration
23241 (server-blocks
23242 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23243 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23244 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
23245 @end lisp
23246
23247 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
23248 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
23249 file, the elements should be of type
23250 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
23251
23252 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
23253 when combined with @code{locations} in the
23254 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
23255 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
23256 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
23257 requests with two servers.
23258
23259 @lisp
23260 (service
23261 nginx-service-type
23262 (nginx-configuration
23263 (server-blocks
23264 (list (nginx-server-configuration
23265 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
23266 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
23267 (locations
23268 (list
23269 (nginx-location-configuration
23270 (uri "/path1")
23271 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
23272 (upstream-blocks
23273 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
23274 (name "server-proxy")
23275 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
23276 "server2.example.com")))))))
23277 @end lisp
23278
23279 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
23280 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
23281 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
23282 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
23283 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
23284 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
23285
23286 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
23287 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
23288 nginx-configuration record.
23289
23290 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
23291 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
23292 use the size of the processors cache line.
23293
23294 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
23295 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
23296
23297 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
23298 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
23299 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
23300
23301 @lisp
23302 (modules
23303 (list
23304 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
23305 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
23306 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
23307 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
23308 @end lisp
23309
23310 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
23311 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
23312 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
23313
23314 @lisp
23315 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
23316 lua-resty-lrucache
23317 lua-resty-signal
23318 lua-tablepool
23319 lua-resty-shell))
23320 @end lisp
23321
23322 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
23323 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
23324 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
23325
23326 @lisp
23327 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
23328 @end lisp
23329
23330 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
23331 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
23332 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
23333
23334 @lisp
23335 (global-directives
23336 `((worker_processes . 16)
23337 (pcre_jit . on)
23338 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
23339 @end lisp
23340
23341 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
23342 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
23343 valued G-expression.
23344
23345 @end table
23346 @end deffn
23347
23348 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
23349 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
23350 This type has the following parameters:
23351
23352 @table @asis
23353 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
23354 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
23355 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
23356 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
23357 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
23358
23359 @lisp
23360 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
23361 @end lisp
23362
23363 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
23364 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
23365 default server for connections matching no other server.
23366
23367 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
23368 Root of the website nginx will serve.
23369
23370 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
23371 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
23372 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
23373 server block.
23374
23375 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
23376 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
23377 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
23378
23379 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
23380 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
23381 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
23382
23383 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
23384 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
23385 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
23386
23387 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
23388 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
23389 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
23390
23391 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
23392 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
23393
23394 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
23395 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
23396
23397 @end table
23398 @end deftp
23399
23400 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
23401 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
23402 block. This type has the following parameters:
23403
23404 @table @asis
23405 @item @code{name}
23406 Name for this group of servers.
23407
23408 @item @code{servers}
23409 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
23410 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
23411 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
23412 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
23413 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
23414 explicitly.
23415
23416 @end table
23417 @end deftp
23418
23419 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
23420 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
23421 block. This type has the following parameters:
23422
23423 @table @asis
23424 @item @code{uri}
23425 URI which this location block matches.
23426
23427 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
23428 @item @code{body}
23429 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
23430 many
23431 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
23432 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
23433 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
23434 http://upstream-name;")}.
23435
23436 @end table
23437 @end deftp
23438
23439 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
23440 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
23441 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
23442 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
23443 parameters:
23444
23445 @table @asis
23446 @item @code{name}
23447 Name to identify this location block.
23448
23449 @item @code{body}
23450 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
23451 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
23452 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
23453 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
23454
23455 @end table
23456 @end deftp
23457
23458 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
23459 @cindex Varnish
23460 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
23461 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
23462 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
23463 creates one request to the back-end.
23464
23465 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
23466 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
23467 @end defvr
23468
23469 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
23470 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
23471 This type has the following parameters:
23472
23473 @table @asis
23474 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
23475 The Varnish package to use.
23476
23477 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
23478 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
23479 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
23480 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
23481 directory name.
23482
23483 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
23484 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
23485
23486 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23487 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
23488
23489 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
23490 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
23491 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
23492 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
23493 VCL syntax.
23494
23495 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
23496 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
23497 can do something along these lines:
23498
23499 @lisp
23500 (define %gnu-mirror
23501 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
23502 "vcl 4.1;
23503 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
23504
23505 (operating-system
23506 ;; @dots{}
23507 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
23508 (varnish-configuration
23509 (listen '(":80"))
23510 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
23511 %base-services)))
23512 @end lisp
23513
23514 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
23515 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
23516
23517 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
23518 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
23519 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
23520
23521 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
23522 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
23523
23524 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
23525 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
23526
23527 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
23528 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
23529
23530 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23531 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
23532
23533 @end table
23534 @end deftp
23535
23536 @subsubheading Patchwork
23537 @cindex Patchwork
23538 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
23539 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
23540
23541 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
23542 Service type for Patchwork.
23543 @end defvr
23544
23545 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
23546 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
23547
23548 @lisp
23549 (service patchwork-service-type
23550 (patchwork-configuration
23551 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
23552 (settings-module
23553 (patchwork-settings-module
23554 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
23555 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
23556 (getmail-retriever-config
23557 (getmail-retriever-configuration
23558 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
23559 (server "imap.example.com")
23560 (port 993)
23561 (username "patchwork")
23562 (password-command
23563 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
23564 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
23565 (extra-parameters
23566 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
23567
23568 @end lisp
23569
23570 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
23571 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
23572 within the HTTPD service.
23573
23574 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
23575 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
23576 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
23577
23578 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
23579 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
23580 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
23581
23582 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
23583 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
23584 following parameters:
23585
23586 @table @asis
23587 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
23588 The Patchwork package to use.
23589
23590 @item @code{domain}
23591 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
23592 host.
23593
23594 @item @code{settings-module}
23595 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
23596 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
23597 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
23598 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
23599 store.
23600
23601 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
23602 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
23603
23604 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
23605 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
23606 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
23607 delivered to Patchwork.
23608
23609 @end table
23610 @end deftp
23611
23612 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
23613 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
23614 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
23615 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
23616 has the following parameters:
23617
23618 @table @asis
23619 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
23620 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
23621 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
23622
23623 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
23624 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
23625 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
23626
23627 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
23628 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
23629
23630 This setting relates to Django.
23631
23632 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
23633 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
23634 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
23635
23636 This is a Django setting.
23637
23638 @item @code{default-from-email}
23639 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
23640
23641 This is a Patchwork setting.
23642
23643 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
23644 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
23645 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
23646
23647 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
23648 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
23649
23650 This is a Django setting.
23651
23652 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
23653 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
23654 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
23655
23656 This is a Django setting.
23657
23658 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23659 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
23660 messages will be shown.
23661
23662 This is a Django setting.
23663
23664 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
23665 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
23666
23667 This is a Patchwork setting.
23668
23669 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
23670 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
23671
23672 This is a Patchwork setting.
23673
23674 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
23675 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
23676
23677 This is a Patchwork setting.
23678
23679 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
23680 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
23681
23682 @end table
23683 @end deftp
23684
23685 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
23686 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
23687
23688 @table @asis
23689 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
23690 The database engine to use.
23691
23692 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
23693 The name of the database to use.
23694
23695 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
23696 The user to connect to the database as.
23697
23698 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
23699 The password to use when connecting to the database.
23700
23701 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
23702 The host to make the database connection to.
23703
23704 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
23705 The port on which to connect to the database.
23706
23707 @end table
23708 @end deftp
23709
23710 @subsubheading Mumi
23711
23712 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
23713 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
23714 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
23715 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
23716 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
23717 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
23718
23719 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
23720 This is the service type for Mumi.
23721 @end defvr
23722
23723 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
23724 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
23725 following fields:
23726
23727 @table @asis
23728 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
23729 The Mumi package to use.
23730
23731 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
23732 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
23733
23734 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
23735 The email address used as the sender for comments.
23736
23737 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
23738 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
23739 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
23740 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
23741 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
23742
23743 @end table
23744 @end deftp
23745
23746
23747 @subsubheading FastCGI
23748 @cindex fastcgi
23749 @cindex fcgiwrap
23750 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
23751 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
23752 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
23753 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
23754 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
23755 support for it in Guix.
23756
23757 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
23758 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
23759 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
23760 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
23761 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
23762 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
23763
23764 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
23765 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
23766 @end defvr
23767
23768 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
23769 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
23770 This type has the following parameters:
23771 @table @asis
23772 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
23773 The fcgiwrap package to use.
23774
23775 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
23776 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
23777 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
23778 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
23779 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
23780 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
23781
23782 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
23783 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
23784 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
23785 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
23786 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
23787 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
23788
23789 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
23790 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
23791 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
23792 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
23793 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
23794 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
23795 @end table
23796 @end deftp
23797
23798 @cindex php-fpm
23799 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
23800 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
23801
23802 These features include:
23803 @itemize @bullet
23804 @item Adaptive process spawning
23805 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
23806 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
23807 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
23808 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
23809 @item Stdout & stderr logging
23810 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
23811 @item Accelerated upload support
23812 @item Support for a "slowlog"
23813 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
23814 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
23815 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
23816 @end itemize
23817 ...@: and much more.
23818
23819 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
23820 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
23821 @end defvr
23822
23823 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
23824 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
23825 @table @asis
23826 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
23827 The php package to use.
23828 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
23829 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
23830 @table @asis
23831 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
23832 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
23833 @item @code{"port"}
23834 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
23835 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
23836 Listen on a unix socket.
23837 @end table
23838
23839 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
23840 User who will own the php worker processes.
23841 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
23842 Group of the worker processes.
23843 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
23844 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
23845 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
23846 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
23847 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
23848 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
23849 once the service has started.
23850 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
23851 Log for the php-fpm master process.
23852 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
23853 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
23854 Must be one of:
23855 @table @asis
23856 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
23857 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
23858 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
23859 @end table
23860 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
23861 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
23862 and displayed in their browsers.
23863 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
23864 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
23865 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
23866 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
23867 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
23868 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
23869 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
23870 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
23871 An optional override of the whole configuration.
23872 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
23873 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
23874 An optional override of the default php settings.
23875 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
23876 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
23877
23878 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
23879 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
23880 following operating system configuration snippet:
23881 @lisp
23882 (define %local-php-ini
23883 (plain-file "php.ini"
23884 "memory_limit = 2G
23885 max_execution_time = 1800"))
23886
23887 (operating-system
23888 ;; @dots{}
23889 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
23890 (php-fpm-configuration
23891 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
23892 %base-services)))
23893 @end lisp
23894
23895 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
23896 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
23897 @file{php.ini} directives.
23898 @end table
23899 @end deftp
23900
23901 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
23902 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
23903 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
23904 based on it's configured limits.
23905 @table @asis
23906 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
23907 Maximum of worker processes.
23908 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
23909 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
23910 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
23911 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
23912 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
23913 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
23914 @end table
23915 @end deftp
23916
23917 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
23918 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
23919 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
23920 are created.
23921 @table @asis
23922 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
23923 Maximum of worker processes.
23924 @end table
23925 @end deftp
23926
23927 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
23928 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
23929 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
23930 requests arrive.
23931 @table @asis
23932 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
23933 Maximum of worker processes.
23934 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
23935 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
23936 @end table
23937 @end deftp
23938
23939
23940 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
23941 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
23942 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
23943 (version-major (package-version php)) @
23944 "-fpm.sock")]
23945 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
23946 @end deffn
23947
23948 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
23949 @lisp
23950 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
23951 (service php-fpm-service-type)
23952 (service nginx-service-type
23953 (nginx-server-configuration
23954 (server-name '("example.com"))
23955 (root "/srv/http/")
23956 (locations
23957 (list (nginx-php-location)))
23958 (listen '("80"))
23959 (ssl-certificate #f)
23960 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
23961 %base-services))
23962 @end lisp
23963
23964 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
23965 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
23966 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
23967 the hash of a user's email address.
23968
23969 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
23970 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
23971 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
23972 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
23973 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
23974 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
23975 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
23976 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
23977 @end deffn
23978
23979 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
23980 @lisp
23981 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
23982 #:configuration
23983 (nginx-server-configuration
23984 (server-name '("example.com"))))
23985 ...
23986 %base-services))
23987 @end lisp
23988
23989 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
23990
23991 @cindex hpcguix-web
23992 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
23993 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
23994 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
23995 clusters.
23996
23997 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
23998 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
23999 @end defvr
24000
24001 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
24002 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
24003
24004 @table @asis
24005 @item @code{specs}
24006 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
24007 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
24008
24009 @table @asis
24010 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
24011 The page title prefix.
24012
24013 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
24014 The @command{guix} command.
24015
24016 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
24017 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
24018
24019 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
24020 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
24021
24022 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
24023 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
24024
24025 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
24026 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
24027
24028 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
24029 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
24030 the latest instances of the given channels.
24031 @end table
24032
24033 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
24034 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
24035 complete example}.
24036
24037 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
24038 The hpcguix-web package to use.
24039 @end table
24040 @end deftp
24041
24042 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
24043
24044 @lisp
24045 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
24046 (hpcguix-web-configuration
24047 (specs
24048 #~(define site-config
24049 (hpcweb-configuration
24050 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
24051 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
24052 @end lisp
24053
24054 @quotation Note
24055 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
24056 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
24057 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
24058 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
24059
24060 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
24061 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
24062 more information on X.509 certificates.
24063 @end quotation
24064
24065 @subsubheading gmnisrv
24066
24067 @cindex gmnisrv
24068 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
24069 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
24070
24071 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
24072 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
24073 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
24074
24075 @lisp
24076 (service gmnisrv-service-type
24077 (gmnisrv-configuration
24078 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
24079 @end lisp
24080 @end deffn
24081
24082 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
24083 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
24084
24085 @table @asis
24086 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
24087 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
24088
24089 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
24090 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
24091 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
24092 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
24093 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
24094 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
24095
24096 @end table
24097 @end deftp
24098
24099 @node Certificate Services
24100 @subsection Certificate Services
24101
24102 @cindex Web
24103 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
24104 @cindex Let's Encrypt
24105 @cindex TLS certificates
24106 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
24107 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
24108 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
24109 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
24110 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
24111 authenticity.
24112
24113 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
24114 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
24115 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
24116 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
24117 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
24118 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
24119 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
24120 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
24121 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
24122 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
24123 signature.
24124
24125 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
24126 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
24127 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
24128 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
24129 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
24130 with different permissions).
24131
24132 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
24133 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
24134 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
24135 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
24136 some reason.
24137
24138 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
24139 can be found there:
24140 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
24141
24142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
24143 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
24144 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
24145
24146 @lisp
24147 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
24148 (program-file
24149 "nginx-deploy-hook"
24150 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
24151 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
24152
24153 (service certbot-service-type
24154 (certbot-configuration
24155 (email "foo@@example.net")
24156 (certificates
24157 (list
24158 (certificate-configuration
24159 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
24160 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
24161 (certificate-configuration
24162 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
24163 @end lisp
24164
24165 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
24166 @end defvr
24167
24168 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
24169 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
24170 This type has the following parameters:
24171
24172 @table @asis
24173 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
24174 The certbot package to use.
24175
24176 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
24177 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
24178 files.
24179
24180 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
24181 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
24182 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
24183 and several @code{domains}.
24184
24185 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
24186 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
24187 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
24188 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
24189
24190 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
24191 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
24192 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
24193
24194 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
24195 Size of the RSA key.
24196
24197 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
24198 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
24199 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
24200 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
24201 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
24202 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
24203 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
24204 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
24205 these nginx configuration data types.
24206
24207 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
24208 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
24209 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
24210
24211 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
24212 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
24213 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
24214
24215 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
24216 @end table
24217 @end deftp
24218
24219 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
24220 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
24221 This type has the following parameters:
24222
24223 @table @asis
24224 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
24225 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
24226 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
24227 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
24228
24229 Its default is the first provided domain.
24230
24231 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
24232 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
24233 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
24234
24235 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
24236 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
24237 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
24238 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
24239 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
24240 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
24241 requesting machine.
24242
24243 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24244 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
24245 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
24246 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
24247 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
24248 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
24249
24250 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24251 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
24252 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
24253 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
24254 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
24255 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
24256
24257 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
24258 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
24259 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
24260 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
24261 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
24262 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
24263 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
24264 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
24265
24266 @end table
24267 @end deftp
24268
24269 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
24270 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
24271 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
24272 @node DNS Services
24273 @subsection DNS Services
24274 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
24275 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
24276
24277 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
24278 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
24279 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
24280 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
24281 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
24282 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
24283
24284 @subsubheading Knot Service
24285
24286 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
24287 and one slave, is:
24288
24289 @lisp
24290 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
24291 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
24292 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
24293 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
24294 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
24295
24296 (define master-zone
24297 (knot-zone-configuration
24298 (domain "example.org")
24299 (zone (zone-file
24300 (origin "example.org")
24301 (entries example.org.zone)))))
24302
24303 (define slave-zone
24304 (knot-zone-configuration
24305 (domain "plop.org")
24306 (dnssec-policy "default")
24307 (master (list "plop-master"))))
24308
24309 (define plop-master
24310 (knot-remote-configuration
24311 (id "plop-master")
24312 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
24313
24314 (operating-system
24315 ;; ...
24316 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
24317 (knot-configuration
24318 (remotes (list plop-master))
24319 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
24320 ;; ...
24321 %base-services)))
24322 @end lisp
24323
24324 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
24325 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
24326
24327 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
24328 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
24329 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
24330 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
24331 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
24332 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
24333 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
24334
24335 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
24336 @end deffn
24337
24338 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
24339 Data type representing a key.
24340 This type has the following parameters:
24341
24342 @table @asis
24343 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24344 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
24345 be unique and must not be empty.
24346
24347 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
24348 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
24349 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
24350 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
24351
24352 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
24353 The secret key itself.
24354
24355 @end table
24356 @end deftp
24357
24358 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
24359 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
24360 This type has the following parameters:
24361
24362 @table @asis
24363 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24364 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
24365 unique and must not be empty.
24366
24367 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
24368 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
24369 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
24370 address match is not required.
24371
24372 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
24373 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
24374 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
24375 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
24376
24377 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
24378 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
24379 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
24380 and @code{'update}.
24381
24382 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
24383 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
24384 false, listed actions are allowed.
24385
24386 @end table
24387 @end deftp
24388
24389 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
24390 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
24391 This type has the following parameters:
24392
24393 @table @asis
24394 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
24395 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
24396 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
24397 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
24398 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
24399 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
24400
24401 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
24402 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
24403
24404 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
24405 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
24406 partially @code{"CH"}.
24407
24408 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
24409 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
24410 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
24411 defined.
24412
24413 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
24414 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
24415 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
24416 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
24417
24418 @end table
24419 @end deftp
24420
24421 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
24422 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
24423 This type has the following parameters:
24424
24425 @table @asis
24426 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
24427 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
24428 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
24429 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
24430 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
24431 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
24432 field of the @code{zone-file}.
24433
24434 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
24435 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
24436
24437 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
24438 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
24439 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
24440 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
24441 to an IP address in the list of entries.
24442
24443 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
24444 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
24445 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
24446
24447 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
24448 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
24449 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
24450 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
24451
24452 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
24453 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
24454 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
24455 @code{(string->duration)}.
24456
24457 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
24458 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
24459 to do so a first time.
24460
24461 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
24462 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
24463 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
24464 and check again that it still exists.
24465
24466 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
24467 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
24468 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
24469
24470 @end table
24471 @end deftp
24472
24473 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
24474 Data type representing a remote configuration.
24475 This type has the following parameters:
24476
24477 @table @asis
24478 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24479 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
24480 be unique and must not be empty.
24481
24482 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
24483 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
24484 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
24485 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
24486
24487 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
24488 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
24489 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
24490 The default is to choose at random.
24491
24492 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
24493 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
24494 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
24495
24496 @end table
24497 @end deftp
24498
24499 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
24500 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
24501 This type has the following parameters:
24502
24503 @table @asis
24504 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24505 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
24506
24507 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
24508 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
24509
24510 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
24511 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
24512 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
24513 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
24514
24515 @end table
24516 @end deftp
24517
24518 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
24519 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
24520 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
24521 use keys that you generate.
24522
24523 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
24524 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
24525 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
24526 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
24527 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
24528 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
24529
24530 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
24531 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
24532 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
24533 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
24534 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
24535
24536 This type has the following parameters:
24537
24538 @table @asis
24539 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
24540 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
24541
24542 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
24543 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
24544 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
24545 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
24546 was setup by this service).
24547
24548 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
24549 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
24550
24551 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
24552 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
24553
24554 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
24555 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
24556
24557 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
24558 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
24559 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
24560
24561 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
24562 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
24563 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
24564
24565 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
24566 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
24567 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
24568
24569 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
24570 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
24571
24572 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
24573 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
24574 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
24575
24576 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
24577 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
24578
24579 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
24580 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
24581
24582 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
24583 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
24584
24585 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
24586 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
24587
24588 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
24589 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
24590 name before hashing.
24591
24592 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
24593 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
24594
24595 @end table
24596 @end deftp
24597
24598 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
24599 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
24600 This type has the following parameters:
24601
24602 @table @asis
24603 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
24604 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
24605
24606 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
24607 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
24608 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
24609
24610 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
24611 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
24612 must contain a zone-file record.
24613
24614 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
24615 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
24616 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
24617
24618 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
24619 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
24620 masters.
24621
24622 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
24623 A list of slave remote identifiers.
24624
24625 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
24626 A list of acl identifiers.
24627
24628 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
24629 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
24630
24631 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
24632 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
24633
24634 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
24635 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
24636 synchronization.
24637
24638 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
24639 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
24640 are:
24641
24642 @itemize
24643 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
24644 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
24645 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
24646 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
24647 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
24648 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
24649 automatically.
24650 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
24651 @end itemize
24652
24653 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
24654 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
24655 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
24656 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
24657 default value from Knot is used.
24658
24659 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
24660 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
24661 so the default value from Knot is used.
24662
24663 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
24664 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
24665 default value from Knot is used.
24666
24667 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
24668 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
24669 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
24670 value from Knot is used.
24671
24672 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
24673 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
24674 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
24675 on this zone.
24676
24677 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
24678 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
24679
24680 @end table
24681 @end deftp
24682
24683 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
24684 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
24685 This type has the following parameters:
24686
24687 @table @asis
24688 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
24689 The Knot package.
24690
24691 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
24692 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
24693
24694 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
24695 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
24696 included at the top of the configuration file.
24697
24698 @cindex secrets, Knot service
24699 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
24700 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
24701 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
24702 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
24703 to the @code{includes} list.
24704
24705 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
24706 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
24707 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
24708 tsig key:
24709
24710 @example
24711 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
24712 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
24713 @end example
24714
24715 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
24716 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
24717 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
24718 to that key.
24719
24720 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
24721
24722 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
24723 An ip address on which to listen.
24724
24725 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
24726 An ip address on which to listen.
24727
24728 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
24729 A port on which to listen.
24730
24731 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
24732 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
24733
24734 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
24735 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
24736
24737 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
24738 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
24739
24740 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
24741 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
24742
24743 @end table
24744 @end deftp
24745
24746 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
24747
24748 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
24749 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
24750 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
24751
24752 @lisp
24753 (service knot-resolver-service-type
24754 (knot-resolver-configuration
24755 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
24756 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
24757 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
24758 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
24759 cache.size = 100 * MB
24760 "))))
24761 @end lisp
24762
24763 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
24764 @end deffn
24765
24766 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
24767 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
24768
24769 @table @asis
24770 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
24771 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
24772
24773 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
24774 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
24775 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
24776
24777 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
24778 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
24779
24780 @end table
24781 @end deftp
24782
24783
24784 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
24785
24786 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
24787 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
24788 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
24789
24790 @lisp
24791 (service dnsmasq-service-type
24792 (dnsmasq-configuration
24793 (no-resolv? #t)
24794 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
24795 @end lisp
24796 @end deffn
24797
24798 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
24799 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
24800
24801 @table @asis
24802 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
24803 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
24804
24805 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
24806 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
24807
24808 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
24809 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
24810 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
24811
24812 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
24813 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
24814 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
24815
24816 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
24817 Listen on the given IP addresses.
24818
24819 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
24820 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
24821
24822 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
24823 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
24824
24825 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
24826 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
24827
24828 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
24829 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
24830 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
24831 replied to with the specified IP address.
24832
24833 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
24834
24835 @lisp
24836 (service dnsmasq-service-type
24837 (dnsmasq-configuration
24838 (addresses
24839 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
24840 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
24841 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
24842 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
24843 @end lisp
24844
24845 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
24846
24847 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
24848 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
24849 disables caching.
24850
24851 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
24852 When false, disable negative caching.
24853
24854 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
24855 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
24856
24857 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
24858 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
24859
24860 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
24861 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
24862
24863 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
24864 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
24865
24866 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
24867 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
24868 world-readable bit set are accessible.
24869
24870 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
24871 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
24872
24873 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
24874 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
24875
24876 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
24877 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
24878
24879 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
24880 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
24881
24882 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
24883 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
24884 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
24885
24886 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
24887 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
24888 When this is set, TFTP paths which include ".." are rejected, to stop clients
24889 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with /) are
24890 allowed, but they must be within the tftp-root. If the optional interface
24891 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
24892 interface.
24893
24894 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
24895 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
24896 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
24897 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
24898 format).
24899
24900 For instance, if --tftp-root is "/tftp" and client 1.2.3.4 requests file
24901 "myfile" then the effective path will be "/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile" if
24902 /tftp/1.2.3.4 exists or /tftp/myfile otherwise. When "=mac" is specified
24903 it will append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
24904 separated by dashes, e.g.: 01-02-03-04-aa-bb Note that resolving MAC
24905 addresses is only possible if the client is in the local network or obtained
24906 a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
24907
24908 @end table
24909 @end deftp
24910
24911 @subsubheading ddclient Service
24912
24913 @cindex ddclient
24914 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
24915 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
24916 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
24917
24918 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
24919 configuration:
24920
24921 @lisp
24922 (service ddclient-service-type)
24923 @end lisp
24924
24925 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
24926 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
24927 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
24928 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
24929 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
24930 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
24931 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
24932
24933 @c %start of fragment
24934
24935 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
24936
24937 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
24938 The ddclient package.
24939
24940 @end deftypevr
24941
24942 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
24943 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
24944
24945 Defaults to @samp{300}.
24946
24947 @end deftypevr
24948
24949 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
24950 Use syslog for the output.
24951
24952 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24953
24954 @end deftypevr
24955
24956 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
24957 Mail to user.
24958
24959 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
24960
24961 @end deftypevr
24962
24963 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
24964 Mail failed update to user.
24965
24966 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
24967
24968 @end deftypevr
24969
24970 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
24971 The ddclient PID file.
24972
24973 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
24974
24975 @end deftypevr
24976
24977 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
24978 Enable SSL support.
24979
24980 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24981
24982 @end deftypevr
24983
24984 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
24985 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
24986 program.
24987
24988 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
24989
24990 @end deftypevr
24991
24992 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
24993 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
24994
24995 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
24996
24997 @end deftypevr
24998
24999 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
25000 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
25001 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
25002 create it manually.
25003
25004 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
25005
25006 @end deftypevr
25007
25008 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
25009 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
25010
25011 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25012
25013 @end deftypevr
25014
25015
25016 @c %end of fragment
25017
25018
25019 @node VPN Services
25020 @subsection VPN Services
25021 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
25022 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
25023
25024 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
25025 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
25026 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
25027 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
25028
25029 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
25030 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
25031
25032 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
25033 @end deffn
25034
25035 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
25036 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
25037
25038 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
25039
25040 Both can be run simultaneously.
25041 @end deffn
25042
25043 @c %automatically generated documentation
25044
25045 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
25046
25047 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
25048 The OpenVPN package.
25049
25050 @end deftypevr
25051
25052 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
25053 The OpenVPN pid file.
25054
25055 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
25056
25057 @end deftypevr
25058
25059 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
25060 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
25061 servers.
25062
25063 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
25064
25065 @end deftypevr
25066
25067 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
25068 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
25069
25070 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
25071
25072 @end deftypevr
25073
25074 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
25075 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
25076 it to @code{'disabled}.
25077
25078 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
25079 The certificate authority to check connections against.
25080
25081 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
25082
25083 @end deftypevr
25084
25085 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
25086 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
25087 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
25088
25089 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
25090
25091 @end deftypevr
25092
25093 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
25094 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
25095 certificate is @code{cert}.
25096
25097 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
25098
25099 @end deftypevr
25100
25101 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
25102 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
25103
25104 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25105
25106 @end deftypevr
25107
25108 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
25109 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
25110
25111 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25112
25113 @end deftypevr
25114
25115 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
25116 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
25117 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
25118
25119 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25120
25121 @end deftypevr
25122
25123 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
25124 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
25125 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
25126
25127 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25128 @end deftypevr
25129
25130 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
25131 Verbosity level.
25132
25133 Defaults to @samp{3}.
25134
25135 @end deftypevr
25136
25137 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
25138 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
25139 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
25140
25141 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25142
25143 @end deftypevr
25144
25145 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
25146 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
25147 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
25148 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
25149
25150 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
25151 @end deftypevr
25152
25153 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
25154 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
25155
25156 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25157
25158 @end deftypevr
25159
25160 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
25161 Bind to a specific local port number.
25162
25163 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25164
25165 @end deftypevr
25166
25167 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
25168 Retry resolving server address.
25169
25170 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25171
25172 @end deftypevr
25173
25174 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
25175 A list of remote servers to connect to.
25176
25177 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25178
25179 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
25180
25181 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
25182 Server name.
25183
25184 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
25185
25186 @end deftypevr
25187
25188 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
25189 Port number the server listens to.
25190
25191 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
25192
25193 @end deftypevr
25194
25195 @end deftypevr
25196 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
25197
25198 @c %automatically generated documentation
25199
25200 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
25201
25202 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
25203 The OpenVPN package.
25204
25205 @end deftypevr
25206
25207 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
25208 The OpenVPN pid file.
25209
25210 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
25211
25212 @end deftypevr
25213
25214 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
25215 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
25216 servers.
25217
25218 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
25219
25220 @end deftypevr
25221
25222 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
25223 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
25224
25225 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
25226
25227 @end deftypevr
25228
25229 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
25230 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
25231 it to @code{'disabled}.
25232
25233 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
25234 The certificate authority to check connections against.
25235
25236 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
25237
25238 @end deftypevr
25239
25240 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
25241 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
25242 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
25243
25244 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
25245
25246 @end deftypevr
25247
25248 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
25249 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
25250 certificate is @code{cert}.
25251
25252 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
25253
25254 @end deftypevr
25255
25256 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
25257 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
25258
25259 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25260
25261 @end deftypevr
25262
25263 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
25264 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
25265
25266 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25267
25268 @end deftypevr
25269
25270 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
25271 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
25272 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
25273
25274 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25275
25276 @end deftypevr
25277
25278 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
25279 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
25280 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
25281
25282 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25283 @end deftypevr
25284
25285 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
25286 Verbosity level.
25287
25288 Defaults to @samp{3}.
25289
25290 @end deftypevr
25291
25292 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
25293 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
25294 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
25295
25296 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25297
25298 @end deftypevr
25299
25300 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
25301 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
25302
25303 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
25304
25305 @end deftypevr
25306
25307 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
25308 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
25309
25310 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
25311
25312 @end deftypevr
25313
25314 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
25315 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
25316
25317 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25318
25319 @end deftypevr
25320
25321 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
25322 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
25323
25324 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
25325
25326 @end deftypevr
25327
25328 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
25329 The file that records client IPs.
25330
25331 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
25332
25333 @end deftypevr
25334
25335 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
25336 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
25337
25338 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25339
25340 @end deftypevr
25341
25342 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
25343 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
25344
25345 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25346
25347 @end deftypevr
25348
25349 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
25350 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
25351 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
25352 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
25353 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
25354 down.
25355
25356 @end deftypevr
25357
25358 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
25359 The maximum number of clients.
25360
25361 Defaults to @samp{100}.
25362
25363 @end deftypevr
25364
25365 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
25366 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
25367 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
25368
25369 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
25370
25371 @end deftypevr
25372
25373 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
25374 The list of configuration for some clients.
25375
25376 Defaults to @samp{()}.
25377
25378 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
25379
25380 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
25381 Client name.
25382
25383 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
25384
25385 @end deftypevr
25386
25387 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
25388 Client own network
25389
25390 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25391
25392 @end deftypevr
25393
25394 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
25395 Client VPN IP.
25396
25397 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25398
25399 @end deftypevr
25400
25401 @end deftypevr
25402
25403
25404 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
25405
25406
25407 @node Network File System
25408 @subsection Network File System
25409 @cindex NFS
25410
25411 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
25412 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
25413 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
25414
25415 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
25416 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
25417 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
25418
25419 @subsubheading NFS Service
25420 @cindex NFS, server
25421
25422 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
25423 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
25424 the locations that NFS expects.
25425
25426 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
25427 A service type for a complete NFS server.
25428 @end defvr
25429
25430 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
25431 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
25432 of its subsystems.
25433
25434 It has the following parameters:
25435 @table @asis
25436 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25437 The nfs-utils package to use.
25438
25439 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
25440 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
25441 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
25442
25443 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
25444 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
25445 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
25446 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
25447 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
25448
25449 @lisp
25450 (nfs-configuration
25451 (exports
25452 '(("/export"
25453 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
25454 @end lisp
25455
25456 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
25457 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
25458
25459 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
25460 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
25461
25462 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
25463 The rpcbind package to use.
25464
25465 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
25466 The local NFSv4 domain name.
25467
25468 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
25469 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
25470
25471 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
25472 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
25473
25474 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
25475 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
25476
25477 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
25478 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
25479
25480 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25481 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25482
25483 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
25484 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
25485 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
25486 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
25487 @end table
25488 @end deftp
25489
25490 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
25491 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
25492
25493 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
25494 @cindex rpcbind
25495
25496 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
25497 universal addresses.
25498 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
25499 started when a dependent service starts.
25500
25501 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
25502 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
25503 @end defvr
25504
25505
25506 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
25507 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
25508 This type has the following parameters:
25509 @table @asis
25510 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
25511 The rpcbind package to use.
25512
25513 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
25514 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
25515 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
25516 instance.
25517 @end table
25518 @end deftp
25519
25520
25521 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
25522 @cindex pipefs
25523 @cindex rpc_pipefs
25524
25525 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
25526 between the kernel and user space programs.
25527
25528 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
25529 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
25530 @end defvr
25531
25532 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
25533 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
25534 This type has the following parameters:
25535 @table @asis
25536 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25537 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
25538 @end table
25539 @end deftp
25540
25541
25542 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
25543 @cindex GSSD
25544 @cindex GSS
25545 @cindex global security system
25546
25547 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
25548 based protocols.
25549 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
25550 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
25551 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
25552
25553 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
25554 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
25555 @end defvr
25556
25557 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
25558 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
25559 This type has the following parameters:
25560 @table @asis
25561 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25562 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
25563
25564 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25565 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25566
25567 @end table
25568 @end deftp
25569
25570
25571 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
25572 @cindex idmapd
25573 @cindex name mapper
25574
25575 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
25576 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
25577
25578 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
25579 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
25580 @end defvr
25581
25582 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
25583 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
25584 This type has the following parameters:
25585 @table @asis
25586 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
25587 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
25588
25589 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
25590 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
25591
25592 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
25593 The local NFSv4 domain name.
25594 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
25595 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
25596
25597 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
25598 The verbosity level of the daemon.
25599
25600 @end table
25601 @end deftp
25602
25603 @node Continuous Integration
25604 @subsection Continuous Integration
25605
25606 @cindex continuous integration
25607 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
25608 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
25609 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
25610
25611 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
25612
25613 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
25614 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
25615 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
25616 @end defvr
25617
25618 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
25619 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
25620 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
25621 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
25622 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
25623
25624 @lisp
25625 (define %cuirass-specs
25626 #~(list
25627 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
25628 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
25629 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
25630 (#:proc-input . "guix")
25631 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
25632 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
25633 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
25634 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
25635 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
25636 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
25637 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
25638 (#:load-path . ".")
25639 (#:branch . "master")
25640 (#:no-compile? . #t))
25641 ((#:name . "config")
25642 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
25643 (#:load-path . ".")
25644 (#:branch . "master")
25645 (#:no-compile? . #t))
25646 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
25647 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
25648 (#:load-path . ".")
25649 (#:branch . "master")
25650 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
25651
25652 (service cuirass-service-type
25653 (cuirass-configuration
25654 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
25655 @end lisp
25656
25657 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
25658 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
25659 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
25660
25661 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
25662 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
25663
25664 @table @asis
25665 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
25666 Location of the log file.
25667
25668 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
25669 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
25670
25671 @item @code{queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25672 Location of the SQL queries log file. By default, SQL queries logging is
25673 disabled.
25674
25675 @item @code{web-queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25676 Location of the web SQL queries log file. By default, web SQL queries
25677 logging is disabled.
25678
25679 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
25680 Location of the repository cache.
25681
25682 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
25683 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
25684
25685 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
25686 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
25687
25688 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
25689 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
25690 Cuirass jobs.
25691
25692 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
25693 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
25694 added specifications.
25695
25696 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25697 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
25698 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
25699 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
25700
25701 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
25702 Port number used by the HTTP server.
25703
25704 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
25705 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
25706 accept connections from localhost.
25707
25708 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
25709 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
25710 where a specification is an association list
25711 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
25712 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
25713 above.
25714
25715 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
25716 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
25717 from source.
25718
25719 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
25720 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
25721
25722 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
25723 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
25724 packages locally.
25725
25726 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
25727 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
25728
25729 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
25730 The Cuirass package to use.
25731 @end table
25732 @end deftp
25733
25734 @node Power Management Services
25735 @subsection Power Management Services
25736
25737 @cindex tlp
25738 @cindex power management with TLP
25739 @subsubheading TLP daemon
25740
25741 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
25742 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
25743
25744 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
25745 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
25746 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
25747 source is detected. More information can be found at
25748 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
25749
25750 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
25751 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
25752 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
25753 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
25754 @lisp
25755 (service tlp-service-type
25756 (tlp-configuration
25757 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
25758 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
25759 @end lisp
25760 @end deffn
25761
25762 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
25763 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
25764 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
25765 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
25766 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
25767
25768 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
25769 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
25770 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
25771 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
25772 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
25773 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
25774 @c the churn as TLP updates.
25775
25776 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
25777
25778 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
25779 The TLP package.
25780
25781 @end deftypevr
25782
25783 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
25784 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
25785
25786 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25787
25788 @end deftypevr
25789
25790 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
25791 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
25792 and BAT.
25793
25794 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
25795
25796 @end deftypevr
25797
25798 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
25799 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
25800 before syncing on AC.
25801
25802 Defaults to @samp{0}.
25803
25804 @end deftypevr
25805
25806 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
25807 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
25808
25809 Defaults to @samp{2}.
25810
25811 @end deftypevr
25812
25813 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
25814 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
25815
25816 Defaults to @samp{15}.
25817
25818 @end deftypevr
25819
25820 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
25821 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
25822
25823 Defaults to @samp{60}.
25824
25825 @end deftypevr
25826
25827 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
25828 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
25829 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
25830 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
25831
25832 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25833
25834 @end deftypevr
25835
25836 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
25837 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
25838
25839 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25840
25841 @end deftypevr
25842
25843 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
25844 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
25845
25846 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25847
25848 @end deftypevr
25849
25850 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
25851 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
25852
25853 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25854
25855 @end deftypevr
25856
25857 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
25858 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
25859
25860 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25861
25862 @end deftypevr
25863
25864 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
25865 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
25866
25867 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25868
25869 @end deftypevr
25870
25871 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
25872 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
25873 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
25874
25875 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25876
25877 @end deftypevr
25878
25879 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
25880 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
25881 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
25882
25883 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25884
25885 @end deftypevr
25886
25887 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
25888 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
25889
25890 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25891
25892 @end deftypevr
25893
25894 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
25895 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
25896
25897 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25898
25899 @end deftypevr
25900
25901 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
25902 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
25903
25904 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25905
25906 @end deftypevr
25907
25908 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
25909 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
25910
25911 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25912
25913 @end deftypevr
25914
25915 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
25916 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
25917 used under light load conditions.
25918
25919 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25920
25921 @end deftypevr
25922
25923 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
25924 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
25925
25926 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
25927
25928 @end deftypevr
25929
25930 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
25931 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
25932
25933 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
25934
25935 @end deftypevr
25936
25937 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
25938 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
25939 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
25940
25941 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25942
25943 @end deftypevr
25944
25945 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
25946 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
25947 performance, normal, powersave.
25948
25949 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
25950
25951 @end deftypevr
25952
25953 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
25954 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
25955
25956 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
25957
25958 @end deftypevr
25959
25960 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
25961 Hard disk devices.
25962
25963 @end deftypevr
25964
25965 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
25966 Hard disk advanced power management level.
25967
25968 @end deftypevr
25969
25970 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
25971 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
25972
25973 @end deftypevr
25974
25975 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
25976 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
25977 declared hard disk.
25978
25979 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25980
25981 @end deftypevr
25982
25983 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
25984 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
25985
25986 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25987
25988 @end deftypevr
25989
25990 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
25991 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
25992 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
25993 noop.
25994
25995 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
25996
25997 @end deftypevr
25998
25999 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
26000 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
26001 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
26002
26003 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
26004
26005 @end deftypevr
26006
26007 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
26008 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
26009
26010 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
26011
26012 @end deftypevr
26013
26014 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
26015 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
26016
26017 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26018
26019 @end deftypevr
26020
26021 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
26022 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
26023 mode.
26024
26025 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26026
26027 @end deftypevr
26028
26029 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
26030 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
26031
26032 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26033
26034 @end deftypevr
26035
26036 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
26037 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
26038
26039 Defaults to @samp{15}.
26040
26041 @end deftypevr
26042
26043 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
26044 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
26045 default, performance, powersave.
26046
26047 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
26048
26049 @end deftypevr
26050
26051 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
26052 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
26053
26054 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
26055
26056 @end deftypevr
26057
26058 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
26059 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
26060 auto, default.
26061
26062 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
26063
26064 @end deftypevr
26065
26066 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
26067 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
26068
26069 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
26070
26071 @end deftypevr
26072
26073 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
26074 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
26075 performance.
26076
26077 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
26078
26079 @end deftypevr
26080
26081 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
26082 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
26083
26084 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
26085
26086 @end deftypevr
26087
26088 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
26089 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
26090
26091 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26092
26093 @end deftypevr
26094
26095 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
26096 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
26097
26098 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26099
26100 @end deftypevr
26101
26102 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
26103 Wifi power saving mode.
26104
26105 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26106
26107 @end deftypevr
26108
26109 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
26110 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
26111
26112 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26113
26114 @end deftypevr
26115
26116 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
26117 Disable wake on LAN.
26118
26119 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26120
26121 @end deftypevr
26122
26123 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
26124 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
26125 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
26126
26127 Defaults to @samp{0}.
26128
26129 @end deftypevr
26130
26131 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
26132 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
26133
26134 Defaults to @samp{1}.
26135
26136 @end deftypevr
26137
26138 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
26139 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
26140
26141 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26142
26143 @end deftypevr
26144
26145 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
26146 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
26147 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
26148 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
26149
26150 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26151
26152 @end deftypevr
26153
26154 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
26155 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
26156
26157 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
26158
26159 @end deftypevr
26160
26161 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
26162 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
26163 and auto.
26164
26165 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
26166
26167 @end deftypevr
26168
26169 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
26170 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
26171
26172 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
26173
26174 @end deftypevr
26175
26176 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
26177 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
26178 ones.
26179
26180 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26181
26182 @end deftypevr
26183
26184 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
26185 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
26186
26187 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26188
26189 @end deftypevr
26190
26191 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
26192 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
26193 Power Management.
26194
26195 @end deftypevr
26196
26197 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
26198 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
26199
26200 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26201
26202 @end deftypevr
26203
26204 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
26205 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
26206
26207 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26208
26209 @end deftypevr
26210
26211 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
26212 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
26213
26214 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26215
26216 @end deftypevr
26217
26218 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
26219 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
26220 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
26221
26222 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26223
26224 @end deftypevr
26225
26226 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
26227 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
26228
26229 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
26230
26231 @end deftypevr
26232
26233 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
26234 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
26235 shutdown on system startup.
26236
26237 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26238
26239 @end deftypevr
26240
26241 @cindex thermald
26242 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
26243 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
26244
26245 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
26246 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
26247
26248 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
26249 This is the service type for
26250 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
26251 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
26252 of processors and preventing overheating.
26253 @end defvr
26254
26255 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
26256 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
26257
26258 @table @asis
26259 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
26260 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
26261
26262 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
26263 Package object of thermald.
26264
26265 @end table
26266 @end deftp
26267
26268 @node Audio Services
26269 @subsection Audio Services
26270
26271 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
26272 (the Music Player Daemon).
26273
26274 @cindex mpd
26275 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
26276
26277 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
26278 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
26279 of clients.
26280
26281 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
26282 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
26283
26284 @lisp
26285 (service mpd-service-type
26286 (mpd-configuration
26287 (user "bob")
26288 (port "6666")))
26289 @end lisp
26290
26291 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
26292 The service type for @command{mpd}
26293 @end defvr
26294
26295 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
26296 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
26297
26298 @table @asis
26299 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
26300 The user to run mpd as.
26301
26302 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
26303 The directory to scan for music files.
26304
26305 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
26306 The directory to store playlists.
26307
26308 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
26309 The location of the music database.
26310
26311 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
26312 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
26313
26314 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
26315 The location of the sticker database.
26316
26317 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
26318 The port to run mpd on.
26319
26320 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
26321 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
26322 an absolute path can be specified here.
26323
26324 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
26325 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
26326
26327 @end table
26328 @end deftp
26329
26330 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
26331 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
26332
26333 @table @asis
26334 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
26335 The name of the audio output.
26336
26337 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
26338 The type of audio output.
26339
26340 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
26341 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
26342 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
26343 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
26344 state is restored.
26345
26346 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
26347 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
26348 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
26349 @code{httpd} output plugin.
26350
26351 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
26352 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
26353 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
26354 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
26355
26356 @item @code{mixer-type}
26357 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
26358 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
26359 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
26360 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
26361 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
26362
26363 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
26364 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
26365 the audio output configuration.
26366
26367 @end table
26368 @end deftp
26369
26370 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
26371 an HTTP audio streaming output.
26372
26373 @lisp
26374 (service mpd-service-type
26375 (mpd-configuration
26376 (outputs
26377 (list (mpd-output
26378 (name "streaming")
26379 (type "httpd")
26380 (mixer-type 'null)
26381 (extra-options
26382 `((encoder . "vorbis")
26383 (port . "8080"))))))))
26384 @end lisp
26385
26386
26387 @node Virtualization Services
26388 @subsection Virtualization Services
26389
26390 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
26391 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
26392 services.
26393
26394 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
26395
26396 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
26397 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
26398 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
26399
26400 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
26401 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
26402 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
26403
26404 @lisp
26405 (service libvirt-service-type
26406 (libvirt-configuration
26407 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
26408 (tls-port "16555")))
26409 @end lisp
26410 @end deffn
26411
26412 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
26413 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
26414
26415 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
26416 Libvirt package.
26417
26418 @end deftypevr
26419
26420 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
26421 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
26422 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
26423
26424 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
26425 this capability.
26426
26427 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26428
26429 @end deftypevr
26430
26431 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
26432 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
26433 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
26434
26435 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
26436 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
26437 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
26438
26439 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26440
26441 @end deftypevr
26442
26443 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
26444 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
26445 or service name.
26446
26447 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
26448
26449 @end deftypevr
26450
26451 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
26452 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
26453 or service name.
26454
26455 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
26456
26457 @end deftypevr
26458
26459 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
26460 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
26461
26462 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
26463
26464 @end deftypevr
26465
26466 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
26467 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
26468
26469 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
26470 Avahi daemon.
26471
26472 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26473
26474 @end deftypevr
26475
26476 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
26477 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
26478 broadcast network.
26479
26480 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
26481
26482 @end deftypevr
26483
26484 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
26485 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
26486 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
26487 becoming root.
26488
26489 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26490
26491 @end deftypevr
26492
26493 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
26494 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
26495 VM status only.
26496
26497 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
26498
26499 @end deftypevr
26500
26501 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
26502 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
26503 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
26504 everyone (eg, 0777)
26505
26506 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
26507
26508 @end deftypevr
26509
26510 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
26511 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
26512 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
26513 the access to.
26514
26515 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
26516
26517 @end deftypevr
26518
26519 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
26520 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
26521
26522 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
26523
26524 @end deftypevr
26525
26526 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
26527 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
26528 permissions allow anyone to connect
26529
26530 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
26531
26532 @end deftypevr
26533
26534 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
26535 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
26536 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
26537 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
26538
26539 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
26540
26541 @end deftypevr
26542
26543 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
26544 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
26545 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
26546 scenario.
26547
26548 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
26549
26550 @end deftypevr
26551
26552 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
26553 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
26554 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
26555 by certificates.
26556
26557 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
26558 by using 'sasl' for this option
26559
26560 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
26561
26562 @end deftypevr
26563
26564 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
26565 API access control scheme.
26566
26567 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
26568 drivers can place restrictions on this.
26569
26570 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26571
26572 @end deftypevr
26573
26574 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
26575 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
26576 loaded.
26577
26578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26579
26580 @end deftypevr
26581
26582 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
26583 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
26584 loaded.
26585
26586 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26587
26588 @end deftypevr
26589
26590 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
26591 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
26592 is loaded.
26593
26594 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26595
26596 @end deftypevr
26597
26598 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
26599 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
26600 CRL is loaded.
26601
26602 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26603
26604 @end deftypevr
26605
26606 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
26607 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
26608
26609 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
26610 certificates.
26611
26612 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26613
26614 @end deftypevr
26615
26616 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
26617 Disable verification of client certificates.
26618
26619 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
26620 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
26621 rejected.
26622
26623 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26624
26625 @end deftypevr
26626
26627 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
26628 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
26629
26630 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26631
26632 @end deftypevr
26633
26634 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
26635 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
26636 the SASL authentication mechanism.
26637
26638 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26639
26640 @end deftypevr
26641
26642 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
26643 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
26644 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
26645 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
26646
26647 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
26648
26649 @end deftypevr
26650
26651 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
26652 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
26653 sockets combined.
26654
26655 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
26656
26657 @end deftypevr
26658
26659 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
26660 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
26661 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
26662 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
26663
26664 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
26665
26666 @end deftypevr
26667
26668 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
26669 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
26670 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
26671
26672 Defaults to @samp{20}.
26673
26674 @end deftypevr
26675
26676 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
26677 Number of workers to start up initially.
26678
26679 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26680
26681 @end deftypevr
26682
26683 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
26684 Maximum number of worker threads.
26685
26686 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
26687 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
26688 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
26689
26690 Defaults to @samp{20}.
26691
26692 @end deftypevr
26693
26694 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
26695 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
26696 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
26697 executed in this pool.
26698
26699 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26700
26701 @end deftypevr
26702
26703 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
26704 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
26705
26706 Defaults to @samp{20}.
26707
26708 @end deftypevr
26709
26710 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
26711 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
26712 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
26713 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
26714
26715 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26716
26717 @end deftypevr
26718
26719 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
26720 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
26721
26722 Defaults to @samp{1}.
26723
26724 @end deftypevr
26725
26726 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
26727 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
26728
26729 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26730
26731 @end deftypevr
26732
26733 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
26734 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
26735
26736 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26737
26738 @end deftypevr
26739
26740 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
26741 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
26742
26743 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26744
26745 @end deftypevr
26746
26747 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
26748 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
26749
26750 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26751
26752 @end deftypevr
26753
26754 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
26755 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
26756
26757 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26758
26759 @end deftypevr
26760
26761 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
26762 Logging filters.
26763
26764 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
26765 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
26766
26767 @itemize @bullet
26768 @item
26769 x:name
26770
26771 @item
26772 x:+name
26773
26774 @end itemize
26775
26776 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
26777 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
26778 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
26779 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
26780 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
26781 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
26782 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
26783 logged:
26784
26785 @itemize @bullet
26786 @item
26787 1: DEBUG
26788
26789 @item
26790 2: INFO
26791
26792 @item
26793 3: WARNING
26794
26795 @item
26796 4: ERROR
26797
26798 @end itemize
26799
26800 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
26801 need to be separated by spaces.
26802
26803 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
26804
26805 @end deftypevr
26806
26807 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
26808 Logging outputs.
26809
26810 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
26811 for an output can be:
26812
26813 @table @code
26814 @item x:stderr
26815 output goes to stderr
26816
26817 @item x:syslog:name
26818 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
26819
26820 @item x:file:file_path
26821 output to a file, with the given filepath
26822
26823 @item x:journald
26824 output to journald logging system
26825
26826 @end table
26827
26828 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
26829
26830 @itemize @bullet
26831 @item
26832 1: DEBUG
26833
26834 @item
26835 2: INFO
26836
26837 @item
26838 3: WARNING
26839
26840 @item
26841 4: ERROR
26842
26843 @end itemize
26844
26845 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
26846 spaces.
26847
26848 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
26849
26850 @end deftypevr
26851
26852 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
26853 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
26854
26855 @itemize @bullet
26856 @item
26857 0: disable all auditing
26858
26859 @item
26860 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
26861
26862 @item
26863 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
26864
26865 @end itemize
26866
26867 Defaults to @samp{1}.
26868
26869 @end deftypevr
26870
26871 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
26872 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
26873
26874 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26875
26876 @end deftypevr
26877
26878 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
26879 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
26880
26881 Defaults to @samp{""}.
26882
26883 @end deftypevr
26884
26885 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
26886 Source to read host UUID.
26887
26888 @itemize @bullet
26889 @item
26890 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
26891
26892 @item
26893 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
26894
26895 @end itemize
26896
26897 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
26898 be generated.
26899
26900 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
26901
26902 @end deftypevr
26903
26904 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
26905 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
26906 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
26907 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
26908 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
26909
26910 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26911
26912 @end deftypevr
26913
26914 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
26915 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
26916 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
26917 broken.
26918
26919 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
26920 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
26921 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
26922 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
26923 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
26924 keepalive messages.
26925
26926 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26927
26928 @end deftypevr
26929
26930 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
26931 Same as above but for admin interface.
26932
26933 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26934
26935 @end deftypevr
26936
26937 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
26938 Same as above but for admin interface.
26939
26940 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26941
26942 @end deftypevr
26943
26944 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
26945 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
26946
26947 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
26948 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
26949 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
26950
26951 Defaults to @samp{5}.
26952
26953 @end deftypevr
26954
26955 @c %end of autogenerated docs
26956
26957 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
26958 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
26959 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
26960
26961 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
26962 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
26963 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
26964 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
26965 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
26966
26967 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
26968 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
26969 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
26970
26971 @lisp
26972 (service virtlog-service-type
26973 (virtlog-configuration
26974 (max-clients 1000)))
26975 @end lisp
26976 @end deffn
26977
26978 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
26979 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
26980
26981 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26982
26983 @end deftypevr
26984
26985 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
26986 Logging filters.
26987
26988 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
26989 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
26990
26991 @itemize @bullet
26992 @item
26993 x:name
26994
26995 @item
26996 x:+name
26997
26998 @end itemize
26999
27000 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
27001 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
27002 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
27003 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
27004 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
27005 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
27006 where matching messages should be logged:
27007
27008 @itemize @bullet
27009 @item
27010 1: DEBUG
27011
27012 @item
27013 2: INFO
27014
27015 @item
27016 3: WARNING
27017
27018 @item
27019 4: ERROR
27020
27021 @end itemize
27022
27023 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
27024 need to be separated by spaces.
27025
27026 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
27027
27028 @end deftypevr
27029
27030 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
27031 Logging outputs.
27032
27033 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
27034 for an output can be:
27035
27036 @table @code
27037 @item x:stderr
27038 output goes to stderr
27039
27040 @item x:syslog:name
27041 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
27042
27043 @item x:file:file_path
27044 output to a file, with the given filepath
27045
27046 @item x:journald
27047 output to journald logging system
27048
27049 @end table
27050
27051 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
27052
27053 @itemize @bullet
27054 @item
27055 1: DEBUG
27056
27057 @item
27058 2: INFO
27059
27060 @item
27061 3: WARNING
27062
27063 @item
27064 4: ERROR
27065
27066 @end itemize
27067
27068 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
27069 spaces.
27070
27071 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
27072
27073 @end deftypevr
27074
27075 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
27076 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
27077 sockets combined.
27078
27079 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
27080
27081 @end deftypevr
27082
27083 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
27084 Maximum file size before rolling over.
27085
27086 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
27087
27088 @end deftypevr
27089
27090 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
27091 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
27092
27093 Defaults to @samp{3}
27094
27095 @end deftypevr
27096
27097 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
27098 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
27099
27100 @cindex emulation
27101 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
27102 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
27103 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
27104 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
27105 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
27106 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
27107 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
27108 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
27109
27110 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
27111 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
27112 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
27113 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
27114 emulated:
27115
27116 @lisp
27117 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
27118 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
27119 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
27120 @end lisp
27121
27122 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
27123 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
27124 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
27125 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27126 @end defvr
27127
27128 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
27129 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
27130
27131 @table @asis
27132 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
27133 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
27134 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
27135
27136 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
27137 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
27138 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
27139 @option{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
27140 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
27141 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
27142
27143 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
27144 service:
27145
27146 @lisp
27147 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
27148 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
27149 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
27150 (guix-support? #t)))
27151 @end lisp
27152
27153 You can run:
27154
27155 @example
27156 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
27157 @end example
27158
27159 @noindent
27160 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
27161 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
27162 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
27163 access to!
27164
27165 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
27166 The QEMU package to use.
27167 @end table
27168 @end deftp
27169
27170 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
27171 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
27172 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
27173 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
27174 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
27175 @end deffn
27176
27177 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
27178 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
27179 @end deffn
27180
27181 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
27182 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
27183 @end deffn
27184
27185
27186 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
27187
27188 @cindex @code{hurd}
27189 @cindex the Hurd
27190 @cindex childhurd
27191
27192 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
27193 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
27194 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
27195 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
27196 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
27197 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
27198
27199 @example
27200 herd start hurd-vm
27201 herd stop childhurd
27202 @end example
27203
27204 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
27205 it with a VNC client, for example with:
27206
27207 @example
27208 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
27209 vncviewer localhost:5900
27210 @end example
27211
27212 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
27213 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
27214 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
27215 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
27216
27217 @example
27218 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
27219 @end example
27220
27221 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
27222 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
27223 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
27224 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
27225 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
27226 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
27227 below.
27228
27229 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
27230 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
27231 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
27232 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
27233 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
27234 options for running it.
27235
27236 For example:
27237
27238 @lisp
27239 (service hurd-vm-service-type
27240 (hurd-vm-configuration
27241 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
27242 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
27243 @end lisp
27244
27245 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
27246 extra memory.
27247 @end defvr
27248
27249 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
27250 The data type representing the configuration for
27251 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
27252
27253 @table @asis
27254 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
27255 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
27256 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
27257 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
27258
27259 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
27260 The QEMU package to use.
27261
27262 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
27263 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
27264 configuration.
27265
27266 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
27267 The size of the disk image.
27268
27269 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
27270 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
27271
27272 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
27273 The extra options for running QEMU.
27274
27275 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
27276 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
27277 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
27278 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
27279
27280 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
27281 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
27282
27283 By default, it produces
27284
27285 @lisp
27286 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
27287 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
27288 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004\
27289 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222\
27290 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900")
27291 @end lisp
27292
27293 with forwarded ports:
27294
27295 @example
27296 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27297 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27298 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
27299 @end example
27300
27301 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
27302 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
27303 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
27304 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
27305 are recreated.
27306
27307 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
27308 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
27309 list of secrets.
27310
27311 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
27312 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
27313
27314 @example
27315 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
27316 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
27317 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
27318 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
27319 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
27320 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
27321 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
27322 @end example
27323
27324 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
27325 including permissions.
27326
27327 @cindex childhurd, offloading
27328 @cindex Hurd, offloading
27329 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
27330 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
27331 childhurd:
27332
27333 @enumerate
27334 @item
27335 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
27336 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
27337
27338 @example
27339 guix archive --authorize < \
27340 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
27341 @end example
27342
27343 @item
27344 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
27345 Offload Setup}).
27346 @end enumerate
27347
27348 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
27349 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
27350 @end table
27351 @end deftp
27352
27353 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
27354 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
27355 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
27356 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
27357
27358 @lisp
27359 (service hurd-vm-service-type
27360 (hurd-vm-configuration
27361 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
27362 (options '())))
27363 @end lisp
27364
27365 @subsubheading Ganeti
27366
27367 @cindex ganeti
27368
27369 @quotation Note
27370 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
27371 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
27372 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
27373 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
27374 @end quotation
27375
27376 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
27377 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
27378 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
27379 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
27380 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
27381 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
27382 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
27383 and address (or use a DNS server).
27384
27385 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
27386 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
27387 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
27388 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
27389
27390 @lisp
27391 (use-package-modules virtualization)
27392 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
27393 (operating-system
27394 ;; @dots{}
27395 (host-name "node1")
27396 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
27397 127.0.0.1 localhost
27398 ::1 localhost
27399
27400 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
27401 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
27402 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
27403 ")))
27404
27405 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
27406 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
27407 (packages (append (map specification->package
27408 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
27409 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
27410 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
27411 %base-packages))
27412 (services
27413 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
27414 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
27415 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
27416 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
27417 "192.168.1.253"))
27418
27419 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
27420 (service openssh-service-type
27421 (openssh-configuration
27422 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
27423
27424 (service ganeti-service-type
27425 (ganeti-configuration
27426 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
27427 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
27428 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
27429 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
27430 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
27431 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
27432 %base-services)))
27433 @end lisp
27434
27435 Users are advised to read the
27436 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
27437 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
27438 day-to-day operations. There is also a
27439 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
27440 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
27441
27442 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
27443 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
27444 nodes should run.
27445
27446 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
27447 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
27448 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
27449 configured through this data type.
27450 @end defvr
27451
27452 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
27453 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
27454
27455 @table @asis
27456 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27457 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
27458 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
27459 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
27460 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
27461
27462 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
27463 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
27464 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
27465 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
27466 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
27467 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
27468 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
27469 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
27470 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
27471 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
27472
27473 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
27474 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
27475 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
27476
27477 @lisp
27478 (service ganeti-service-type
27479 (ganeti-configuration
27480 (rapi-configuration
27481 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
27482 (interface "eth1"))))
27483 (watcher-configuration
27484 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
27485 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
27486 @end lisp
27487
27488 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
27489 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
27490
27491 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
27492 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
27493 @end table
27494
27495 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
27496 individually:
27497
27498 @lisp
27499 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
27500 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
27501 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
27502 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
27503 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
27504 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
27505 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
27506 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
27507 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
27508 @end lisp
27509
27510 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
27511 storage backend and OS variants.
27512
27513 @end deftp
27514
27515 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
27516 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
27517 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
27518
27519 @table @asis
27520 @item @code{name}
27521 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
27522 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
27523 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
27524
27525 @item @code{extension}
27526 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
27527 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
27528
27529 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
27530 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
27531
27532 @end table
27533 @end deftp
27534
27535 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
27536 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
27537 parameters:
27538
27539 @table @asis
27540 @item @code{name}
27541 The name of this variant.
27542
27543 @item @code{configuration}
27544 A configuration file for this variant.
27545 @end table
27546 @end deftp
27547
27548 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
27549 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
27550 @end defvr
27551
27552 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
27553 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
27554 @end defvr
27555
27556 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
27557
27558 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
27559
27560 @table @asis
27561 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
27562 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
27563 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
27564 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
27565
27566 @lisp
27567 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
27568 @end lisp
27569
27570 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
27571 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
27572 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
27573 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
27574 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
27575 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
27576 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
27577 The default varies depending on the distribution.
27578 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
27579 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
27580 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
27581 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
27582 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
27583 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
27584 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
27585 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
27586 to the minimal system.
27587 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
27588 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
27589 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
27590 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
27591 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
27592 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
27593 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
27594 clear the cache.
27595 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
27596 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
27597 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
27598 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
27599 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
27600 @end table
27601 @end deftp
27602
27603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
27604 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
27605 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
27606 @end deffn
27607
27608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
27609 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
27610 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
27611 @end deffn
27612
27613 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
27614 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
27615 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
27616 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
27617 Guix System configuration.
27618 @end deffn
27619
27620 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
27621 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
27622 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
27623 @end deffn
27624
27625 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
27626 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
27627 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
27628 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
27629
27630 @lisp
27631 (list (debootstrap-variant
27632 "default"
27633 (debootstrap-configuration)))
27634 @end lisp
27635 @end defvr
27636
27637 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
27638 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
27639 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
27640 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
27641
27642 @lisp
27643 (list (guix-variant
27644 "default"
27645 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
27646 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
27647 @end lisp
27648 @end defvr
27649
27650 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
27651 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
27652 For example:
27653
27654 @lisp
27655 (ganeti-os
27656 (name "custom")
27657 (extension ".conf")
27658 (variants
27659 (list (ganeti-os-variant
27660 (name "foo")
27661 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
27662 @end lisp
27663
27664 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
27665 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
27666 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
27667
27668 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
27669 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
27670
27671 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
27672 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
27673
27674 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
27675 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
27676 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
27677 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
27678 @end defvr
27679
27680 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
27681 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
27682
27683 @table @asis
27684 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27685 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27686
27687 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
27688 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
27689
27690 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
27691 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
27692 bind to all available addresses.
27693
27694 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
27695 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
27696 that the daemon will bind to.
27697
27698 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
27699 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
27700 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
27701 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
27702
27703 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
27704 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
27705 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
27706 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
27707
27708 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
27709 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
27710
27711 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
27712 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
27713
27714 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27715 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27716 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
27717
27718 @end table
27719 @end deftp
27720
27721 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
27722 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
27723 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
27724 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
27725 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
27726 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
27727
27728 @end defvr
27729
27730 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
27731 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
27732
27733 @table @asis
27734 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27735 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27736
27737 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
27738 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
27739
27740 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
27741 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
27742
27743 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27744 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27745
27746 @end table
27747 @end deftp
27748
27749 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
27750 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
27751 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
27752 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
27753 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
27754 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
27755
27756 The value of this service must be a
27757 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
27758 @end defvr
27759
27760 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
27761 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
27762
27763 @table @asis
27764 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27765 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27766
27767 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
27768 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
27769 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
27770 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
27771
27772 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27773 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27774
27775 @end table
27776 @end deftp
27777
27778 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
27779 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
27780 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
27781 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
27782 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
27783
27784 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
27785 @end defvr
27786
27787 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
27788 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
27789
27790 @table @asis
27791 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27792 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27793
27794 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
27795 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
27796 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
27797 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
27798
27799 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27800 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27801
27802 @end table
27803 @end deftp
27804
27805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
27806 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
27807 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
27808 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
27809
27810 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
27811 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
27812 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
27813 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
27814 API documentation} for more information.
27815
27816 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
27817 @end defvr
27818
27819 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
27820 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
27821
27822 @table @asis
27823 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27824 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27825
27826 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
27827 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
27828
27829 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
27830 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
27831
27832 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
27833 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
27834 on all configured addresses.
27835
27836 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
27837 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
27838 that the daemon will bind to.
27839
27840 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
27841 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
27842 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
27843 have closed.
27844
27845 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
27846 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
27847
27848 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
27849 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
27850
27851 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
27852 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
27853
27854 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27855 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27856 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
27857
27858 @end table
27859 @end deftp
27860
27861 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
27862 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
27863 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
27864 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
27865 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
27866 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
27867 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
27868 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
27869
27870 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
27871 @end defvr
27872
27873 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
27874
27875 @table @asis
27876 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27877 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27878
27879 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27880 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27881
27882 @end table
27883 @end deftp
27884
27885 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
27886 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
27887 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
27888 collected information through a HTTP interface.
27889
27890 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
27891 @end defvr
27892
27893 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
27894
27895 @table @asis
27896 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27897 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27898
27899 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
27900 The port on which the daemon will listen.
27901
27902 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
27903 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
27904 available interfaces.
27905
27906 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27907 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27908
27909 @end table
27910 @end deftp
27911
27912 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
27913 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
27914 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
27915
27916 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
27917 @end defvr
27918
27919 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
27920
27921 @table @asis
27922 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27923 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27924
27925 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
27926 The port on which the daemon will listen.
27927
27928 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
27929 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
27930 depends on the cluster configuration.
27931
27932 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27933 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27934
27935 @end table
27936 @end deftp
27937
27938 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
27939 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
27940 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
27941 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
27942 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
27943 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
27944 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
27945 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
27946
27947 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
27948
27949 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
27950 @end defvr
27951
27952 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
27953
27954 @table @asis
27955 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27956 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
27957
27958 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
27959 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
27960
27961 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
27962 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
27963 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
27964
27965 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
27966 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
27967 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
27968
27969 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
27970 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
27971 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
27972 manually instead.
27973
27974 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
27975 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
27976
27977 @end table
27978 @end deftp
27979
27980 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
27981 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
27982 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
27983 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
27984 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
27985 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
27986 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
27987 necessary.
27988
27989 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
27990 @end defvr
27991
27992 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
27993
27994 @table @asis
27995 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
27996 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
27997
27998 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
27999 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
28000 01:45:00.
28001
28002 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
28003 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
28004 02:45:00.
28005
28006 @end table
28007 @end deftp
28008
28009 @node Version Control Services
28010 @subsection Version Control Services
28011
28012 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
28013 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
28014 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
28015 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
28016 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
28017 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
28018 @code{cgit-service-type}.
28019
28020 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
28021
28022 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
28023 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
28024
28025 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
28026 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
28027 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
28028 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
28029 @file{/srv/git}.
28030
28031 @end deffn
28032
28033 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
28034 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
28035
28036 @table @asis
28037 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
28038 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
28039
28040 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
28041 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
28042 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
28043
28044 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
28045 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
28046 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
28047 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
28048 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
28049 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
28050
28051 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
28052 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
28053 specified with empty string, requests to
28054 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
28055 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
28056 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
28057 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
28058 directory of user @code{alice}.
28059
28060 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
28061 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
28062 all.
28063
28064 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
28065 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
28066
28067 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
28068 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
28069
28070 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
28071 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
28072 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
28073
28074 @end table
28075 @end deftp
28076
28077 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
28078 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
28079 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
28080 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
28081 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
28082 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
28083 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
28084 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
28085 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
28086 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
28087
28088 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
28089 over HTTP.
28090
28091 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
28092 Data type representing the configuration for a future
28093 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
28094 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
28095
28096 @table @asis
28097 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
28098 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
28099
28100 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
28101 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
28102
28103 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
28104 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
28105 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
28106
28107 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
28108 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
28109 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
28110 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
28111 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
28112
28113 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
28114 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
28115 Services}.
28116 @end table
28117 @end deftp
28118
28119 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
28120 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
28121 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
28122 server.
28123
28124 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
28125 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
28126 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
28127 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
28128 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
28129
28130 @lisp
28131 (service nginx-service-type
28132 (nginx-configuration
28133 (server-blocks
28134 (list
28135 (nginx-server-configuration
28136 (listen '("443 ssl"))
28137 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
28138 (ssl-certificate
28139 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
28140 (ssl-certificate-key
28141 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
28142 (locations
28143 (list
28144 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
28145 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
28146 @end lisp
28147
28148 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
28149 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
28150 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
28151 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
28152 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
28153 @end deffn
28154
28155 @subsubheading Cgit Service
28156
28157 @cindex Cgit service
28158 @cindex Git, web interface
28159 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
28160 repositories written in C.
28161
28162 The following example will configure the service with default values.
28163 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
28164
28165 @lisp
28166 (service cgit-service-type)
28167 @end lisp
28168
28169 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
28170 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
28171
28172 @c %start of fragment
28173
28174 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
28175
28176 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
28177 The CGIT package.
28178
28179 @end deftypevr
28180
28181 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
28182 NGINX configuration.
28183
28184 @end deftypevr
28185
28186 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
28187 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
28188 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
28189
28190 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28191
28192 @end deftypevr
28193
28194 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
28195 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
28196 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
28197
28198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28199
28200 @end deftypevr
28201
28202 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
28203 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
28204 access.
28205
28206 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28207
28208 @end deftypevr
28209
28210 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
28211 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
28212 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
28213
28214 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
28215
28216 @end deftypevr
28217
28218 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
28219 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
28220
28221 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
28222
28223 @end deftypevr
28224
28225 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
28226 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28227 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
28228
28229 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
28230
28231 @end deftypevr
28232
28233 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
28234 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28235 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
28236
28237 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28238
28239 @end deftypevr
28240
28241 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
28242 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28243 version of the repository summary page.
28244
28245 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28246
28247 @end deftypevr
28248
28249 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
28250 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28251 version of the repository index page.
28252
28253 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28254
28255 @end deftypevr
28256
28257 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
28258 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
28259 scanning a path for Git repositories.
28260
28261 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28262
28263 @end deftypevr
28264
28265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
28266 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28267 version of the repository about page.
28268
28269 Defaults to @samp{15}.
28270
28271 @end deftypevr
28272
28273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
28274 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
28275 version of snapshots.
28276
28277 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28278
28279 @end deftypevr
28280
28281 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
28282 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
28283 caching is disabled.
28284
28285 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28286
28287 @end deftypevr
28288
28289 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
28290 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
28291
28292 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28293
28294 @end deftypevr
28295
28296 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
28297 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
28298 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
28299
28300 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28301
28302 @end deftypevr
28303
28304 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
28305 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
28306
28307 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28308
28309 @end deftypevr
28310
28311 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
28312 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
28313
28314 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28315
28316 @end deftypevr
28317
28318 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
28319 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
28320 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
28321 ordering.
28322
28323 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
28324
28325 @end deftypevr
28326
28327 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
28328 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
28329
28330 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
28331
28332 @end deftypevr
28333
28334 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
28335 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
28336 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
28337 places throughout the cgit interface.
28338
28339 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28340
28341 @end deftypevr
28342
28343 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
28344 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
28345 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
28346
28347 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28348
28349 @end deftypevr
28350
28351 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
28352 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
28353 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
28354 repository log page.
28355
28356 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28357
28358 @end deftypevr
28359
28360 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
28361 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
28362 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
28363
28364 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28365
28366 @end deftypevr
28367
28368 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
28369 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
28370 log view.
28371
28372 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28373
28374 @end deftypevr
28375
28376 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
28377 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
28378 clones.
28379
28380 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28381
28382 @end deftypevr
28383
28384 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
28385 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
28386 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
28387
28388 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28389
28390 @end deftypevr
28391
28392 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
28393 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
28394 each repo in the repository index.
28395
28396 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28397
28398 @end deftypevr
28399
28400 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
28401 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
28402 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
28403
28404 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28405
28406 @end deftypevr
28407
28408 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
28409 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
28410 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
28411
28412 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28413
28414 @end deftypevr
28415
28416 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
28417 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
28418 branches in the summary and refs views.
28419
28420 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28421
28422 @end deftypevr
28423
28424 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
28425 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
28426 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
28427 commit view.
28428
28429 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28430
28431 @end deftypevr
28432
28433 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
28434 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
28435 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
28436 commit view.
28437
28438 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28439
28440 @end deftypevr
28441
28442 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
28443 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
28444 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
28445
28446 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28447
28448 @end deftypevr
28449
28450 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
28451 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
28452 set any repo specific settings.
28453
28454 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28455
28456 @end deftypevr
28457
28458 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
28459 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
28460
28461 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
28462
28463 @end deftypevr
28464
28465 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
28466 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28467 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
28468 "generated by..."@: message).
28469
28470 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28471
28472 @end deftypevr
28473
28474 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
28475 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28476 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
28477
28478 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28479
28480 @end deftypevr
28481
28482 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
28483 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28484 verbatim at the top of all pages.
28485
28486 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28487
28488 @end deftypevr
28489
28490 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
28491 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
28492 file is parsed.
28493
28494 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28495
28496 @end deftypevr
28497
28498 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
28499 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28500 verbatim above the repository index.
28501
28502 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28503
28504 @end deftypevr
28505
28506 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
28507 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28508 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
28509
28510 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28511
28512 @end deftypevr
28513
28514 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
28515 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
28516 in the servers timezone.
28517
28518 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28519
28520 @end deftypevr
28521
28522 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
28523 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
28524 on all cgit pages.
28525
28526 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
28527
28528 @end deftypevr
28529
28530 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
28531 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
28532
28533 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28534
28535 @end deftypevr
28536
28537 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
28538 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
28539 page.
28540
28541 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28542
28543 @end deftypevr
28544
28545 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
28546 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
28547
28548 Defaults to @samp{10}.
28549
28550 @end deftypevr
28551
28552 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
28553 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
28554
28555 Defaults to @samp{50}.
28556
28557 @end deftypevr
28558
28559 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
28560 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
28561
28562 Defaults to @samp{80}.
28563
28564 @end deftypevr
28565
28566 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
28567 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
28568 page.
28569
28570 Defaults to @samp{50}.
28571
28572 @end deftypevr
28573
28574 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
28575 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
28576 on the repository index page.
28577
28578 Defaults to @samp{80}.
28579
28580 @end deftypevr
28581
28582 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
28583 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
28584
28585 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28586
28587 @end deftypevr
28588
28589 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
28590 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
28591 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
28592
28593 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28594
28595 @end deftypevr
28596
28597 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
28598 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
28599
28600 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
28601 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
28602 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
28603
28604 @end deftypevr
28605
28606 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
28607 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
28608
28609 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28610
28611 @end deftypevr
28612
28613 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
28614 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
28615 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
28616
28617 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28618
28619 @end deftypevr
28620
28621 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
28622 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
28623
28624 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28625
28626 @end deftypevr
28627
28628 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
28629 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
28630 disabled.
28631
28632 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28633
28634 @end deftypevr
28635
28636 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
28637 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
28638 header on all pages.
28639
28640 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28641
28642 @end deftypevr
28643
28644 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
28645 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
28646 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
28647 all subdirectories will be loaded.
28648
28649 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28650
28651 @end deftypevr
28652
28653 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
28654 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
28655
28656 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28657
28658 @end deftypevr
28659
28660 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
28661 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
28662 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
28663 removed for the URL and name.
28664
28665 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28666
28667 @end deftypevr
28668
28669 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
28670 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
28671
28672 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
28673
28674 @end deftypevr
28675
28676 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
28677 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
28678
28679 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28680
28681 @end deftypevr
28682
28683 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
28684 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
28685
28686 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
28687
28688 @end deftypevr
28689
28690 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
28691 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
28692
28693 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
28694
28695 @end deftypevr
28696
28697 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
28698 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
28699 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
28700
28701 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28702
28703 @end deftypevr
28704
28705 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
28706 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
28707
28708 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28709
28710 @end deftypevr
28711
28712 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
28713 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
28714 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
28715 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
28716 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
28717 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
28718
28719 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28720
28721 @end deftypevr
28722
28723 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
28724 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
28725 generates links for.
28726
28727 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28728
28729 @end deftypevr
28730
28731 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
28732 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
28733 @code{scan-path}).
28734
28735 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
28736
28737 @end deftypevr
28738
28739 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
28740 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
28741 after this option will inherit the current section name.
28742
28743 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28744
28745 @end deftypevr
28746
28747 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
28748 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
28749 repository listing by name.
28750
28751 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28752
28753 @end deftypevr
28754
28755 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
28756 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
28757 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
28758
28759 Defaults to @samp{0}.
28760
28761 @end deftypevr
28762
28763 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
28764 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
28765 default.
28766
28767 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28768
28769 @end deftypevr
28770
28771 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
28772 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
28773 the tree view.
28774
28775 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28776
28777 @end deftypevr
28778
28779 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
28780 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
28781 view.
28782
28783 Defaults to @samp{10}.
28784
28785 @end deftypevr
28786
28787 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
28788 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
28789 ``summary'' view.
28790
28791 Defaults to @samp{10}.
28792
28793 @end deftypevr
28794
28795 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
28796 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
28797 view.
28798
28799 Defaults to @samp{10}.
28800
28801 @end deftypevr
28802
28803 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
28804 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
28805 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
28806
28807 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28808
28809 @end deftypevr
28810
28811 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
28812 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
28813
28814 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
28815
28816 @end deftypevr
28817
28818 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
28819 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
28820
28821 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28822
28823 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
28824
28825 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
28826 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
28827 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
28828
28829 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28830
28831 @end deftypevr
28832
28833 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
28834 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
28835
28836 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28837
28838 @end deftypevr
28839
28840 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
28841 The relative URL used to access the repository.
28842
28843 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28844
28845 @end deftypevr
28846
28847 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
28848 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
28849
28850 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28851
28852 @end deftypevr
28853
28854 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
28855 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
28856 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
28857
28858 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28859
28860 @end deftypevr
28861
28862 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
28863 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
28864
28865 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28866
28867 @end deftypevr
28868
28869 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
28870 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
28871
28872 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28873
28874 @end deftypevr
28875
28876 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
28877 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
28878 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
28879 ordering.
28880
28881 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28882
28883 @end deftypevr
28884
28885 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
28886 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
28887 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
28888 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
28889 there is no suitable HEAD.
28890
28891 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28892
28893 @end deftypevr
28894
28895 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
28896 The value to show as repository description.
28897
28898 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28899
28900 @end deftypevr
28901
28902 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
28903 The value to show as repository homepage.
28904
28905 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28906
28907 @end deftypevr
28908
28909 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
28910 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
28911
28912 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28913
28914 @end deftypevr
28915
28916 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
28917 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
28918 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
28919
28920 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28921
28922 @end deftypevr
28923
28924 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
28925 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
28926 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
28927
28928 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28929
28930 @end deftypevr
28931
28932 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
28933 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
28934 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
28935
28936 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28937
28938 @end deftypevr
28939
28940 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
28941 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
28942 branches in the summary and refs views.
28943
28944 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28945
28946 @end deftypevr
28947
28948 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
28949 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
28950 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
28951
28952 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28953
28954 @end deftypevr
28955
28956 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
28957 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
28958 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
28959
28960 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
28961
28962 @end deftypevr
28963
28964 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
28965 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
28966 repository index.
28967
28968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28969
28970 @end deftypevr
28971
28972 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
28973 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
28974
28975 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28976
28977 @end deftypevr
28978
28979 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
28980 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
28981 on this repo’s pages.
28982
28983 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28984
28985 @end deftypevr
28986
28987 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
28988 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
28989
28990 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28991
28992 @end deftypevr
28993
28994 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
28995 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
28996
28997 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28998
28999 @end deftypevr
29000
29001 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
29002 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
29003 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
29004 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
29005
29006 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29007
29008 @end deftypevr
29009
29010 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
29011 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
29012 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
29013 listing.
29014
29015 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29016
29017 @end deftypevr
29018
29019 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
29020 Override the default maximum statistics period.
29021
29022 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29023
29024 @end deftypevr
29025
29026 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
29027 The value to show as repository name.
29028
29029 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29030
29031 @end deftypevr
29032
29033 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
29034 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
29035
29036 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29037
29038 @end deftypevr
29039
29040 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
29041 An absolute path to the repository directory.
29042
29043 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29044
29045 @end deftypevr
29046
29047 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
29048 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
29049 the ``About'' page for this repo.
29050
29051 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29052
29053 @end deftypevr
29054
29055 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
29056 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
29057 after this option will inherit the current section name.
29058
29059 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29060
29061 @end deftypevr
29062
29063 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
29064 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
29065
29066 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29067
29068 @end deftypevr
29069
29070 @end deftypevr
29071
29072 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
29073 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
29074
29075 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29076
29077 @end deftypevr
29078
29079
29080 @c %end of fragment
29081
29082 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
29083 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
29084 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
29085 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
29086
29087 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
29088
29089 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
29090 The cgit package.
29091 @end deftypevr
29092
29093 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
29094 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
29095 @end deftypevr
29096
29097 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
29098 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
29099
29100 @lisp
29101 (service cgit-service-type
29102 (opaque-cgit-configuration
29103 (cgitrc "")))
29104 @end lisp
29105
29106 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
29107
29108 @cindex Gitolite service
29109 @cindex Git, hosting
29110 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
29111 repositories on a central server.
29112
29113 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
29114 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
29115
29116 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
29117 user, and the provided SSH public key.
29118
29119 @lisp
29120 (service gitolite-service-type
29121 (gitolite-configuration
29122 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
29123 "yourname.pub"
29124 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
29125 @end lisp
29126
29127 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
29128 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
29129 following command to clone the admin repository.
29130
29131 @example
29132 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
29133 @end example
29134
29135 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
29136 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
29137 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
29138 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
29139
29140 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
29141 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
29142
29143 @table @asis
29144 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
29145 Gitolite package to use.
29146
29147 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
29148 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
29149 Gitolite over SSH.
29150
29151 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
29152 Group to use for Gitolite.
29153
29154 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
29155 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
29156
29157 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
29158 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
29159 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
29160
29161 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
29162 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
29163 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
29164 within the gitolite-admin repository.
29165
29166 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
29167
29168 @lisp
29169 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
29170 @end lisp
29171
29172 @end table
29173 @end deftp
29174
29175 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
29176 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
29177
29178 @table @asis
29179 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
29180 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
29181 contents.
29182
29183 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
29184 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
29185 like cgit or gitweb.
29186
29187 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
29188 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config} keyword. This
29189 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
29190
29191 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
29192 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
29193
29194 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
29195 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
29196
29197 @end table
29198 @end deftp
29199
29200
29201 @node Game Services
29202 @subsection Game Services
29203
29204 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
29205 @cindex wesnothd
29206 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
29207 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
29208 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
29209
29210 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
29211 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
29212 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
29213 configuration, instantiate it as:
29214
29215 @lisp
29216 (service wesnothd-service-type)
29217 @end lisp
29218 @end defvar
29219
29220 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
29221 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
29222
29223 @table @asis
29224 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
29225 The wesnoth server package to use.
29226
29227 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
29228 The port to bind the server to.
29229 @end table
29230 @end deftp
29231
29232
29233 @node PAM Mount Service
29234 @subsection PAM Mount Service
29235 @cindex pam-mount
29236
29237 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
29238 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
29239 volume format supported by the system.
29240
29241 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
29242 Service type for PAM Mount support.
29243 @end defvar
29244
29245 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
29246 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
29247
29248 It takes the following parameters:
29249
29250 @table @asis
29251 @item @code{rules}
29252 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
29253 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
29254
29255 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
29256 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
29257 anyone at login:
29258
29259 @lisp
29260 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
29261 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
29262 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
29263 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
29264 "allow_root" "allow_other")
29265 ","))))
29266 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
29267 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
29268 (hup "0")
29269 (term "no")
29270 (kill "no")))
29271 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
29272 (remove "true"))))
29273 @end lisp
29274
29275 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
29276 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
29277 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
29278 the partition where he stores his data:
29279
29280 @lisp
29281 (define pam-mount-rules
29282 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
29283 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
29284 (fstype "crypt")
29285 (path "/dev/sda2")
29286 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
29287 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
29288 (fstype "auto")
29289 (path "/dev/sdb3")
29290 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
29291 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
29292 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
29293 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
29294 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
29295 "allow_root" "allow_other")
29296 ","))))
29297 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
29298 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
29299 (hup "0")
29300 (term "no")
29301 (kill "no")))
29302 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
29303 (remove "true")))))
29304
29305 (service pam-mount-service-type
29306 (pam-mount-configuration
29307 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
29308 @end lisp
29309
29310 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
29311 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
29312 @end table
29313 @end deftp
29314
29315
29316 @node Guix Services
29317 @subsection Guix Services
29318
29319 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
29320 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
29321 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
29322 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
29323 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
29324 and working with the results.
29325
29326 @quotation Note
29327 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
29328 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
29329 been thorougly tested.
29330 @end quotation
29331
29332 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
29333 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
29334 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
29335 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
29336 send the results back to the coordinator.
29337
29338 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
29339 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
29340 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
29341
29342 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
29343 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
29344 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
29345 @end defvar
29346
29347 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
29348 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
29349
29350 @table @asis
29351 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29352 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29353
29354 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
29355 The system user to run the service as.
29356
29357 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
29358 The system group to run the service as.
29359
29360 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
29361 The URI to use for the database.
29362
29363 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
29364 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
29365
29366 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
29367 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
29368 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
29369 care when configuring this value.
29370
29371 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
29372 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
29373 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
29374 allocation plan in the database.
29375
29376 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
29377 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
29378 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
29379
29380 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
29381 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
29382
29383 @end table
29384 @end deftp
29385
29386 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
29387 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
29388 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
29389 @end defvar
29390
29391 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
29392 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
29393
29394 @table @asis
29395 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29396 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29397
29398 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
29399 The system user to run the service as.
29400
29401 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
29402 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
29403
29404 @item @code{uuid}
29405 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
29406 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
29407 agent.
29408
29409 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
29410 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator. A file to read
29411 the password from can also be specified, and this is more secure.
29412
29413 @item @code{password-file} (default: @code{#f})
29414 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
29415 coordinator.
29416
29417 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
29418 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
29419 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
29420
29421 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
29422 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
29423
29424 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
29425 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
29426 derivations aren't already available.
29427
29428 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
29429 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
29430 input store items aren't already available.
29431
29432 @end table
29433 @end deftp
29434
29435 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
29436 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
29437 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
29438 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
29439 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
29440 instance of the Guix Data Service.
29441
29442 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
29443 Service type for the
29444 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
29445 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
29446 object.
29447 @end defvar
29448
29449 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
29450 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
29451 service script.
29452
29453 @table @asis
29454 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
29455 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
29456
29457 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
29458 The system user to run the service as.
29459
29460 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
29461 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
29462
29463 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
29464 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
29465
29466 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
29467 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
29468 derivations to build.
29469
29470 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
29471 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
29472 derivations to build.
29473
29474 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
29475 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
29476 processing them again if the service is restarted.
29477
29478 @end table
29479 @end deftp
29480
29481 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
29482 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
29483 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
29484 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
29485
29486 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
29487 interface.
29488
29489 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
29490 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
29491 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
29492 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
29493 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
29494 @end defvar
29495
29496 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
29497 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
29498
29499 @table @asis
29500 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
29501 The Guix Data Service package to use.
29502
29503 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
29504 The system user to run the service as.
29505
29506 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
29507 The system group to run the service as.
29508
29509 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
29510 The port to bind the web service to.
29511
29512 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
29513 The host to bind the web service to.
29514
29515 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
29516 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
29517 configured to listen to.
29518
29519 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
29520 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
29521 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
29522 list.
29523
29524 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
29525 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
29526
29527 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
29528 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
29529
29530 @end table
29531 @end deftp
29532
29533 @node Linux Services
29534 @subsection Linux Services
29535
29536 @cindex oom
29537 @cindex out of memory killer
29538 @cindex earlyoom
29539 @cindex early out of memory daemon
29540 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
29541
29542 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
29543 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
29544 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
29545 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
29546 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
29547
29548 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
29549 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
29550 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
29551 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
29552 with:
29553
29554 @lisp
29555 (service earlyoom-service-type)
29556 @end lisp
29557 @end deffn
29558
29559 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
29560 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
29561
29562 @table @asis
29563 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
29564 The Earlyoom package to use.
29565
29566 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
29567 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
29568
29569 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
29570 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
29571
29572 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
29573 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
29574 that should be preferably killed.
29575
29576 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
29577 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
29578 that should @emph{not} be killed.
29579
29580 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
29581 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
29582 disabled by default.
29583
29584 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
29585 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
29586 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
29587
29588 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
29589 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
29590 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
29591
29592 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
29593 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
29594 notifications.
29595 @end table
29596 @end deftp
29597
29598 @cindex modprobe
29599 @cindex kernel module loader
29600 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
29601
29602 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
29603 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
29604 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
29605 @code{ddcci}.
29606
29607 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
29608 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
29609 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
29610 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
29611 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
29612 parameters, can be done as follow:
29613
29614 @lisp
29615 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
29616 (use-package-modules linux)
29617 (use-service-modules linux)
29618
29619 (define ddcci-config
29620 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
29621 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
29622
29623 (operating-system
29624 ...
29625 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
29626 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
29627 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
29628 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
29629 ,ddcci-config)))
29630 %base-services))
29631 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
29632 @end lisp
29633 @end deffn
29634
29635 @cindex zram
29636 @cindex compressed swap
29637 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
29638 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
29639
29640 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
29641 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
29642 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
29643 devices.
29644
29645 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
29646 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
29647 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
29648 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
29649
29650 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
29651 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
29652 service.
29653
29654 @table @asis
29655 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
29656 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
29657 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
29658 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
29659 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
29660 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
29661 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
29662 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
29663 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
29664 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
29665 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
29666 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
29667 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
29668 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
29669 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
29670 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
29671 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
29672 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
29673 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
29674 first.
29675 @end table
29676
29677 @end deftp
29678 @end deffn
29679
29680 @node Hurd Services
29681 @subsection Hurd Services
29682
29683 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
29684 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
29685
29686 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
29687 @end defvr
29688
29689 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
29690 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
29691 hurd-console-service.
29692
29693 @table @asis
29694 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
29695 The Hurd package to use.
29696 @end table
29697 @end deftp
29698
29699 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
29700 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
29701
29702 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
29703 @end defvr
29704
29705 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
29706 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
29707 hurd-getty-service.
29708
29709 @table @asis
29710 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
29711 The Hurd package to use.
29712
29713 @item @code{tty}
29714 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
29715
29716 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
29717 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
29718
29719 @end table
29720 @end deftp
29721
29722 @node Miscellaneous Services
29723 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
29724
29725 @cindex fingerprint
29726 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
29727
29728 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
29729 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
29730
29731 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
29732 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
29733 reading capability.
29734
29735 @lisp
29736 (service fprintd-service-type)
29737 @end lisp
29738 @end defvr
29739
29740 @cindex sysctl
29741 @subsubheading System Control Service
29742
29743 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
29744 parameters at boot.
29745
29746 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
29747 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
29748 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
29749 instantiated as:
29750
29751 @lisp
29752 (service sysctl-service-type
29753 (sysctl-configuration
29754 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
29755 @end lisp
29756 @end defvr
29757
29758 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
29759 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
29760
29761 @table @asis
29762 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
29763 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
29764
29765 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
29766 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
29767 @end table
29768 @end deftp
29769
29770 @cindex pcscd
29771 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
29772
29773 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
29774 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
29775 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
29776 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
29777 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
29778
29779 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
29780 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
29781 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
29782 configuration, instantiate it as:
29783
29784 @lisp
29785 (service pcscd-service-type)
29786 @end lisp
29787 @end defvr
29788
29789 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
29790 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
29791
29792 @table @asis
29793 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
29794 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
29795 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
29796 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
29797 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
29798 @end table
29799 @end deftp
29800
29801 @cindex lirc
29802 @subsubheading Lirc Service
29803
29804 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
29805
29806 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
29807 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
29808 [#:extra-options '()]
29809 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
29810 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
29811
29812 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
29813 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
29814 for details.
29815
29816 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
29817 passed to @command{lircd}.
29818 @end deffn
29819
29820 @cindex spice
29821 @subsubheading Spice Service
29822
29823 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
29824
29825 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
29826 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
29827 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
29828 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
29829 @end deffn
29830
29831 @cindex inputattach
29832 @subsubheading inputattach Service
29833
29834 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
29835 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
29836 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
29837 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
29838 Xorg display server.
29839
29840 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
29841 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
29842 dispatches events from it.
29843 @end deffn
29844
29845 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
29846 @table @asis
29847 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
29848 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
29849 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
29850
29851 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
29852 The device file to connect to the device.
29853
29854 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
29855 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
29856 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
29857
29858 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
29859 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
29860 @end table
29861 @end deftp
29862
29863 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
29864 @cindex dictionary
29865 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
29866
29867 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
29868 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
29869 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29870 @end defvr
29871
29872 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
29873 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
29874 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29875
29876 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
29877 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
29878 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
29879
29880 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
29881 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
29882 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29883 @end deffn
29884
29885 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
29886 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
29887
29888 @table @asis
29889 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
29890 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
29891
29892 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
29893 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
29894 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
29895 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29896
29897 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
29898 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
29899
29900 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
29901 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
29902 @end table
29903 @end deftp
29904
29905 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
29906 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
29907
29908 @table @asis
29909 @item @code{name}
29910 Name of the handler (module instance).
29911
29912 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
29913 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
29914 the module has the same name as the handler.
29915 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29916
29917 @item @code{options}
29918 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
29919 @end table
29920 @end deftp
29921
29922 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
29923 Data type representing a dictionary database.
29924
29925 @table @asis
29926 @item @code{name}
29927 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
29928
29929 @item @code{handler}
29930 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
29931 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29932
29933 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
29934 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
29935 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
29936
29937 @item @code{options}
29938 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
29939 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
29940 @end table
29941 @end deftp
29942
29943 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
29944 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
29945 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
29946 @end defvr
29947
29948 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
29949
29950 @lisp
29951 (dicod-service #:config
29952 (dicod-configuration
29953 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
29954 (name "wordnet")
29955 (module "dictorg")
29956 (options
29957 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
29958 (databases (list (dicod-database
29959 (name "wordnet")
29960 (complex? #t)
29961 (handler "wordnet")
29962 (options '("database=wn")))
29963 %dicod-database:gcide))))
29964 @end lisp
29965
29966 @cindex Docker
29967 @subsubheading Docker Service
29968
29969 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
29970
29971 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
29972
29973 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
29974 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
29975 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
29976
29977 @end defvr
29978
29979 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
29980 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
29981
29982 @table @asis
29983
29984 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
29985 The Docker daemon package to use.
29986
29987 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker-cli})
29988 The Docker client package to use.
29989
29990 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
29991 The Containerd package to use.
29992
29993 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
29994 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
29995
29996 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
29997 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
29998
29999 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
30000 Enable or disable debug output.
30001
30002 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
30003 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
30004
30005 @end table
30006 @end deftp
30007
30008 @cindex Singularity, container service
30009 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
30010 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
30011 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
30012 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
30013 service is the Singularity package to use.
30014
30015 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
30016 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
30017 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
30018 @end defvr
30019
30020 @cindex Audit
30021 @subsubheading Auditd Service
30022
30023 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
30024
30025 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
30026
30027 This is the type of the service that runs
30028 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
30029 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
30030
30031 Examples of things that can be tracked:
30032
30033 @enumerate
30034 @item
30035 File accesses
30036 @item
30037 System calls
30038 @item
30039 Invoked commands
30040 @item
30041 Failed login attempts
30042 @item
30043 Firewall filtering
30044 @item
30045 Network access
30046 @end enumerate
30047
30048 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
30049 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
30050 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
30051 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
30052 directory (see below).
30053 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
30054 to view a report of all recorded events.
30055 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
30056 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
30057
30058 @end defvr
30059
30060 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
30061 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
30062
30063 @table @asis
30064
30065 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
30066 The audit package to use.
30067
30068 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
30069 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
30070 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
30071 instantiate on startup.
30072
30073 @end table
30074 @end deftp
30075
30076 @cindex rshiny
30077 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
30078
30079 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
30080
30081 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
30082
30083 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
30084 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
30085 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
30086
30087 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
30088 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
30089
30090 @table @asis
30091
30092 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
30093 The package to use.
30094
30095 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
30096 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
30097 run when the service is run.
30098
30099 The common way to create this file is as follows:
30100
30101 @lisp
30102 @dots{}
30103 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
30104 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
30105 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
30106 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
30107 "/bin/Rscript")))
30108 ;; @dots{}
30109 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
30110 (call-with-output-file app
30111 (lambda (port)
30112 (format port
30113 "#!~a
30114 library(shiny)
30115 setwd(\"~a\")
30116 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
30117 Rbin targetdir))))
30118 @end lisp
30119
30120 @end table
30121 @end deftp
30122 @end defvr
30123
30124 @cindex Nix
30125 @subsubheading Nix service
30126
30127 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
30128
30129 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
30130
30131 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
30132 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
30133 how to use it:
30134
30135 @lisp
30136 (use-modules (gnu))
30137 (use-service-modules nix)
30138 (use-package-modules package-management)
30139
30140 (operating-system
30141 ;; @dots{}
30142 (packages (append (list nix)
30143 %base-packages))
30144
30145 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
30146 %base-services)))
30147 @end lisp
30148
30149 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
30150
30151 @itemize
30152 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
30153 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
30154
30155 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
30156 @end itemize
30157
30158 @example
30159 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
30160 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
30161 @end example
30162
30163 @end defvr
30164
30165 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
30166 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
30167
30168 @table @asis
30169 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
30170 The Nix package to use.
30171
30172 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
30173 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
30174
30175 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
30176 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
30177 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
30178
30179 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
30180 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
30181 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
30182 file.
30183
30184 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
30185 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
30186 @end table
30187 @end deftp
30188
30189 @node Setuid Programs
30190 @section Setuid Programs
30191
30192 @cindex setuid programs
30193 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
30194 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
30195 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
30196 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
30197 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
30198 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
30199 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
30200 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
30201 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
30202
30203 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
30204 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
30205 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
30206 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
30207 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
30208 should be setuid root.
30209
30210 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
30211 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
30212 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
30213 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
30214 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
30215
30216 @example
30217 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
30218 @end example
30219
30220 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
30221 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
30222
30223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
30224 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
30225
30226 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
30227 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
30228 @end defvr
30229
30230 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
30231 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
30232 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
30233 store.
30234
30235 @node X.509 Certificates
30236 @section X.509 Certificates
30237
30238 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
30239 @cindex X.509 certificates
30240 @cindex TLS
30241 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
30242 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
30243 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
30244 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
30245 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
30246 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
30247
30248 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
30249 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
30250 out-of-the-box.
30251
30252 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
30253 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
30254 certificates can be found.
30255
30256 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
30257 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
30258 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
30259 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
30260 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
30261 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
30262
30263 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
30264 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
30265 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
30266 to the certificates installed globally.
30267
30268 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
30269 can also install their own certificate package in
30270 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
30271 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
30272 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
30273 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
30274 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
30275 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
30276 would typically run something like:
30277
30278 @example
30279 guix install nss-certs
30280 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
30281 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
30282 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
30283 @end example
30284
30285 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
30286 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
30287 something like this:
30288
30289 @example
30290 guix install nss-certs
30291 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
30292 @end example
30293
30294 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
30295 variable in the relevant documentation.
30296
30297
30298 @node Name Service Switch
30299 @section Name Service Switch
30300
30301 @cindex name service switch
30302 @cindex NSS
30303 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
30304 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
30305 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
30306 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
30307 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
30308 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
30309 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
30310 C Library Reference Manual}).
30311
30312 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
30313 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
30314 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
30315 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
30316 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
30317 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
30318
30319 @cindex nss-mdns
30320 @cindex .local, host name lookup
30321 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
30322 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
30323 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
30324 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
30325
30326 @lisp
30327 (name-service-switch
30328 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
30329
30330 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
30331 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
30332 (name-service
30333 (name "mdns_minimal")
30334
30335 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
30336 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
30337 ;; no need to try the next methods.
30338 (reaction (lookup-specification
30339 (not-found => return))))
30340
30341 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
30342 (name-service
30343 (name "dns"))
30344
30345 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
30346 (name-service
30347 (name "mdns")))))
30348 @end lisp
30349
30350 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
30351 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
30352 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
30353
30354 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
30355 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
30356 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
30357 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
30358 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
30359 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
30360 @code{nscd-service}}).
30361
30362 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
30363 configurations.
30364
30365 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
30366 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
30367 @code{name-service-switch} object.
30368 @end defvr
30369
30370 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
30371 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
30372 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
30373 @end defvr
30374
30375 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
30376 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
30377 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
30378 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
30379 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
30380 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
30381 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
30382 run @command{guix system}.
30383
30384 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
30385
30386 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
30387 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
30388 system databases.
30389
30390 @table @code
30391 @item aliases
30392 @itemx ethers
30393 @itemx group
30394 @itemx gshadow
30395 @itemx hosts
30396 @itemx initgroups
30397 @itemx netgroup
30398 @itemx networks
30399 @itemx password
30400 @itemx public-key
30401 @itemx rpc
30402 @itemx services
30403 @itemx shadow
30404 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
30405 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
30406 @end table
30407 @end deftp
30408
30409 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
30410
30411 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
30412 associated lookup action.
30413
30414 @table @code
30415 @item name
30416 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
30417 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
30418
30419 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
30420 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
30421 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
30422 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
30423
30424 @item reaction
30425 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
30426 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
30427 Reference Manual}). For example:
30428
30429 @lisp
30430 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
30431 (success => return))
30432 @end lisp
30433 @end table
30434 @end deftp
30435
30436 @node Initial RAM Disk
30437 @section Initial RAM Disk
30438
30439 @cindex initrd
30440 @cindex initial RAM disk
30441 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
30442 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
30443 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
30444 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
30445 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
30446
30447 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
30448 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
30449 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
30450 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
30451 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
30452 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
30453 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
30454 file system, you would write:
30455
30456 @lisp
30457 (operating-system
30458 ;; @dots{}
30459 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
30460 @end lisp
30461
30462 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
30463 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
30464 @end defvr
30465
30466 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
30467 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
30468 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
30469 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
30470 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
30471 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
30472
30473 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
30474 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
30475 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
30476 system declaration like this:
30477
30478 @lisp
30479 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
30480 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
30481 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
30482 (apply base-initrd file-systems
30483 #:qemu-networking? #t
30484 rest)))
30485 @end lisp
30486
30487 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
30488 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
30489 volatile root file system.
30490
30491 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
30492 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
30493 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
30494 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
30495 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
30496 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
30497
30498 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
30499 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
30500 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
30501 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
30502
30503 @table @code
30504 @item --load=@var{boot}
30505 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
30506 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
30507
30508 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
30509 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
30510 initialization system.
30511
30512 @item --root=@var{root}
30513 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
30514 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
30515 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
30516 operating system declaration is used.
30517
30518 @item --system=@var{system}
30519 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
30520 @var{system}.
30521
30522 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
30523 @cindex module, black-listing
30524 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
30525 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
30526 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
30527 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
30528 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
30529
30530 @item --repl
30531 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
30532 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
30533 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
30534 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
30535 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
30536
30537 @end table
30538
30539 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
30540 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
30541 here is how to use it and customize it further.
30542
30543 @cindex initrd
30544 @cindex initial RAM disk
30545 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
30546 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
30547 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
30548 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
30549 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
30550 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
30551 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
30552 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
30553 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
30554 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
30555 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
30556 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
30557 the root file system.
30558
30559 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
30560 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
30561 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
30562 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
30563 intended keyboard layout.
30564
30565 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
30566 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
30567 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
30568
30569 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
30570 to it are lost.
30571 @end deffn
30572
30573 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
30574 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
30575 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
30576 [#:linux-modules '()]
30577 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
30578 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
30579 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
30580 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
30581 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
30582
30583 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
30584 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
30585 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
30586 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
30587 intended keyboard layout.
30588
30589 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
30590
30591 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
30592 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
30593 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
30594 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
30595 @end deffn
30596
30597 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
30598 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
30599 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
30600 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
30601 program to run in that initrd.
30602
30603 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
30604 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
30605 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
30606 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
30607 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
30608 automatically copied to the initrd.
30609 @end deffn
30610
30611 @node Bootloader Configuration
30612 @section Bootloader Configuration
30613
30614 @cindex bootloader
30615 @cindex boot loader
30616
30617 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
30618 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
30619 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
30620 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
30621 installed.
30622
30623 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
30624 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
30625 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
30626 field.
30627
30628 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
30629 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
30630
30631 @table @asis
30632
30633 @item @code{bootloader}
30634 @cindex EFI, bootloader
30635 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
30636 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
30637 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
30638 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
30639 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
30640 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
30641
30642 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
30643 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
30644 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
30645 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
30646 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
30647 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
30648
30649 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
30650 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
30651 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
30652 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
30653 when you boot it on your system.
30654
30655 @vindex grub-bootloader
30656 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
30657 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
30658
30659 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
30660 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
30661 through TFTP. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
30662 build a diskless Guix system.
30663
30664 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the content
30665 of the TFTP root directory at @code{target}
30666 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{target}}), to be served by a TFTP server.
30667 You may want to mount your TFTP server directory onto @code{target} to move the
30668 required files to the TFTP server automatically.
30669
30670 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
30671 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
30672 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
30673 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
30674 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
30675 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
30676 store path, for example as
30677 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
30678
30679 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. The first symlink is
30680 @code{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
30681 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg},
30682 where @code{target} may be @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving
30683 the served TFTP root directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
30684 @code{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This link
30685 is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
30686
30687 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting the root
30688 file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP server exporting your
30689 @code{target} directory—usually @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for
30690 your Guix system. In this constellation the symlinks will work.
30691
30692 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader installer,
30693 which then takes care to make necessary files from the store accessible through
30694 TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root directory at @code{target}.
30695
30696 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
30697 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
30698 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP. Both points need to be
30699 considered carefully for security aspects.
30700
30701 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
30702 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
30703 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
30704 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
30705
30706 @item @code{target}
30707 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
30708 bootloader.
30709
30710 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
30711 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
30712 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
30713 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
30714 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
30715 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader},
30716 @code{target} should be the mount point corresponding to the TFTP root
30717 directory of your TFTP server.
30718
30719 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
30720 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
30721 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
30722 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
30723
30724 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
30725 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
30726 current system.
30727
30728 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
30729 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
30730 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
30731
30732 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
30733 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
30734 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
30735 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
30736
30737 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
30738 Layout}).
30739
30740 @quotation Note
30741 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
30742 @code{grub-efi}.
30743 @end quotation
30744
30745 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
30746 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
30747 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
30748 for GRUB.
30749
30750 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
30751 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
30752 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
30753 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
30754 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
30755 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
30756 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
30757
30758 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
30759 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
30760 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
30761 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
30762 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
30763 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
30764 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
30765 manual}).
30766
30767 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
30768 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
30769 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
30770 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
30771
30772 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
30773 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
30774 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
30775 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
30776 @end table
30777
30778 @end deftp
30779
30780 @cindex dual boot
30781 @cindex boot menu
30782 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
30783 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
30784 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
30785 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
30786 along these lines:
30787
30788 @lisp
30789 (menu-entry
30790 (label "The Other Distro")
30791 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
30792 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
30793 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
30794 @end lisp
30795
30796 Details below.
30797
30798 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
30799 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
30800
30801 @table @asis
30802
30803 @item @code{label}
30804 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
30805
30806 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
30807 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
30808
30809 @lisp
30810 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
30811 @end lisp
30812
30813 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
30814 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
30815 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
30816
30817 @example
30818 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
30819 @end example
30820
30821 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
30822 field is ignored entirely.
30823
30824 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
30825 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
30826 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
30827
30828 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
30829 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
30830 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
30831
30832 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
30833 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
30834 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
30835
30836 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
30837 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
30838 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
30839 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
30840 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
30841
30842 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
30843 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
30844 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
30845 For example:
30846
30847 @lisp
30848 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
30849 @end lisp
30850
30851 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
30852 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
30853
30854 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
30855 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
30856
30857 @lisp
30858 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
30859 @dots{})
30860 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
30861 @dots{}))
30862 @end lisp
30863
30864 @end table
30865 @end deftp
30866
30867 @cindex HDPI
30868 @cindex HiDPI
30869 @cindex resolution
30870 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
30871 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
30872 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
30873
30874 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
30875 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
30876
30877 @table @asis
30878 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
30879 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
30880 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
30881 @end table
30882 @end deftp
30883
30884 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
30885 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
30886 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
30887 record.
30888
30889 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
30890 logos.
30891 @end deffn
30892
30893 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
30894 like
30895
30896 @lisp
30897 (bootloader
30898 (bootloader-configuration
30899 ;; @dots{}
30900 (theme (grub-theme
30901 (inherit (grub-theme))
30902 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
30903 @end lisp
30904
30905 @node Invoking guix system
30906 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
30907
30908 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
30909 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
30910 system} command. The synopsis is:
30911
30912 @example
30913 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
30914 @end example
30915
30916 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
30917 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
30918 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
30919 supported:
30920
30921 @table @code
30922 @item search
30923 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
30924 expressions, sorted by relevance:
30925
30926 @cindex HDPI
30927 @cindex HiDPI
30928 @cindex resolution
30929 @example
30930 $ guix system search console
30931 name: console-fonts
30932 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
30933 extends: shepherd-root
30934 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
30935 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
30936 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
30937 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
30938 +
30939 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
30940 + ("tty2" . (file-append
30941 + font-tamzen
30942 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
30943 + ("tty3" . (file-append
30944 + font-terminus
30945 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
30946 relevance: 9
30947
30948 name: mingetty
30949 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
30950 extends: shepherd-root
30951 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
30952 relevance: 2
30953
30954 name: login
30955 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
30956 extends: pam
30957 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
30958 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
30959 relevance: 2
30960
30961 @dots{}
30962 @end example
30963
30964 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
30965 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
30966 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
30967
30968 @item reconfigure
30969 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
30970 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
30971 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
30972 systems already running Guix System.}.
30973
30974 @quotation Note
30975 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
30976 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
30977 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
30978 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
30979 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
30980 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
30981 @end quotation
30982
30983 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
30984 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
30985 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
30986 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
30987 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
30988 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
30989
30990 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
30991 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
30992 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
30993 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
30994 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
30995
30996 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
30997 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
30998 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
30999 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
31000
31001 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
31002 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
31003 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
31004 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
31005 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
31006
31007 @example
31008 guix system describe
31009 @end example
31010
31011 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
31012 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
31013 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
31014 operating system with:
31015
31016 @example
31017 guix time-machine \
31018 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
31019 system reconfigure \
31020 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
31021 @end example
31022
31023 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
31024 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
31025 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
31026 information on provenance tracking.
31027
31028 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
31029 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
31030 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
31031 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
31032 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
31033
31034 @item switch-generation
31035 @cindex generations
31036 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
31037 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
31038 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
31039 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
31040 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
31041 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
31042 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
31043
31044 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
31045 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
31046 configuration file.
31047
31048 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
31049 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
31050 generation 7:
31051
31052 @example
31053 guix system switch-generation 7
31054 @end example
31055
31056 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
31057 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
31058 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
31059 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
31060 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
31061 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
31062
31063 @example
31064 guix system switch-generation -- -1
31065 @end example
31066
31067 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
31068 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
31069 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
31070 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
31071 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
31072 like activating and deactivating services.
31073
31074 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
31075
31076 @item roll-back
31077 @cindex rolling back
31078 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
31079 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
31080 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
31081 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
31082
31083 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
31084 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
31085 generation.
31086
31087 @item delete-generations
31088 @cindex deleting system generations
31089 @cindex saving space
31090 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
31091 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
31092 collector'').
31093
31094 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
31095 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
31096 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
31097
31098 @example
31099 guix system delete-generations
31100 @end example
31101
31102 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
31103 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
31104
31105 @example
31106 guix system delete-generations 2m
31107 @end example
31108
31109 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
31110 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
31111 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
31112
31113 @item build
31114 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
31115 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
31116 This action does not actually install anything.
31117
31118 @item init
31119 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
31120 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
31121 installations of Guix System. For instance:
31122
31123 @example
31124 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
31125 @end example
31126
31127 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
31128 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
31129 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
31130 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
31131 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
31132
31133 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
31134 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
31135 passed.
31136
31137 @item vm
31138 @cindex virtual machine
31139 @cindex VM
31140 @anchor{guix system vm}
31141 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
31142 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
31143
31144 @quotation Note
31145 The @code{vm} action and others below
31146 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
31147 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
31148 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
31149 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
31150 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
31151 @end quotation
31152
31153 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
31154 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
31155 emulated machine:
31156
31157 @example
31158 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
31159 @end example
31160
31161 The VM shares its store with the host system.
31162
31163 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
31164 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
31165 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
31166 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
31167
31168 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
31169 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
31170 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
31171
31172 @example
31173 guix system vm my-config.scm \
31174 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
31175 @end example
31176
31177 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
31178 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
31179 store of the host can then be mounted.
31180
31181 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
31182 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
31183 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
31184 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
31185 size of the image.
31186
31187 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
31188 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
31189 @item vm-image
31190 @itemx disk-image
31191 @itemx docker-image
31192 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
31193 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
31194 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
31195 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
31196 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
31197 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
31198 @code{docker-image}.
31199
31200 @cindex disk-image, creating disk images
31201 The @code{disk-image} command can produce various image types. The
31202 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
31203 defaults to @code{raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
31204 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
31205 @code{disk-image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
31206 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
31207 make it volatile instead. When using @code{disk-image}, the bootloader
31208 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
31209 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
31210 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
31211 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
31212
31213 @example
31214 image=$(guix system disk-image --image-type=qcow2 \
31215 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
31216 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
31217 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
31218 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
31219 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
31220 @end example
31221
31222 When using the @code{raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced; it
31223 can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
31224 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
31225 the image to it using the following command:
31226
31227 @example
31228 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
31229 @end example
31230
31231 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
31232 types.
31233
31234 @cindex vm-image, creating virtual machine images
31235 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
31236 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for
31237 more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine. The
31238 @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used independently of what
31239 is declared in the @code{operating-system} file passed as argument.
31240 This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which uses the SeaBIOS BIOS
31241 by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed in the Master Boot
31242 Record (MBR).
31243
31244 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
31245 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
31246 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
31247 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
31248 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
31249 Docker container using commands like the following:
31250
31251 @example
31252 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
31253 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
31254 docker start $container_id
31255 @end example
31256
31257 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
31258 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
31259 start any services you have defined in the operating system
31260 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
31261 using @command{docker exec}:
31262
31263 @example
31264 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
31265 @end example
31266
31267 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
31268 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
31269 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
31270 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
31271 @code{docker create}.
31272
31273 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
31274 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
31275 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
31276
31277 @item container
31278 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
31279 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
31280 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
31281 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
31282 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
31283 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
31284
31285 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
31286 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
31287 system.
31288
31289 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
31290 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
31291 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
31292
31293 @example
31294 guix system container my-config.scm \
31295 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
31296 @end example
31297
31298 @quotation Note
31299 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
31300 @end quotation
31301
31302 @end table
31303
31304 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
31305 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
31306 following:
31307
31308 @table @option
31309 @item --expression=@var{expr}
31310 @itemx -e @var{expr}
31311 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
31312 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
31313 operating system.
31314 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
31315 Installation Image}).
31316
31317 @item --system=@var{system}
31318 @itemx -s @var{system}
31319 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
31320 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
31321
31322 @item --derivation
31323 @itemx -d
31324 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
31325 building anything.
31326
31327 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
31328 @item --save-provenance
31329 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
31330 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
31331 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
31332 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
31333 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
31334 can run:
31335
31336 @example
31337 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
31338 @end example
31339
31340 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
31341 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
31342 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
31343 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
31344 of the image.
31345
31346 @item --image-type=@var{type}
31347 @itemx -t @var{type}
31348 For the @code{disk-image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
31349
31350 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the @code{raw}
31351 image type.
31352
31353 @cindex ISO-9660 format
31354 @cindex CD image format
31355 @cindex DVD image format
31356 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
31357 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
31358
31359 @item --image-size=@var{size}
31360 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
31361 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
31362 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
31363 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
31364
31365 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
31366 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
31367 @var{file}.
31368
31369 @item --network
31370 @itemx -N
31371 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
31372 that is, do not create a network namespace.
31373
31374 @item --root=@var{file}
31375 @itemx -r @var{file}
31376 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
31377 collector root.
31378
31379 @item --skip-checks
31380 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
31381
31382 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
31383 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
31384 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
31385 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
31386 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
31387 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
31388
31389 @item --allow-downgrades
31390 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
31391
31392 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
31393 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
31394 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
31395 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
31396 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
31397 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
31398 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
31399
31400 @quotation Note
31401 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
31402 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
31403 @end quotation
31404
31405 @cindex on-error
31406 @cindex on-error strategy
31407 @cindex error strategy
31408 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
31409 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
31410 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
31411
31412 @table @code
31413 @item nothing-special
31414 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
31415
31416 @item backtrace
31417 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
31418
31419 @item debug
31420 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
31421 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
31422 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
31423 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
31424 a list of available debugging commands.
31425 @end table
31426 @end table
31427
31428 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
31429 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
31430 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
31431 bootloader boot menu:
31432
31433 @table @code
31434
31435 @item describe
31436 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
31437 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
31438
31439 @item list-generations
31440 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
31441 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
31442 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
31443 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
31444
31445 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
31446 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
31447 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
31448 generations that are up to 10 days old:
31449
31450 @example
31451 $ guix system list-generations 10d
31452 @end example
31453
31454 @end table
31455
31456 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
31457 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
31458 each other:
31459
31460 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
31461 @table @code
31462
31463 @item extension-graph
31464 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
31465 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
31466 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
31467 extensions).
31468
31469 The command:
31470
31471 @example
31472 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
31473 @end example
31474
31475 shows the extension relations among services.
31476
31477 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
31478 @item shepherd-graph
31479 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
31480 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
31481 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
31482 example graph.
31483
31484 @end table
31485
31486 @node Invoking guix deploy
31487 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
31488
31489 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
31490 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
31491 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
31492 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
31493 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
31494 once as a logical ``deployment''.
31495
31496 @quotation Note
31497 The functionality described in this section is still under development
31498 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
31499 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
31500 @end quotation
31501
31502 @example
31503 guix deploy @var{file}
31504 @end example
31505
31506 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
31507 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
31508
31509 @lisp
31510 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
31511 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
31512 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
31513 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
31514 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
31515
31516 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
31517 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
31518
31519 (define %system
31520 (operating-system
31521 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
31522 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
31523 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
31524 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
31525 (target "/dev/vda")
31526 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
31527 (file-systems (cons (file-system
31528 (mount-point "/")
31529 (device "/dev/vda1")
31530 (type "ext4"))
31531 %base-file-systems))
31532 (services
31533 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
31534 (service openssh-service-type
31535 (openssh-configuration
31536 (permit-root-login #t)
31537 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
31538 %base-services))))
31539
31540 (list (machine
31541 (operating-system %system)
31542 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
31543 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
31544 (host-name "localhost")
31545 (system "x86_64-linux")
31546 (user "alice")
31547 (identity "./id_rsa")
31548 (port 2222)))))
31549 @end lisp
31550
31551 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
31552 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
31553 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
31554 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
31555 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
31556 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
31557 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
31558 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
31559 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
31560 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
31561 @var{environment} type would be used.
31562
31563 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
31564 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
31565 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
31566 System:
31567
31568 @example
31569 # guix archive --generate-key
31570 @end example
31571
31572 @noindent
31573 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
31574 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
31575
31576 @example
31577 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
31578 @end example
31579
31580 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
31581 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
31582 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
31583 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
31584 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
31585 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
31586 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
31587 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
31588 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
31589
31590 @lisp
31591 (use-modules ...
31592 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
31593
31594 (define %user "username")
31595
31596 (operating-system
31597 ...
31598 (sudoers-file
31599 (plain-file "sudoers"
31600 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
31601 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
31602 %user)))))
31603
31604 @end lisp
31605
31606 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
31607 consult @command{man sudoers}.
31608
31609 @deftp {Data Type} machine
31610 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
31611 deployment.
31612
31613 @table @asis
31614 @item @code{operating-system}
31615 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
31616
31617 @item @code{environment}
31618 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
31619
31620 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
31621 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
31622 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
31623 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
31624 however, an error will be thrown.
31625 @end table
31626 @end deftp
31627
31628 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
31629 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
31630 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
31631
31632 @table @asis
31633 @item @code{host-name}
31634 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
31635 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
31636 @item @code{system}
31637 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
31638 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
31639 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
31640 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
31641 keyring.
31642 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
31643 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
31644 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
31645 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
31646 remote host.
31647
31648 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
31649 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
31650
31651 @example
31652 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
31653 @end example
31654
31655 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
31656 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
31657 client does.
31658
31659 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
31660 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
31661
31662 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
31663 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
31664 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
31665 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
31666 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
31667 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
31668 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
31669 @end table
31670 @end deftp
31671
31672 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
31673 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
31674 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
31675
31676 @table @asis
31677 @item @code{ssh-key}
31678 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
31679 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
31680 @item @code{tags}
31681 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
31682 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
31683 @item @code{region}
31684 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
31685 @item @code{size}
31686 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
31687 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
31688 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
31689 @end table
31690 @end deftp
31691
31692 @node Running Guix in a VM
31693 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
31694
31695 @cindex virtual machine
31696 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
31697 distributed at
31698 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
31699 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
31700 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
31701 as QEMU (see below for details).
31702
31703 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
31704 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
31705 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
31706 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
31707 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
31708 Configuration System}).
31709
31710 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
31711 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
31712 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
31713 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
31714
31715 @cindex QEMU
31716 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
31717 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
31718 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
31719 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
31720 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
31721 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
31722
31723 @example
31724 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
31725 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
31726 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
31727 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
31728 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
31729 @end example
31730
31731 Here is what each of these options means:
31732
31733 @table @code
31734 @item qemu-system-x86_64
31735 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
31736 host.
31737
31738 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
31739 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
31740 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
31741 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
31742 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
31743 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
31744 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
31745 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
31746
31747 @item -enable-kvm
31748 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
31749 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
31750 faster.
31751
31752 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
31753 @item -m 1024
31754 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
31755 which may be insufficient for some operations.
31756
31757 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
31758 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
31759 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
31760 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
31761 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
31762
31763 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
31764 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
31765 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
31766 @end table
31767
31768 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
31769 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
31770 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
31771 to your system definition and start the VM using
31772 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
31773 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
31774 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
31775 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
31776
31777 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
31778
31779 @cindex SSH
31780 @cindex SSH server
31781 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
31782 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
31783 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
31784 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
31785
31786 @example
31787 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
31788 @end example
31789
31790 To connect to the VM you can run
31791
31792 @example
31793 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
31794 @end example
31795
31796 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
31797 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
31798 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
31799 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
31800 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
31801
31802 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
31803
31804 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
31805 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
31806 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
31807 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
31808
31809 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
31810 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
31811
31812 @example
31813 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
31814 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
31815 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
31816 name=com.redhat.spice.0
31817 @end example
31818
31819 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
31820 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
31821
31822 @node Defining Services
31823 @section Defining Services
31824
31825 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
31826 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
31827 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
31828
31829 @menu
31830 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
31831 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
31832 * Service Reference:: API reference.
31833 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
31834 @end menu
31835
31836 @node Service Composition
31837 @subsection Service Composition
31838
31839 @cindex services
31840 @cindex daemons
31841 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
31842 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
31843 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
31844 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
31845 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
31846 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
31847 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
31848 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
31849 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
31850 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
31851 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
31852 of the system.
31853
31854 @cindex service extensions
31855 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
31856 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
31857 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
31858 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
31859 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
31860 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
31861 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
31862 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
31863 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
31864 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
31865 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
31866
31867 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
31868 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
31869 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
31870
31871 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
31872
31873 @cindex system service
31874 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
31875 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
31876 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
31877 to learn about the other service types shown here.
31878 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
31879 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
31880 particular operating system definition.
31881
31882 @cindex service types
31883 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
31884 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
31885 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
31886 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
31887 different parameters.
31888
31889 The following section describes the programming interface for service
31890 types and services.
31891
31892 @node Service Types and Services
31893 @subsection Service Types and Services
31894
31895 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
31896 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
31897 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
31898
31899 @lisp
31900 (define guix-service-type
31901 (service-type
31902 (name 'guix)
31903 (extensions
31904 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
31905 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
31906 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
31907 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
31908 @end lisp
31909
31910 @noindent
31911 It defines three things:
31912
31913 @enumerate
31914 @item
31915 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
31916
31917 @item
31918 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
31919 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
31920 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
31921
31922 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
31923 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
31924
31925 @item
31926 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
31927 @end enumerate
31928
31929 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
31930
31931 @table @code
31932 @item shepherd-root-service-type
31933 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
31934 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
31935 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
31936 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
31937
31938 @item account-service-type
31939 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
31940 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
31941 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
31942 guix-daemon}).
31943
31944 @item activation-service-type
31945 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
31946 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
31947 booted.
31948 @end table
31949
31950 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
31951
31952 @lisp
31953 (service guix-service-type
31954 (guix-configuration
31955 (build-accounts 5)
31956 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
31957 @end lisp
31958
31959 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
31960 the parameters of this specific service instance.
31961 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
31962 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
31963 value is omitted, the default value specified by
31964 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
31965
31966 @lisp
31967 (service guix-service-type)
31968 @end lisp
31969
31970 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
31971 services but is not extensible itself.
31972
31973 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
31974
31975 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
31976
31977 @lisp
31978 (define udev-service-type
31979 (service-type (name 'udev)
31980 (extensions
31981 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
31982 udev-shepherd-service)))
31983
31984 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
31985 (extend (lambda (config rules)
31986 (match config
31987 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
31988 (udev-configuration
31989 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
31990 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
31991 @end lisp
31992
31993 This is the service type for the
31994 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
31995 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
31996 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
31997
31998 @table @code
31999 @item compose
32000 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
32001 services of this type.
32002
32003 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
32004 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
32005
32006 @item extend
32007 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
32008 the composition of the extensions.
32009
32010 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
32011 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
32012 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
32013 list of contributed rules.
32014
32015 @item description
32016 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
32017 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
32018 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
32019 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
32020 @end table
32021
32022 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
32023 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
32024 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
32025
32026 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
32027 interface for services.
32028
32029 @node Service Reference
32030 @subsection Service Reference
32031
32032 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
32033 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
32034 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
32035 @code{(gnu services)} module.
32036
32037 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
32038 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
32039 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
32040 this particular service instance.
32041
32042 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
32043 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
32044 raised.
32045
32046 For instance, this:
32047
32048 @lisp
32049 (service openssh-service-type)
32050 @end lisp
32051
32052 @noindent
32053 is equivalent to this:
32054
32055 @lisp
32056 (service openssh-service-type
32057 (openssh-configuration))
32058 @end lisp
32059
32060 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
32061 with the default configuration.
32062 @end deffn
32063
32064 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
32065 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
32066 @end deffn
32067
32068 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
32069 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
32070 @end deffn
32071
32072 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
32073 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
32074 parameters.
32075 @end deffn
32076
32077 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
32078
32079 @lisp
32080 (define s
32081 (service nginx-service-type
32082 (nginx-configuration
32083 (nginx nginx)
32084 (log-directory log-directory)
32085 (run-directory run-directory)
32086 (file config-file))))
32087
32088 (service? s)
32089 @result{} #t
32090
32091 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
32092 @result{} #t
32093 @end lisp
32094
32095 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
32096 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
32097 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
32098 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
32099 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
32100 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
32101 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
32102 common pattern.
32103
32104 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
32105 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
32106
32107 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
32108 clauses. Each clause has the form:
32109
32110 @example
32111 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
32112 @end example
32113
32114 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
32115 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
32116 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
32117 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
32118 @var{type}.
32119
32120 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
32121 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
32122 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
32123 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
32124 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
32125 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
32126
32127 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
32128
32129 @end deffn
32130
32131 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
32132 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
32133 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
32134 @code{operating-system} declaration.
32135
32136 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
32137 @cindex service type
32138 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
32139 and Services}).
32140
32141 @table @asis
32142 @item @code{name}
32143 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
32144
32145 @item @code{extensions}
32146 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
32147
32148 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
32149 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
32150 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
32151 services.
32152
32153 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
32154 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
32155 extensions. It may return any single value.
32156
32157 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
32158 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
32159
32160 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
32161 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
32162 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
32163 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
32164 parameter value for the service instance.
32165
32166 @item @code{description}
32167 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
32168 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
32169 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
32170 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
32171
32172 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
32173 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
32174 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
32175
32176 @lisp
32177 (service @var{type})
32178 @end lisp
32179
32180 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
32181 @var{type}.
32182 @end table
32183
32184 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
32185 @end deftp
32186
32187 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
32188 @var{compute}
32189 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
32190 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
32191 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
32192 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
32193 @end deffn
32194
32195 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
32196 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
32197 @end deffn
32198
32199 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
32200 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
32201 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
32202 provides a shorthand for this.
32203
32204 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
32205 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
32206 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
32207 service is an instance.
32208
32209 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
32210 an additional job:
32211
32212 @lisp
32213 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
32214 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
32215 @end lisp
32216 @end deffn
32217
32218 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
32219 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
32220 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
32221 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
32222 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
32223 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
32224 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
32225
32226 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
32227 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
32228 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
32229 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
32230 @end deffn
32231
32232 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
32233 service types, some of which are listed below.
32234
32235 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
32236 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
32237 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
32238 @end defvr
32239
32240 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
32241 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
32242 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
32243 @end defvr
32244
32245 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
32246 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
32247 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
32248 passing it name/file tuples such as:
32249
32250 @lisp
32251 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
32252 @end lisp
32253
32254 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
32255 pointing to the given file.
32256 @end defvr
32257
32258 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
32259 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
32260 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
32261 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
32262 @end defvr
32263
32264 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
32265 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
32266 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
32267 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
32268 @end defvr
32269
32270 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32271 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
32272 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
32273 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
32274 in the system itself. It creates several files under
32275 @file{/run/current-system}:
32276
32277 @table @file
32278 @item channels.scm
32279 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
32280 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
32281 to build the system, if that information was available
32282 (@pxref{Channels}).
32283
32284 @item configuration.scm
32285 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
32286 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
32287 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
32288 received on the command line.
32289
32290 @item provenance
32291 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
32292 format that is more readily processable.
32293 @end table
32294
32295 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
32296 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
32297
32298 @quotation Caveats
32299 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
32300 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
32301 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
32302 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
32303 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
32304 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
32305
32306 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
32307 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
32308 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
32309 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
32310 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
32311 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
32312 comparison less trivial.
32313 @end quotation
32314
32315 This service is automatically added to your operating system
32316 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
32317 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
32318 @end defvr
32319
32320 @node Shepherd Services
32321 @subsection Shepherd Services
32322
32323 @cindex shepherd services
32324 @cindex PID 1
32325 @cindex init system
32326 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
32327 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
32328 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
32329 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
32330 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32331
32332 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
32333 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
32334 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
32335 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
32336 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
32337
32338 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
32339
32340 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
32341 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
32342 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
32343
32344 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
32345 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
32346 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
32347
32348 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
32349 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
32350
32351 @table @asis
32352 @item @code{provision}
32353 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
32354
32355 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
32356 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
32357 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
32358 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
32359
32360 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
32361 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
32362
32363 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
32364 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
32365 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
32366 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
32367 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
32368
32369 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
32370 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
32371 underlying process dies.
32372
32373 @item @code{start}
32374 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
32375 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
32376 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
32377 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
32378 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
32379 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
32380
32381 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
32382 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
32383 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
32384 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
32385 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
32386 @command{herd} sub-commands:
32387
32388 @example
32389 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
32390 @end example
32391
32392 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
32393 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
32394 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
32395
32396 @item @code{documentation}
32397 A documentation string, as shown when running:
32398
32399 @example
32400 herd doc @var{service-name}
32401 @end example
32402
32403 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
32404 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32405
32406 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
32407 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
32408 @code{stop} are evaluated.
32409
32410 @end table
32411 @end deftp
32412
32413 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
32414 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
32415 Shepherd service (see above).
32416
32417 @table @code
32418 @item name
32419 Symbol naming the action.
32420
32421 @item documentation
32422 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
32423
32424 @example
32425 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
32426 @end example
32427
32428 @item procedure
32429 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
32430 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
32431 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
32432 @end table
32433
32434 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
32435 greets the user:
32436
32437 @lisp
32438 (shepherd-action
32439 (name 'say-hello)
32440 (documentation "Say hi!")
32441 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
32442 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
32443 args)
32444 #t)))
32445 @end lisp
32446
32447 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
32448
32449 @example
32450 # herd say-hello example
32451 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
32452 # herd say-hello example a b c
32453 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
32454 @end example
32455
32456 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
32457 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
32458 info on actions.
32459 @end deftp
32460
32461 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
32462 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
32463
32464 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
32465 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
32466 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
32467 @end defvr
32468
32469 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
32470 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
32471 @end defvr
32472
32473
32474 @node Documentation
32475 @chapter Documentation
32476
32477 @cindex documentation, searching for
32478 @cindex searching for documentation
32479 @cindex Info, documentation format
32480 @cindex man pages
32481 @cindex manual pages
32482 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
32483 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
32484 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
32485 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
32486 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
32487 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
32488
32489 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
32490 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
32491 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
32492
32493 @example
32494 $ info -k TLS
32495 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
32496 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
32497 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
32498 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
32499 @dots{}
32500 @end example
32501
32502 @noindent
32503 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
32504
32505 @example
32506 $ man -k TLS
32507 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
32508 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
32509 @dots {}
32510 @end example
32511
32512 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
32513 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
32514 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
32515 respected.
32516
32517 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
32518 running, say:
32519
32520 @example
32521 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
32522 @end example
32523
32524 @noindent
32525 or:
32526
32527 @example
32528 $ man certtool
32529 @end example
32530
32531 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
32532 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
32533 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
32534 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
32535 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
32536 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
32537
32538 @node Installing Debugging Files
32539 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
32540
32541 @cindex debugging files
32542 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
32543 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
32544 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
32545 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
32546 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
32547
32548 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
32549 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
32550 missing.
32551
32552 @menu
32553 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
32554 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
32555 @end menu
32556
32557 @node Separate Debug Info
32558 @section Separate Debug Info
32559
32560 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
32561 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
32562 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
32563 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
32564 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
32565 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
32566 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
32567
32568 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
32569 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
32570 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
32571 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
32572 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
32573 with GDB}).
32574
32575 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
32576 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
32577 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
32578 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
32579 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
32580 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
32581 Guile:
32582
32583 @example
32584 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
32585 @end example
32586
32587 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
32588 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
32589 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
32590 GDB}):
32591
32592 @example
32593 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
32594 @end example
32595
32596 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
32597 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
32598
32599 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
32600 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
32601 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
32602 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
32603 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
32604 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
32605
32606 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
32607 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
32608 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
32609 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
32610 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
32611 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
32612 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
32613
32614 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
32615
32616 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
32617 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
32618
32619 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
32620 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
32621 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
32622 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
32623 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
32624 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
32625 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
32626 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
32627
32628 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
32629 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
32630 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
32631 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
32632
32633 @example
32634 (gdb) bt
32635 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
32636 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
32637 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
32638 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
32639 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
32640 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
32641 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
32642 at dl-init.c:118
32643 @end example
32644
32645 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
32646 contains debug info:
32647
32648 @example
32649 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
32650 @end example
32651
32652 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
32653
32654 @example
32655 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
32656 @dots{}
32657 (gdb) b g_getenv
32658 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
32659 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
32660 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
32661 (gdb) r
32662 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
32663 @dots{}
32664 (gdb) bt
32665 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
32666 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
32667 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
32668 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
32669 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
32670 @dots{}
32671 @end example
32672
32673 Much better!
32674
32675 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
32676 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
32677 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
32678
32679 @node Security Updates
32680 @chapter Security Updates
32681
32682 @cindex security updates
32683 @cindex security vulnerabilities
32684 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
32685 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
32686 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
32687 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
32688 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
32689 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
32690 distribution:
32691
32692 @smallexample
32693 $ guix lint -c cve
32694 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
32695 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
32696 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
32697 @dots{}
32698 @end smallexample
32699
32700 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
32701
32702 Guix follows a functional
32703 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
32704 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
32705 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
32706 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
32707 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
32708 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
32709 desired.
32710
32711 @cindex grafts
32712 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
32713 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
32714 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
32715 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
32716 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
32717 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
32718 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
32719
32720 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
32721 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
32722 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
32723 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
32724 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
32725 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
32726
32727 @lisp
32728 (define bash
32729 (package
32730 (name "bash")
32731 ;; @dots{}
32732 (replacement bash-fixed)))
32733 @end lisp
32734
32735 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
32736 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
32737 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
32738 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
32739 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
32740 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
32741 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
32742 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
32743
32744 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
32745 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
32746 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
32747 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
32748 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
32749 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
32750 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
32751
32752 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
32753 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
32754 Thus, the command:
32755
32756 @example
32757 guix build bash --no-grafts
32758 @end example
32759
32760 @noindent
32761 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
32762
32763 @example
32764 guix build bash
32765 @end example
32766
32767 @noindent
32768 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
32769 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
32770
32771 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
32772 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
32773
32774 @example
32775 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
32776 @end example
32777
32778 @noindent
32779 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
32780 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
32781
32782 @example
32783 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
32784 @end example
32785
32786 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
32787 @command{lsof} command:
32788
32789 @example
32790 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
32791 @end example
32792
32793
32794 @node Bootstrapping
32795 @chapter Bootstrapping
32796
32797 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
32798
32799 @cindex bootstrapping
32800
32801 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
32802 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
32803 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
32804 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
32805 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
32806
32807 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
32808 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
32809 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
32810 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
32811 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
32812 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
32813 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
32814
32815 @cindex bootstrap binaries
32816 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
32817 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
32818 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
32819 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
32820 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
32821 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
32822 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
32823 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
32824 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
32825
32826 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
32827 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
32828 Binaries}).
32829
32830 @menu
32831 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
32832 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
32833 @end menu
32834
32835 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
32836 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
32837
32838 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
32839 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
32840 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
32841 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
32842 ``taken for granted.''
32843
32844 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
32845 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
32846 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
32847 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
32848 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
32849
32850 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
32851 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
32852 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
32853 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
32854
32855 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
32856 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
32857 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
32858 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
32859 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
32860
32861 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
32862 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
32863 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
32864 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
32865
32866 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
32867 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
32868 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
32869 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
32870 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
32871 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
32872 removed are now built from source.
32873
32874 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possibly by adding
32875 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
32876 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
32877 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
32878 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
32879 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
32880 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
32881 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
32882 hopefully be reduced again.
32883
32884 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
32885 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
32886 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
32887
32888 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
32889 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
32890
32891 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
32892 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
32893 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
32894 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
32895 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
32896 to get Guile running.}.
32897
32898 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
32899 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
32900
32901 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
32902 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
32903 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
32904 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
32905
32906 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
32907 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
32908 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
32909
32910 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
32911 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
32912
32913 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
32914 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
32915 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
32916
32917 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
32918 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
32919 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
32920 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
32921
32922 @example
32923 guix graph -t derivation \
32924 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
32925 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
32926 @end example
32927
32928 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
32929
32930 @example
32931 guix graph -t derivation \
32932 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
32933 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
32934 @end example
32935
32936 At this level of detail, things are
32937 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
32938 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
32939 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
32940 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
32941 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
32942 (@pxref{The Store}).
32943
32944 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
32945 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
32946 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
32947 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
32948 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
32949 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
32950 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
32951 tarball to be unpacked.
32952
32953 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
32954 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
32955 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
32956 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
32957 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
32958 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
32959 in the store, using the original layout. The
32960 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
32961 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
32962 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
32963 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
32964
32965 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
32966 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
32967 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
32968 point we have a working C tool chain.
32969
32970 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
32971
32972 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
32973 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
32974 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
32975 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
32976 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
32977 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
32978 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
32979
32980 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
32981 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
32982 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
32983 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
32984 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
32985 package from source. The command:
32986
32987 @example
32988 guix graph -t bag \
32989 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
32990 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
32991 @end example
32992
32993 @noindent
32994 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
32995 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
32996 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
32997 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
32998
32999 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
33000
33001 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
33002 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
33003 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
33004 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
33005 built.
33006
33007 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
33008 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
33009 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
33010 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
33011
33012 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
33013 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
33014 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
33015 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
33016 Coreutils, etc.
33017
33018 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
33019 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
33020 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
33021 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
33022 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
33023
33024
33025 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
33026
33027 @cindex bootstrap binaries
33028 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
33029 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
33030 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
33031 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
33032
33033 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
33034 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
33035 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
33036 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
33037 command-line tools):
33038
33039 @example
33040 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
33041 @end example
33042
33043 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
33044 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
33045 this section.
33046
33047 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
33048 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
33049 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
33050 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
33051 know.
33052
33053 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
33054
33055 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
33056 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
33057 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
33058 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
33059 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
33060 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
33061
33062 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
33063 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
33064 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
33065 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
33066 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
33067
33068 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
33069 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
33070 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
33071 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
33072 a simple and auditable assembler.
33073
33074 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
33075 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
33076 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
33077 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
33078 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
33079 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
33080 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
33081 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
33082
33083 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
33084 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
33085
33086 @node Porting
33087 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
33088
33089 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
33090 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
33091 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
33092 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
33093 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
33094 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
33095 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
33096
33097 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
33098 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
33099 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
33100 one:
33101
33102 @example
33103 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
33104 @end example
33105
33106 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
33107 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
33108 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
33109 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
33110 taught about the new platform.
33111
33112 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
33113 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
33114 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
33115 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
33116 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
33117 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
33118 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
33119 as well.
33120
33121 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
33122 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
33123 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
33124 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
33125 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
33126 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
33127 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
33128 reason.
33129
33130 @c *********************************************************************
33131 @include contributing.texi
33132
33133 @c *********************************************************************
33134 @node Acknowledgments
33135 @chapter Acknowledgments
33136
33137 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
33138 which was designed and
33139 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
33140 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
33141 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
33142 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
33143 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
33144
33145 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
33146 an inspiration for Guix.
33147
33148 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
33149 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
33150 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
33151 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
33152 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
33153
33154
33155 @c *********************************************************************
33156 @node GNU Free Documentation License
33157 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
33158 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
33159 @include fdl-1.3.texi
33160
33161 @c *********************************************************************
33162 @node Concept Index
33163 @unnumbered Concept Index
33164 @printindex cp
33165
33166 @node Programming Index
33167 @unnumbered Programming Index
33168 @syncodeindex tp fn
33169 @syncodeindex vr fn
33170 @printindex fn
33171
33172 @bye
33173
33174 @c Local Variables:
33175 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
33176 @c End: